Professional Documents
Culture Documents
MTIw MZ Ay MDQX NQ
MTIw MZ Ay MDQX NQ
43/16) SD - 4
Dated 25.4.2016 has given approval to prescribe this textbook in its meeting held on
30.01.2020 and it has been decided to implement it from academic year 2020-21
PHYSICS
Standard XII
2020
Maharashtra State Bureau of Textbook Production and
Curriculum Research, Pune.
First Edition : © Maharashtra State Bureau of Textbook Production and
2020 Curriculum Research, Pune - 411 004.
The Maharashtra State Bureau of Textbook Production
and Curriculum Research reserves all rights relating to
the book. No part of this book should be reproduced
without the written permission of the Director, Maharashtra
State Bureau of Textbook Production and Curriculum
Research, ‘Balbharati’, Senapati Bapat Marg, Pune 411004.
Committee:
Illustration
Dr. Chandrashekhar V. Murumkar, Chairman Shri. Shubham Chavan
Dr. Dilip Sadashiv Joag, Convener Cover
Shri. Vinayak Shripad Katdare, Co- Convener Shri. Vivekanand S. Patil
Dr. Pushpa Khare, Member Typesetting
Dr. Rajendra Shankar Mahamuni, Member DTP Section, Textbook Bureau, Pune
Dr. Anjali Kshirsagar, Member
Co-ordination :
Dr. Rishi Baboo Sharma, Member
Shri. Rajiv Arun Patole
Shri. Ramesh Devidas Deshpande, Member Special Officer - Science Section
Shri. Rajiv Arun Patole, Member Secretary Physics
Paper
Study group:
70 GSM Creamwove
Dr. Umesh Anant Palnitkar
Print Order
Dr. Vandana Laxmanrao Jadhav Patil
Dr. Neelam Sunil Shinde Printer
Dr. Radhika Gautamkumar Deshmukh
Shri. Dinesh Madhusudan Joshi
Smt. Smitha Menon Production
Shri. Govind Diliprao Kulkarni Shri Sachchitanand Aphale
Chief Production Officer
Smt. Pratibha Pradeep Pandit
Shri Liladhar Atram
Shri. Prashant Panditrao Kolase
Production Officer
Dr. Archana Balasaheb Bodade
Dr. Jayashri Kalyanrao Chavan Publisher
Smt. Mugdha Milind Taksale Shri Vivek Uttam Gosavi
Dr. Prabhakar Nagnath Kshirsagar Controller
Shri. Ramchandra Sambhaji Shinde Maharashtra State Textbook
Bureau, Prabhadevi,
Shri. Brajesh Pandey
Mumbai - 400 025
The Constitution of India
Preamble
(Vivek Gosavi)
Pune Director
Date : 21 February, 2020 Maharashtra State Bureau of Texbook
Bhartiya Saur : 2 Phalguna, 1941 Production and Curriculum Research, Pune
- For Teachers -
Dear Teachers, introduced in a graded manner to facilitate
We are happy to introduce the revised knowledge building.
textbook of Physics for XIIth standard. This P 'Error in measurements' is an important
book is a sincere attempt to follow the topic in physics. Please ask the students to
maxims of teaching as well as develop a use this in estimating errors in their
‘constructivist’ approach to enhance the measurements. This must become an
quality of learning. The demand for more integral part of laboratory practices.
activity based, experiential and innovative P Major concepts of physics have a scientific
learning opportunities is the need of the base. Encourage group work, learning
hour. The present curriculum has been through each other’s help, etc. Facilitate
restructured so as to bridge the credibility peer learning as much as possible by
gap that exists between what is taught and reorganizing the class structure frequently.
what students learn from direct experience P Do not use the boxes titled ‘Do you know?’
in the outside world. Guidelines provided or ‘Use your brain power’ for evaluation.
below will help to enrich the teaching- However, teachers must ensure that students
learning process and achieve the desired read this extra information and think about
learning outcomes. the questions posed.
P To begin with, get familiar with the P For evaluation, equal weightage should be
textbook yourself, and encourage the assigned to all the topics. Use different
students to read each chapter carefully. combinations of questions. Stereotype
P The present book has been prepared for questions should be avoided.
constructivist and activity-based teaching, P Use Q.R. Code given in the textbook. Keep
including problem solving exercises. checking the Q.R. Code for updated
P Use teaching aids as required for proper information. Certain important links, websites
understanding of the subject. have been given for references. Also a list
P Do not finish the chapter in short. However, of reference books is given. Teachers as well
in the view of insufficient lectures, standard as the students can use these references for
derivations may be left to the students for extra reading and in-depth understanding of
self study. Problem sloving must be given the subject.
due importance. Best wishes for a wonderful teaching
P Follow the order of the chapters strictly as experience!
listed in the contents because the units are
References:
1. Fundamentals of Physics - Halliday, Resnick, Walker; John Wiley (Sixth ed.).
2. Sears and Zeemansky's University Physics - Young and Freedman, Pearson Education (12th ed.)
3. Physics for Scientists and Engineers - Lawrence S. Lerner; Jones and Bartlett Publishers, UK.
Front Cover : Picture shows part of Indus 2, Synchrotron radiation source (electron accelerator) at
RRCAT, Department of Atomic Energy, Govt. of India, Indore. Indus offers several research
opportunities. The photoelectron spectroscopy beamline is also seen.
Picture credit : Director, RRCAT, Indore. The permission to reproduce these pictures by Director,
RRCAT, DAE, Govt. of India is gratefully acknowledged.
Back Cover : Transmission Electron Microscope is based on De Broglie's hypothesis. TEM picture
shows a carbon nanotube filled with water showing the miniscus formed due to surface tension. Other
picture shows crystallites of LaB6 and the electron diffraction pattern (spot pattern) of the crystallite.
Picture credit : Dr. Dilip Joag, Savitribai Phule Pune University. Pune
DISCLAIMER Note : All attempts have been made to contact copy right/s (©) but we have not heard from them. We will be
pleased to acknowledge the copy right holder (s) in our next edition if we learn from them.
Competency Statements :
Standard XII
Area/
Competency Statements
Unit/
After studying the content in Textbook students would be able to....
Lesson
Ratational Motion and Mechanical
• Compare emission of thermal radiation from a body with black body radiation.
• Apply Stefan’s law of radiation to hot bodies .
• Identify thermodynamic process in every day life.
• Relate mechanical work and thermodynamic work.
• Differentiate between different types of thermodynamic processes.
• Explain the working of heat engine, refrigerator and air conditioner.
• Identify periodic motion and simple harmonic motion.
• Obtain the laws of motion for simple pendulum.
Oscillations and waves
diffraction.
• Visualize polarized and unpolarized light.
• Apply concepts of diffraction to calculate the resolving power.
• Distinguish between the stationary waves in pipes with open and closed ends.
• Verify laws of vibrating string using a sonometer.
• Explain the physics involved in musical instruments.
Electrostatics and electric current
• Use Gaus's law to obtain the electric field for a charge distribution.
• Relate potential energy to work done to establish a charge distribution.
• Determine the electrostatic potential for a given charge distribution.
• Distingusih between conductors and insulators.
• Visualize polarization of dielectrics.
Unit IV
• Check the correctness of different atomic models by comparing results of various experiments.
• Identify the constituents of atomic nuclei.
Unit VI
4 Thermodynamics 75-108
5 Oscillations 109-130
6 Superposition of Waves 131-157
7 Wave Optics 158-185
8 Electrostatics 186-213
9 Current Electricity 214-229
10 Magnetic Fields due to Electric Current 230-250
11 Magnetic Materials 251-264
12 Electromagnetic induction 265-287
13 AC Circuits 288-305
14 Dual Nature of Radiation and Matter 306-323
15 Structure of Atoms and Nuclei 324-343
16 Semiconductor Devices 344-364
1. Rotational Dynamics
Can you recall? of the right hand along the sense of rotation,
with the thumb outstretched. The outstretched
1. What is circular motion?
thumb then gives the direction of ω .
2. What is the concept of centre of mass?
3. What are kinematical equations of
motion?
4. Do you know real and pseudo forces,
their origin and applications?
1.1 Introduction:
Fig. 1.1: Directions of angular velocity.
Circular motion is an essential part of our
If T is period of circular motion or periodic
daily life. Every day we come across several 2
time and n is the frequency, 2 n
revolving or rotating (rigid) objects. During T
Uniform circular motion: During circular
revolution, the object (every particle in the
motion if the speed of the particle remains
object) undergoes circular motion about some
constant, it is called Uniform Circular Motion
point outside the object or about some other
(UCM). In this case, only the direction of its
object, while during rotation the motion is about
velocity changes at every instant in such a way
an axis of rotation passing through the object.
1.2 Characteristics of Circular Motion: that the velocity is always tangential to the
path. The acceleration responsible for this is
1) It is an accelerated motion: As the 2
direction of velocity changes at every the centripetal or radial acceleration a r r
instant, it is an accelerated motion. For UCM, its 2magnitude is constant and it
v
2) It is a periodic motion: During the motion, is a 2 r v . It is always directed
r
the particle repeats its path along the same towards the centre of the circular motion
trajectory. Thus, the motion is periodic. (along −r ), hence called centripetal.
1.2.1 Kinematics of Circular Motion:
As seen in XIth Std, in order to describe
a circular motion, we use the quantities
angular displacement θ , angular velocity
d d
and angular acceleration
dt dt
which are analogous
to displacement
ds dv
s , velocity v = and acceleration a =
dt dt Fig. 1.2: Directions of linear velocity and
used in translational motion.
acceleration.
Also, the tangential velocity is given by
Illustration: Circular motion of any particle
v r where ω is the angular velocity.
of a fan rotating uniformly.
Here, the position vector r is the radius
Non-uniform circular motion: When a fan is
vector from the centre of the circular motion. switched ON or OFF, the speeds of particles
The magnitude of v is v = ω r.
of the fan go on increasing or decreasing
Direction of ω is always along the axis of
for some time, however their directions are
rotation and is given by the right-hand thumb
always tangential to their circular trajectories.
rule. To know the direction of ω , curl the fingers
1
During this time, it is a non-uniform circular
always change only the direction of ω and
motion. As the velocity is still tangential, the
never its magnitude thereby continuously
centripetal or radial acceleration a r is still
changing the plane of rotation. (This is
there. However, for non-uniform circular
similar to an acceleration a perpendicular
motion, the magnitude of a r is not constant.
to velocity v changing only its direction).
The acceleration responsible for changing
the magnitude of velocity is directed along If the angular acceleration α is constant
or opposite to the velocity, hence always and along the axis of rotation, all , and
tangential and is called as tangential will be directed along the axis. This makes it
acceleration a T . possible to use scalar notation and write the
kinematical equations of motion analogous to
As magnitude of tangential velocity v
is changing during a non-uniform circular those for translational motion as given in the
motion, the corresponding angular velocity ω table 1 at the end of the topic.
is also changing at every instant. This is due to Example 1: A fan is rotating at 90 rpm.
d
the angular acceleration It is then switched OFF. It stops after 21
dt
Though the motion is non-uniform, the revolutions. Calculate the time taken by it
particles are still in the same plane. Hence, to stop assuming that the frictional torque
the direction of α is still along the axis of is constant.
rotation. For increasing speed, it is along the Solution:
rad
direction of ω while during decreasing speed, n0 90 rpm 1.5 rps 0 2 n0 3
s
it is opposite to that of ω .
The angle through which the blades of
the fan move while stopping is θ = 2πN
= 2π (21) = 42 π rad, ω = 0 (fan stops).
Using equations analogous to kinematical
equations of motion
0 2 02
Fig. 1.3: Direction of angular acceleration.
t 2
0 3 0 3
2
Do you know?
t 28 s
t 2 42
If the angular acceleration α is along
any direction other than axial, it will have Remark: One can also use the unit
a component perpendicular to the axis. ‘revolution’ for angle and get rid of π
Thus, it will change the direction of ω also, throughout (for such data). In this case,
which will change the plane of rotation as 0 1.5 rps and 21 rev.
ω is always perpendicular to the plane of
1.2.2 Dynamics of Circular Motion
rotation.
(Centripetal Force and Centrifugal Force):
If α is
i) Centripetal force (CPF): As seen above,
constant in
the acceleration responsible for circular
magnitude,
motion is the centripetal or radial acceleration
but always
a r 2 r . The force providing this
perpendicular
acceleration is the centripetal or radial force,
to ω , it will 2
CPF m r
2
It must be understood that centrifugal
Remember this force is a non-real force, but NOT an
imaginary force. Remember, before the merry-
(i) The word centripetal is NOT the name go-round reaches its uniform speed, you were
or type of that force (like gravitational really experiencing an outward pull (because,
force, nuclear force, etc). It is the centrifugal force is greater than the resultant
adjective or property of that force force towards the centre). A force measuring
saying that the direction of this force instrument can record it as well.
is along the radius and towards centre On reaching the uniform speed, in the
(centre seeking). frame of reference of merry-go-round, this
(ii) While performing circular or rotational centrifugal force exactly balances the resultant
motion, the resultant of all the real
of all the real forces. The resultant force in
forces acting upon the body is (or, must
that frame of reference is thus zero. Thus, only
be) towards the centre, hence we call
this resultant force to be centripetal in such a frame of reference we can say that
force. Under the action of this resultant the centrifugal force balances the centripetal
force, the direction of the velocity is force. It must be remembered that in this case,
always maintained tangential to the centrifugal force means the ‘net pseudo force’
circular track. and centripetal force means the ‘resultant of
The vice versa need not be true, all the real forces’.
i.e., the resultant force directed towards There are two ways of writing force
the centre may not always result into a equation for a circular motion:
circular motion. (In the Chapter 7 you
will know that during an s.h.m. also the Resultant force m 2 r or
force is always directed to the centre of m 2 r realforces 0
the motion). For a motion to be circular,
correspondingly matching tangential
velocity is also essential. Activity
(iii) Obviously, this discussion is in an
Attach a suitable mass to spring balance so
inertial frame of reference in which
we are observing that the body is that it stretches by about half is capacity.
performing a circular motion. Now whirl the spring balance so that the
(iv) In magnitude, centripetal force mass performs a horizontal motion. You will
notice that the balance now reads more mass
mv 2
mr 2 mv for the same mass. Can you explain this?
r
ii) Centrifugal force (c.f.f.): 1.3 Applications of Uniform Circular Motion:
Visualize yourself on a merry-go-round 1.3.1 Vehicle Along a Horizontal Circular
rotating uniformly. If you close your eyes, you Track:
will not know that you are performing a circular
Figure 1.4 shows vertical section of a car
motion but you will feel that you are at rest. In
on a horizontal circular track of radius r. Plane
order to explain that you are at rest, you need
of figure is a vertical plane, perpendicular to
to consider a force equal in magnitude to the
the track but includes only centre C of the
resultant real force, but directed opposite, i.e.,
2
away from the centre. This force, m r is track. Forces acting on the car (considered
to be a particle) are (i) weight mg, vertically
the centrifugal (away from the centre) force. It
is a pseudo force arising due to the centripetal downwards, (ii) normal reaction N, vertically
acceleration of the frame of reference. upwards that balances the weight mg and (iii)
3
force of static friction fs between road and the
but above it. Thus, the frictional force
tyres. This is static friction because it prevents
and the centrifugal force result into a
the vehicle from outward slipping or skidding.
torque which may topple the vehicle
This is the resultant force which is centripetal.
(even a two wheeler).
(ii) For a two wheeler, it is a must for
the rider to incline with respect to the
vertical to prevent toppling.
5
Use your brain power
Do you know?
2 2
vertical, at any position (semi-vertical angle will be infinite.
of the cone), the vertical component T0 cos
θ balances the weight mg. The horizontal
component T0 sinθ then becomes the resultant Activity
force which is centripetal. A stone is tied to a string and whirled
T0 sin centripetalforce mr 2 --- (1.5) such that the stone performs horizontal
Also, T0 cos θ = mg --- (1.6) circular motion. It can be seen that the string
Dividing eq (1.5) by Eq. (1.6), we get, is NEVER horizontal.
8
Example 1.4: A merry-go-round usually mv 2
Solution: N sin mg and N cos
consists of a central vertical pillar. At the r
top of it there are horizontal rods which can rg v 2 tan
tan 2 r
rotate about vertical axis. At the end of this v g
horizontal rod there is a vertical rod fitted v 2max tan
like an elbow joint. At the lower end of rmax 0.3m
g
each vertical rod, there is a horse on which v r 2 rn
the rider can sit. As the merry-go-round is
set into rotation, these vertical rods move If we go for the lower
away from the axle by making some angle limit of the speed (while
with the vertical. rotating),
v 0 r 0 , but the
frequency n increases.
Hence a specific upper
limit is not possible in the case of frequency.
Thus, the practical limit on the frequency of
rotation is its lower limit. It will be possible
The figure above shows vertical section for r = rmax
of a merry-go-round in which the ‘initially v 1
nmin max 1rev / s
vertical’ rods are inclined with the vertical at 2 rmax 0.3
370, during rotation. Calculate the frequency
of revolution of the merry-go-round.
(Use g = π2 m/s2 and sin 37° = 0.6) Activity
Solution: Length of the horizontal rod,
Using a funnel and a marble or a ball bearing
H = 2.1 m
try to work out the situation in the above
Length of the ‘initially vertical’ rod,
question. Try to realize that as the marble
V = 1.5 m, θ = 37°
goes towards the brim, its linear speed
∴ Radius of the horizontal circular motion
increases but its angular speed decreases.
of the rider = H + V sin 37° = 3.0 m
When nearing the base, it is the other way.
If T is the tension along the inclined rod,
T cos θ = mg and T sin θ = mr ω 2 = 4π2 mrn2 1.4 Vertical Circular Motion:
4 2 rn 2 Two types of vertical circular motions are
tan
g commonly observed in practice:
tan 1 (a) A controlled vertical circular motion such
n revs 1 as g 2 as a giant wheel or similar games. In this
4r 4
Example 1.5: Semi-vertical angle of the case the speed is either kept constant or
conical section of a funnel is 370. There is a NOT totally controlled by gravity.
small ball kept inside the funnel. On rotating (b) Vertical circular motion controlled only
the funnel, the maximum speed that the ball by gravity. In this case, we initially
can have in order to remain in the funnel is 2 supply the necessary energy (mostly) at
m/s. Calculate inner radius of the brim of the the lowest point. Then onwards, the entire
funnel. Is there any limit upon the frequency kinetics is governed by the gravitational
of rotation? How much is it? Is it lower or force. During the motion, there is
upper limit? Give a logical reasoning. (Use interconversion of kinetic energy and
g = 10 m/s2 and sin 370 = 0.6) gravitational potential energy.
9
1.4.1 Point Mass Undergoing Vertical realized with minimum possible energy),
Circular Motion Under Gravity: TA = 0 v A min rg --- (1.10)
Case I: Mass tied to a string: Lowermost position (B): Force due to the
The figure 1.10 shows a bob (treated as tension, TB is vertically upwards, i.e., towards
a point mass) tied to a (practically) massless, the centre, and opposite to mg. In this case also
inextensible and flexible string. It is whirled their resultant is the centripetal force. If vB is
along a vertical circle so that the bob performs the speed at the lowermost point, we get,
a vertical circular motion and the string rotates mv 2B
TB mg --- (1.11)
in a vertical plane. At any position of the bob, r
there are only two forces acting on the bob: While coming down from the uppermost to
A the lowermost point, the vertical displacement
is 2r and the motion is governed only by
gravity. Hence the corresponding decrease in
the gravitational potential energy is converted
into the kinetic energy.
1 1
mg 2r mv 2B mv 2A
2 2
v B v A 4 rg
2 2 --- (1.12)
B v A min
Using this in the eq (1.11), and using min rg
from Eq. (1.10) we get,
v B min 5rg --- (1.13)
Subtracting eq (1.9) from eq (1.11) , we can
Fig 1.10: Vertical circular motion. write,
(a) its weight mg, vertically downwards, which m
is constant and (b) the force due to the tension TB TA 2 mg v 2B v 2A --- (1.14)
r
along the string, directed along the string and
Using eq (1.12) and rearranging, we get,
towards the centre. Its magnitude changes TB TA 6 mg --- (1.15)
periodically with time and location. Positions when the string is horizontal (C
As the motion is non uniform, the resultant and D): Force due to the tension is the only
of these two forces is not directed towards force towards the centre as weight mg is
the center except at the uppermost and the perpendicular to the tension. Thus, force due
lowermost positions of the bob. At all the other to the tension is the centripetal force used to
positions, part of the resultant is tangential and change the direction of the velocity and weight
is used to change the speed. mg is used only to change the speed.
Uppermost position (A): Both, weight mg and Using similar mathematics, it can be shown
force due to tension TA are downwards, i.e., that
TC TA TD TA 3mg and
towards the centre. In this case, their resultant
is used only as the centripetal force. Thus, if v C min v D min 3rg
vA is the speed at the uppermost point, we get, Arbitrary positions: Force due to the tension
mv 2A and weight are neither along the same line,
mg TA --- (1.9)
r nor perpendicular. Tangential component of
Radius r of the circular motion is the weight is used to change the speed. It decreases
length of the string. For minimum possible the speed while going up and increases it while
speed at this point (or if the motion is to be coming down.
10
1.4.2 Sphere of Death (मृत्यु गोल):
Remember this This is a popular show in a circus. During
this, two-wheeler rider (or riders) undergo
1. Equation (1.15) is independent of v and r. rounds inside a hollow sphere. Starting with
2. TA can never be exactly equal to zero in small horizontal circles, they eventually
the case of a string, else, the string will perform revolutions along vertical circles. The
slack. ∴ TB > 6 mg.
dynamics of this vertical circular motion is
3. None of the parameters (including the the same as that of the point mass tied to the
linear and angular accelerations) are
string, except that the force due to tension T is
constant during such a motion. Obviously,
kinematical equations given in the table1 replaced by the normal reaction force N.
are not applicable. If you have seen this show, try to visualize
4. We can determine the position vector or that initially there are nearly horizontal circles.
velocity at any instant using the energy The linear speed is more for larger circles but
conservation. But as the function of the angular speed (frequency) is more for smaller
radius vector is not integrable (definite circles (while starting or stopping). This is as
integration is not possible), theoretically per the theory of conical pendulum.
it is not possible to determine the period 1.4.3 Vehicle at the Top of a Convex Over-
or frequency. However, experimentally Bridge:
the period can be measured.
5. Equations (1.10) and (1.13) give only
the respective minimum speeds at the
uppermost and the lowermost points. Any
higher speeds obeying the equation (1.14)
are allowed.
6. In reality, we have to continuously
supply some energy to overcome the air
resistance.
Fig. 1.11: Vehicle on a convex over-bridge.
Case II: Mass tied to a rod: Consider a bob Figure shows a vehicle at the top of a
(point mass) tied to a (practically massless and convex over bridge, during its motion (part
rigid) rod and whirled along a vertical circle. of vertical circular motion). Forces acting on
The basic difference between the rod and the the vehicle are (a) Weight mg and (b) Normal
string is that the string needs some tension at reaction force N, both along the vertical line
all the points, including the uppermost point. (topmost position). The resultant of these two
Thus, a certain minimum speed, Eq. (1.10), is must provide the necessary centripetal force
necessary at the uppermost point in the case (vertically downwards) if the vehicle is at the
of a string. In the case of a rod, as the rod is uppermost position. Thus, if v is the speed at
rigid, such a condition is not necessary. Thus the uppermost point,
(practically) zero speed is possible at the mv 2
mg N
uppermost point. r
Using similar mathematics, it is left to the As the speed is increased, N goes on
readers to show that decreasing. Normal reaction is an indication
v lowermost min 4 rg 2 rg of contact. Thus, for just maintaining contact,
vmin at the rod horizontal position = 2rg N = 0. This imposes an upper limit on the speed
Tlowermost Tuppermost 6 mg as v max = rg
11
1
0.02 8 K.E.min 0.02 10 1.8
2
Do you know? ∴
2
Roller coaster is a common event in the K.E.min 0.28 J
1
K.E.max 0.02 8 0.02 10 1.8
amusement parks. During this ride, all 2
same, and along the axis. Magnitude of the
m1r12 m2 r22 mN rN2 I
resultant torque is then given by
Where, I m1r12 m2 r22 mN rN2 is the 1 2 N
moment of inertia of the body about the given
m1r12 m2 r22 mN rN2 I
17
Examples of conservation of angular
where, I m1r1 m2 r2 mN rN
2 2 2
is the
momentum: During some shows of ballet
moment of inertia of the object about the given
dance, acrobat in a circus, sports like ice
axis of rotation.
skating, diving in a swimming pool, etc., the
The relation I is analogous to
f = ma for the translational motion if the principle of conservation of angular momentum
is realized. In all these applications the product
moment of inertia I replaces mass, which is
L I I 2 n is constant (once the players
its physical significance.
acquire a certain speed). Thus, if the moment
1.10 Conservation of Angular Momentum:
of inertia I is increased, the angular speed and
In the article 4.7 of XIth Std. we have
hence the frequency of revolution n decreases.
seen the conservation of linear momentum
Also, if the moment of inertia is decreased, the
which says that linear momentum of an
frequency increases.
isolated system is conserved in the absence
(i) Ballet dancers: During ice ballet, the
of an external unbalanced force. As seen
dancers have to undertake rounds of smaller
earlier, torque and angular momentum are
and larger radii. The dancers come together
the respective analogous quantities to force
while taking the rounds of smaller radius (near
and linear momentum in rotational dynamics.
the centre). In this case, the moment of inertia
With suitable changes this can be transformed
of their system becomes minimum and the
into the conservation of angular momentum.
frequency increases, to make it thrilling. While
As seen in the section 1.8, angular
outer rounds, the dancers outstretch their legs
momentum or the moment of linear momentum
and arms. This increases their moment of
of a system is given by L r p
inertia that reduces the angular speed and
where r is the position vector from the axis of
hence the linear speed. This is essential to
rotation and p is the linear momentum.
prevent slipping.
Differentiating with respect to time, we get,
(ii) Diving in a swimming pool (during
dL d dp dr
r p r p competition): While on the diving board, the
dt dt dt
dt
divers stretch their body so as to increase the
dr dp
Now, = v and =F . moment of inertia. Immediately after leaving
dt dt the board, they fold their body. This reduces
dL
dt
r F m vv the moment inertia considerably. As a result,
the frequency increases and they can complete
Now v v 0
more rounds in air to make the show attractive.
Again, while entering into water they stretch
dL
rF their body into a streamline shape. This allows
dt
them a smooth entry into the water.
But r × F is the moment of force or torque τ .
dL Example 1.8: A spherical water balloon
dt is revolving at 60 rpm. In the course of
dL
Thus, if 0, 0 or L constant. time, 48.8 % of its water leaks out. With
dt what frequency will the remaining balloon
Hence, angular momentum L is conserved in
revolve now? Neglect all non-conservative
the absence of external unbalanced torque τ . 1
forces. 3
This is the principle of conservation of angular m1 V1 R1 R m 3
Solution: 1 1
momentum, analogous to the conservation of m2 V2 R2 R2 m2
linear momentum.
18
Accordingly, the object possesses two
m1 100 100 1 types of kinetic energies, rotational and
Also,
m2 100 48.8 51.2 0.512 translational. Sum of these two is its total
1
kinetic energy.
m 3 1
1 1.25 Consider an object of moment of inertia
m2 0.8
I, rolling uniformly. Following quantities can
= =
n1 60 rpm 1rps, n2 = ? be related.
Being sphere, moment of inertia v = Linear speed of the centre of mass
5
2 R = Radius of the body
2 I m R m 3
I mR 2 1 1 1 1 Angular speed of rotation of the body
5 I 2 m2 R2 m2 v
for any particle
According to principle of conservation of R
angular momentum, I11 I 22 M = Mass of the body
5
K = Radius of gyration of the body I MK 2
I m 3
I1 2 n1 I 2 2 n2 n2 1 n1 1 Total kinetic energy of rolling = Translational
I2 m2 K.E. + Rotational K.E.
n1 1.225 1 3.052 rps
5
1 1
E Mv 2 I 2
Example 1.9: A ceiling fan having moment 2 2
2
of inertia 2 kg-m2 attains its maximum 1 1 v
frequency of 60 rpm in ‘2π’ seconds. 2
Mv 2 MK 2
2
R
Calculate its power rating. K2
1
Solution: Mv 2 1 2 --- (1.18)
2 R
0 0, 2 n 2 2 4 rad / s
It must be remembered that static friction
0 4 0
2 rad/s2 is essential for a purely rolling motion. In this
t 2
case, it prevents the sliding motion. You might
P I 2 2 4
have noticed that many a times while rolling
16 watt 50 watt
down, the motion is initially a purely rolling
motion that later on turns out to be a sliding
1.11 Rolling Motion:
motion. Similarly, if you push a sphere-like
The objects like a cylinder, sphere,
object along a horizontal surface, initially it
wheels, etc. are quite often seen to perform
slips for some distance and then starts rolling.
rolling motion. In the case of pure rolling,
1.11.1 Linear Acceleration and Speed While
two motions are undertaking simultaneously;
Pure Rolling Down an Inclined Plane:
circular motion and linear motion. Individual
Figure 1.18 shows a rigid object of mass
motion of the particles (except the one at the
m and radius R, rolling down an inclined plane,
centre of mass) is too difficult to describe.
without slipping. Inclination of the plane with
However, for theory considerations we can
the horizontal is θ .
consider the actual motion to be the result of
(i) circular motion of the body as a whole,
about its own symmetric axis and
(ii) linear motion of the body assuming it to
be concentrated at its centre of mass. In other
words, the centre of mass performs purely
translational motion. Fig. 1.18: Rolling along an incline.
19
As the objects starts rolling down, its K2 1
gravitational P.E. is converted into K.E. of 2
= fora uniform disc or a solid cylinder
R 2
rolling. Starting from rest, let v be the speed of K 2
2
= for a thin walled hollow sphere
the centre of mass as the object comes down R 2
3
through a vertical distance h. (II) When a rod rolls, it is actually a cylinder
From Eq. (1.18), that is rolling.
1 1 2 1 2 K2 (III) While rolling, the ratio ‘Translational
E Mv I Mv 1 2
2
dW dW
Power P f v Power P ------
dt dt
Thin ring or
hollow cylinder
Central I = MR 2
1
Thin ring Diameter I= MR 2
2
Annular ring or 1
thick walled Central I
2
M r22 r12
hollow cylinder
21
Uniform disc or 1
Central I= MR 2
solid cylinder 2
1
Uniform disc Diameter I= MR 2
4
Thin walled 2
Central I= MR 2
hollow sphere 3
2
Solid sphere Central I= MR 2
5
Uniform symmetric 2
I M 3 3
r25 r15
Central
spherical shell 5 r2 r1
Perpendicular to 1
Thin uniform rod or I= ML2
length and passing
rectangular plate
through centre 12
Perpendicular to 1
Thin uniform rod or I= MR 2
length and about
rectangular plate
one end 3
Uniform plate 1
or rectangular Central I M ( L2 b 2 )
parallelepiped 12
22
Uniform solid 3
Central I= MR 2
right circular cone 10
Uniform hollow 1
Central I= MR 2
right circular cone 2
Exercises
24
there? By what factor will the answer motorcycle varies between 6 m/s and 10
change if the coin is almost at the rim? m/s. Calculate diameter of the sphere of
(use g = π2 m/s2) death. How much minimum values are
1
[Ans: 2.5 rev/s, n2 = n1 ] possible for these two speeds?
2
14. Part of a racing track is to be designed [Ans: Diameter = 3.2 m,
for a curvature of 72 m. We are not (v1)min = 4 m/s, (v2)min = 4 5 m / s ]
recommending the vehicles to drive 19. A metallic ring of mass 1 kg has moment
faster than 216 kmph. With what angle of inertia 1 kg m2 when rotating about
should the road be tilted? By what height one of its diameters. It is molten and
will its outer edge be, with respect to the remoulded into a thin uniform disc of the
inner edge if the track is 10 m wide? same radius. How much will its moment
[Ans: tan 1 ( 5) 78.69 o ,h 9.8 m ] of inertia be, when rotated about its own
15. The road in the question 14 above is axis.
constructed as per the requirements. The [Ans: 1 kg m2]
coefficient of static friction between the 20. A big dumb-bell is prepared by using a
tyres of a vehicle on this road is 0.8, will uniform rod of mass 60 g and length 20
there be any lower speed limit? By how cm. Two identical solid spheres of mass
much can the upper speed limit exceed in 50 g and radius 10 cm each are at the
this case? two ends of the rod. Calculate moment
[Ans: vmin ≅ 88kmph , no upper limit as of inertia of the dumb-bell when rotated
the road is banked for 45o ] about an axis passing through its centre
16. During a stunt, a cyclist (considered to and perpendicular to the length.
be a particle) is undertaking horizontal [Ans: 24000 g cm-2]
circles inside a cylindrical well of 21. A flywheel used to prepare earthenware
radius 6.05 m. If the necessary friction pots is set into rotation at 100 rpm. It is
coefficient is 0.5, how much minimum in the form of a disc of mass 10 kg and
speed should the stunt artist maintain? radius 0.4 m. A lump of clay (to be taken
Mass of the artist is 50 kg. If she/he equivalent to a particle) of mass 1.6 kg
increases the speed by 20%, how much falls on it and adheres to it at a certain
will the force of friction be? distance x from the centre. Calculate x if
[Ans: vmin = 11 m/s, = = 500N ]
f s mg the wheel now rotates at 80 rpm.
17. A pendulum consisting of a massless 1
=
[Ans: x = m 0.35 m ]
string of length 20 cm and a tiny bob 8
of mass 100 g is set up as a conical 22. Starting from rest, an object rolls down
pendulum. Its bob now performs 75 rpm. along an incline that rises by 3 in every
Calculate kinetic energy and increase in 5 (along it). The object gains a speed of
the gravitational potential energy of the 5
10 m/s as it travels a distance of
bob. (Use 2 10 ) 3
[Ans: cos 0.8, K.E. = 0.45 J, m along the incline. What can be the
P.E 0.04 J] possible shape/s of the object?
K2
18. A motorcyclist (as a particle) is [Ans: 2 = 1. Thus, a ring or
undergoing vertical circles inside R
a sphere of death. The speed of the a hollow cylinder]
25
2. Mechanical Properties of Fluids
A fluid flows under the action of a force
Can you recall?
or a pressure gradient. Behaviour of a fluid
1. How important are fluids in our life? in motion is normally complicated. We can
2. What is atmospheric pressure? understand fluids by making some simple
3. Do you feel excess pressure while assumptions. We introduce the concept of an
swimming under water? Why? ideal fluid to understand its behaviour. An
ideal fluid has the following properties:
2.1 Introduction: 1. It is incompressible: its density is constant.
In XIth Std. we discussed the behaviour of 2. Its flow is irrotational: its flow is smooth,
solids under the action of a force. Among three there are no turbulences in the flow.
states of matter, i.e., solid, liquid and gas, a 3. It is nonviscous: there is no internal friction
solid nearly maintains its fixed shape and in the flow, i.e., the fluid has no viscosity.
volume even if a large force is applied to it. (viscosity is discussed in section 2.6.1)
Liquids and gases do not have their own shape 4. Its flow is steady: its velocity at each point
and they take the shape of the containing is constant in time.
vessel. Due to this, liquids and gases flow under It is important to understand the difference
the action of external force. A fluid means a between a solid and a fluid. Solids can be
substance that can flow. Therefore, liquids and subjected to shear stress (tangential stress) as
gases, collectively, are called fluids. A fluid shown in Fig. 2.1 and normal stress, as shown
either has no rigidity or its rigidity is very low. in Fig.2.2.
In our daily life, we often experience
the pressure exerted by a fluid at rest and in
motion. Viscosity and surface tension play
an important role in nature. We will try to
understand such properties in this chapter.
2.2 Fluid:
Any substance that can flow is a
fluid. A fluid is a substance that deforms Fig. 2.1: Shear stress.
continually under the action of an external
force. Fluid is a phase of matter that
includes liquids, gases and plasmas.
Do you know?
Plasma is one of the four fundamental states (a) Compressive (b) Tensile
of matter. It consists of a gas of ions, free Fig. 2.2: Normal stress.
electrons and neutral atoms.
Solids oppose the shear stress either by
We shall discuss mechanical properties developing a restoring force, which means that
of only liquids and gases in this Chapter. The the deformations are reversible, or they require
shear modulus of a fluid is zero. In simpler a certain initial stress before they deform and
words, fluids are substances which cannot start flowing. (We have studied this behavior
resist any shear force applied to them. Air, of solids (elastic behaviour) in XIth Std).
water, flour dough, toothpaste, etc., are some Ideal fluids, on the other hand, can only
common examples of fluids. Molten lava is be subjected to normal, compressive stress
also a fluid. (called pressure). Most fluids offer a very
26
weak resistance to deformation. Real fluids Figure 2.4 shows a fluid exerting normal
display viscosity and so are capable of being force on a vertical surface and Fig. 2.5 shows
subjected to low levels of shear stress. fluid exerting normal force on a horizontal
surface.
p
Ah g (Which is nearly 6 times the atmospheric
A pressure!)
p = hρg --- (2.2) 2.3.2 Atmospheric Pressure:
Thus, the pressure p due to a liquid of Earth's atmosphere is made up of a fluid,
density ρ at rest, and at a depth h below the
namely, air. It exerts a downward force due
free surface is hρg.
to its weight. The pressure due to this force
Note that the pressure dose not depend
is called atmospheric pressure. Thus, at any
on the area of the imaginary cylinder used to
point, the atmospheric pressure is the weight
derive the expression.
of a column of air of unit cross section starting
28
from that point and extending to the top of the Substituting Eq. (2.4) and Eq. (2.5) in Eq. (2.3)
atmosphere. Clearly, the atmospheric pressure we get,
is highest at the surface of the Earth, i.e., at the p2A = p1A + ρAg (x1- x2)
sea level, and decreases as we go above the p2 = p1 + ρg (x1- x2) --- (2.6)
surface as the height of the column of air above This equation can be used to find the
decreases. The atmospheric pressure at sea pressure inside a liquid (as a function of
level is called normal atmospheric pressure. depth below the liquid surface) and also the
The density of air in the atmosphere decreases atmospheric pressure (as a function of altitude
with increase in height and becomes negligible or height above the sea level).
beyond a height of about 8 km so that the
height of air column producing atmospheric
pressure at sea level can be taken to be 8 km.
The region where gas pressure is less than
the atmospheric pressure is called vacuum.
Perfect or absolute vacuum is when no matter,
i.e., no atoms or molecules are present.
Usually, vacuum refers to conditions when the
gas pressure is considerably smaller than the
atmospheric pressure.
2.3.3 Absolute Pressure and Gauge Pressure: Fig. 2.7: Pressure due to an imaginary cylinder
Consider a tank filled with water as shown of fluid.
in Fig. 2.7. Assume an imaginary cylinder of To find the pressure p at a depth h below
horizontal base area A and height x1- x2 = h. the liquid surface, let the top of an imaginary
x1 and x2 being the heights measured from a cylinder be at the surface of the liquid. Let
reference point, height increasing upwards: this level be x1. Let x2 be some point at depth h
x1 > x2. The vertical forces acting on the below the surface as shown in Fig. 2.8. Let p0
cylinder are:
be the atmospheric pressure at the surface, i.e.,
1. Force F1 acts downwards at the top surface at x1. Then, substituting x1 = 0, p1 = p0, x2 = -h,
of the cylinder, and is due to the weight of and p2 = p in Eq. (2.6) we get,
the water
column above the cylinder. p = p0+ hρg --- (2.7)
2. Force F2 acts upwards at the bottom The above equation gives the total
surface of the cylinder, and is due to the pressure, or the absolute pressure p, at a depth
water below the cylinder. h below the surface of the liquid. The total
3. The gravitational force on the water pressure p, at the depth h is the sum of:
enclosed in the cylinder is mg, where m is 1. p0, the pressure due to the atmosphere,
the mass of the water in the cylinder. As which acts on the surface of the
the water is in static equilibrium, the forces liquid, and
on the cylinder are balanced. The balance
2. hρg, the pressure due to the liquid at depth
of these forces in magnitude is written as,
h.
F2= F1+ mg --- (2.3)
p1and p2 are the pressures at the top and
bottom surfaces of the cylinder respectively
due to the fluid. Using Eq. (2.1) we can write
F1 = p1A, and F2 = p2A --- (2.4)
Also, the mass m of the water in the cylinder
can be written as,
m = density × volume = ρV
Fig. 2.8. Pressure at a depth h below the surface
∴m = ρA(x1-x2) --- (2.5) of a liquid.
29
In general, the difference between the base of the vessel B and the liquid from vessel
absolute pressure and the atmospheric pressure C would rise into the vessel B. However,
is called the gauge pressure. Using Eq. (2.7), it is never observed. Equation 2.2 tells that
gauge pressure at depth h below the liquid the pressure at a point depends only on the
surface can be written as, height of the liquid column above it. It does
p - p0 = hρg --- (2.8) not depend on the shape of the vessel. In this
Eq. (2.8) is also applicable to levels above case, height of the liquid column is the same
the liquid surface. It gives the pressure at a for all the vessels. Therefore, the pressure of
given height above a liquid surface, in terms liquid column in each vessel is the same and
of the atmospheric pressure p0 (assuming that the system is in equilibrium. That means the
the atmospheric density is uniform up to that liquid in vessel C does not rise in to vessel B.
height).
To find the atmospheric pressure at a
distance d above the liquid surface as shown
in Fig. 2.9, we substitute x1 = d, p1 = p, x2 = 0,
p2 = p0 and ρ = ρair in Eq. (2.6) we get,
p = po - dρair g --- (2.9) (a) (b)
Fig. 2.10: Hydrostatic paradox.
Consider Fig. 2.10 (b). The arrows indicate
the forces exerted against the liquid by the walls
of the vessel. These forces are perpendicular to
walls of the vessel at each point. These forces
can be resolved into vertical and horizontal
components. The vertical components act in
the upward direction. Weight of the liquid in
Fig. 2.9: Change of atmospheric pressure
section B is not balanced and contibutes the
with height. pressure at the base. Thus, it is no longer a
paradox!
Can you tell?
2.3.5 Pascal’s Law:
The figures show three containers filled Pascal’s law states that the pressure
with the same oil. How will the pressures at applied at any point of an enclosed fluid at
the reference line compare? rest is transmitted equally and undiminished to
every point of the fluid and also on the walls of
the container, provided the effect of gravity is
neglected.
(a) (b) (c)
Experimental proof of Pascal’s principle.
2.3.4 Hydrostatic Paradox:
Consider a vessel with four arms A, B, C,
Consider the inter connected vessels and D fitted with frictionless, water tight
as shown in Fig. 2.10 (a). When a liquid is pistons and filled with incompressible fluid
poured in any one of the vessels, it is noticed as shown in the figure given. Let the area of
that the level of liquids in all the vessels is the cross sections of A, B, C, and D be a, 2a, 3a,
same. This observation is somewhat puzzling. and a/2 respectively. If a force F is applied
It was called 'hydrostatics paradox' before on the piston A, the pressure exerted on the
the principle of hydrostatics were completely liquid is p = F/a. It is observed that the other
understood. three pistons B, C, and D move outward.
One can feel that the pressure of the base In order to keep these three pistons B, C,
of the vessel C would be more than that at the
30
transmitted undiminished to the bigger piston
and D in their original positions, forces 2F,
S2. A force F2 = pA2 will be exerted upwards
3F, and F/2 respectively are required to be
on it.
applied on the pistons. Therefore, pressure
A
on the pistons B, C, and D is: F2 F1 2 --- (2.10)
A1
Thus, F2 is much larger than F1. A heavy
load can be placed on S2 and can be lifted up
or moved down by applying a small force on
S1. This is the principle of a hydraulic lift.
38
T3 = Force due to surface tension at the air- Table 2.2 – Angle of contact for pair of
liquid interface. liquid - solid in contact.
As the force due to surface tension is Sr. Liquid - solid in contact Angle of
tangential to the surfaces in contact, directions No. contact
of T1, T2 and T3 are as shown in the Fig. 2.20.
1 Pure water and clean glass 0°
For equilibrium of the drop,
T T 2 Chloroform with clean 00
T2 T1 T3 cos , cos 2 1 --- (2.18) glass
T3
From this equation we get the following cases: 3 Organic liquids with clean 00
1) If T2 > T1 and (T2-T1) < T3, cos θ is positive glass
and the angle of contact θ is acute as 4 Ether with clean glass 160
shown in Fig. 2.20 (a). 5 Kerosene with clean glass 260
6 Water with paraffin 1070
7 Mercury with clean glass 1400
2.4.4 Effect of impurity and temperature on
surface tension:
Solid a) Effect of impurities:
i) When soluble substance such as common
Fig. 2.20 (a): Acute angle. salt (i.e., sodium chloride) is dissolved
2) If T2 < T1 and (T1 – T2) < T3, cos θ is in water, the surface tension of water
negative, and the angle of contact θ is increases.
obtuse as shown in Fig. 2.20(b). ii) When a sparingly soluble substance such
as phenol or a detergent is mixed with
water, surface tension of water decreases.
For example, a detergent powder is mixed
with water to wash clothes. Due to this,
the surface tension of water decreases and
water makes good contact with the fabric
Fig. 2.20 (b): Obtuse angle. and is able to remove tough stains.
iii) When insoluble impurity is added
3) If (T2 – T1) = T3, cos θ = 1 and θ is nearly
into water, surface tension of water
equal to zero.
decreases. When impurity gets added
4) If (T2 – T1) >T3 or T2> (T1 + T3), cosθ > 1
to any liquid, the cohesive force of that
which is impossible. The liquid spreads
over the solid surface and drop will not be liquid decreases which affects the angle
formed. of contact and hence the shape of the
c) Factors affecting the angle of contact: meniscus. If mercury gathers dust then
The value of the angle of contact depends on its surface tension is reduced. It does not
the following factors, form spherical droplets unless the dust is
i) The nature of the liquid and the solid in completely removed.
contact. b) Effect of temperature: In most liquids,
ii) Impurity : Impurities present in the liquid as temperature increases surface tension
change the angle of contact. decreases. For example, it is suggested that
iii) Temperature of the liquid : Any increase new cotton fabric should be washed in cold
in the temperature of a liquid decreases its water. In this case, water does not make good
angle of contact. For a given solid-liquid contact with the fabric due to its higher surface
surface, the angle of contact is constant at tension. The fabric does not lose its colour
a given temperature. because of this.
39
Hot water is used to remove tough stains
on fabric because of its lower surface tension.
In the case of molten copper or molten
cadmium, the surface tension increases with
increase in its temperature.
The surface tension of a liquid becomes
zero at critical temperature.
Fig. 2.21 (b) : Convex surface.
2.4.5 Excess pressure across the free surface
of a liquid: downward force f A . This develops greater
Every molecule on a liquid surface pressure at point B, which is inside the liquid
experiences forces due to surface tension and on the concave side of the meniscus. Thus,
which are tangential to the liquid surface at the pressure on the concave side i.e., inside the
rest. The direction of the resultant force of liquid is greater than that on the convex side
surface tension acting on a molecule on the i.e., outside the liquid.
liquid surface depends upon the shape of that c) Concave liquid surface:
liquid surface. This force also contributes in
deciding the pressure at a point just below the
surface of a liquid.
Figures 2.21 (a), (b) and (c) show surfaces
of three liquids with different shapes and their
menisci. Let f A be the downward force due to
the atmospheric pressure. All the three figures
show two molecules A and B. The molecule A Fig. 2.21 (c): Concave Surface.
is just above, and the molecule B is just below Surface of the liquid in the Fig. 2.21 (c)
it (inside the liquid). Level difference between is upper concave (concave, when seen from
A and B is almost zero, so that it does not above). In this case, the force due to surface
f
tension T , on the molecule
at B is vertically
contribute anything to the pressure difference.
f
upwards. The force A due to atmospheric
In all the three figures, the pressure at the point
f
pressure acts downwords. Forces A and T f
A is the atmospheric pressure p.
a) Plane liquid surface: thus, act in opposite direction. Therefore,
Figure 2.21 (a) shows planar free surface the net downward force responsible
for the
f
pressure at B is less than A . This develops a
of the liquid. In this case,
the resultant force
due to surface tension, f lesser pressure at point B, which is inside the
T on the molecule at B
liquid and on the convex side of the meniscus.
is zero. The force f A itself decides the pressure
Thus, the pressure on the concave side i.e.,
and the pressure at A and B is the same.
outside the liquid, is greater than that on the
convex side, i.e., inside the liquid.
2.4.6 Explanation of formation of drops and
bubbles:
Liquid drops and small bubbles are
spherical in shape because the forces of surface
tension dominate the gravitational force.
Fig. 2.21 (a): Plane surface.
b) Convex liquid surface: These force always try to minimize the surface
Surface of the liquid in the Fig.2.21 (b) area of the liquid. A bubble or drop does not
is upper convex. (Convex, when seen from collapse because the resultant of the external
above). In this case, the resultant force due pressure and the force of surface tension is
to surface tension, f T on the molecule at B smaller than the pressure inside a bubble or
is vertically downwards and adds up to the inside a liquid drop.
40
Consider a spherical drop as shown in surface and the outer surface. For a bubble,
Fig. 2.22. Let pi be the pressure inside the drop Eq. (2.19) charges to dA = 2(8πr∆r). Hence, total
and p0 be the pressure out side it. As the drop is increase in the surface area of a soap bubble,
spherical in shape, the pressure, pi, inside the while increasing its radius by ∆r, is 2(8πr∆r)
drop is greater than p0, the pressure outside. The work done by this excess pressure is
Therefore, the excess pressure inside the drop dW = (pi – p0) 4πr 2∆r = T(16πr∆r)
is pi- p0. 4T
∴ (pi – p0) = --- (2.24)
r
Remember this
The gravitational force acting on a
molecule, which is its weight, is also one
of the forces acting within the sphere of
influence near the contact region. However,
Fig. 2.22. Excess pressure inside a liquid drop. within the sphere of influence, the cohesive
Let the radius of the drop increase from and adhesive forces are so strong that the
r to r + ∆r, where ∆r is very small, so that gravitational force can be neglected in the
the pressure inside the drop remains almost
above explanation.
constant.
Let the initial surface area of the drop be Brain teaser:
A1 = 4πr 2, and the final surface area of the 1. Can you suggest any method to measure
drop be A2 = 4π (r+∆r)2. the surface tension of a soap solution?
∴ A2 = 4π(r2 + 2r∆r + ∆r 2) Will this method have any commercial
∴ A2 = 4πr2 + 8πr∆r + 4π∆r 2 application?
As ∆r is very small, ∆r 2 can be neglected, 2. What happens to surface tension under
∴ A = 4πr 2 + 8πr∆r different gravity (e.g. Space station or
2
Thus, increase in the surface area of the drop is lunar surface)?
dA = A2 – A1 = 8πr∆r --- (2.19)
Work done in increasing the surface area Example 2.6: What should be the diameter
by dA is stored as excess surface energy. of a water drop so that the excess pressure
∴ dW = TdA= T (8πr∆r) --- (2.20) inside it is 80 N/m2? (Surface tension of
This work done is also equal to the product water = 7.27 × 10-2 N/m)
of the force F which causes increase in the area Solution: Given
of the bubble and the displacement ∆r which is pi – po = 80 N/m2
the increase in the radius of the bubble. T = 7.27 × 10-2 N/m
∴ dW = F∆r --- (2.21) We have,
2T
The excess force is given by, (pi – po) =
r
(Excess pressure) × (Surface area) 2T 2 7.27 10 2
∴ F = (pi – p0) 4πr 2 --- (2.22) ∴ r = 1.8 10 3 m
pi po 80
Equating Eq. (2.20) and Eq. (2.21), we get,
T(8πr∆r) = (pi – p0) 4πr 2∆r ∴ d = 2r = 3.6 mm
2T 2.4.7 Capillary Action:
∴ (pi – p0) = --- (2.23)
r A tube having a very fine bore ( ~ 1 mm)
This equation gives the excess pressure and open at both ends is called a capillary
inside a drop. This is called Laplace’s law of a tube. If one end of a capillary tube is dipped in
spherical membrane. a liquid which partially or completely wets the
In case of a soap bubble there are two surface of the capillary (like water in glass)
free surfaces in contact with air, the inner the level of liquid in the capillary rises. On the
41
other hand, if the capillary tube is dipped in than that on the convex side.
a liquid which does not wet its surface (like ∴ pB > pA
mercury in glass) the level of liquid in the As the points A and C are at the same level, the
capillary drops. pressure at both these points is the same, and it
The phenomenon of rise or fall of a liquid is the atmospheric pressure.
inside a capillary tube when it is dipped in the ∴pA = pC --- (2.25)
liquid is called capillarity. Capillarity is in Between the points C and D, the surface is
action when, plane.
• Oil rises up the wick of a lamp. ∴ pC = pD= pA --- (2.26)
• Cloth rag sucks water. ∴ pB > pD. But the points B and D are at the
• Water rises up the crevices in rocks. same horizontal level. Thus, in order to
• Sap and water rise up to the top most maintain the same pressure, the mercury in the
leaves in a tree. capillary rushes out of the capillary. Because
• Blotting paper absorbs ink. of this, there is a drop in the level of mercury
When a capillary is dipped in a liquid, inside the capillary as shown in Fig. 2.23 (b).
two effects can be observed, a) The liquid
level can rise in the capillary (water in a glass
capillary), or b) The liquid level can fall in the
capillary (mercury in glass capillary). Here we
discuss a qualitative argument to explain the
capillary fall.
a) Capillary fall:
Fig. 2.23 (b): Capillary in mercury, drop in level.
Consider a capillary tube dipped in a
b) Capillary rise:
liquid which does not wet the surface, for
Refer to Fig. 2.24 (a) and Fig. 2.24 (b) and
example, in mercury. The shape of mercury
explain the rise of a liquid inside a capillary.
meniscus in the capillary is upper convex.
Consider the points A, B, C, and D such that,
(see Fig. 2.23 (a)).
i) Point A is just above the convex surface
and inside the capillary.
ii) Point B is just below the convex surface
inside the capillary.
iii) Point C is just above the plane surface
Fig. 2.24 (a): Capillary just immersed in water.
outside the capillary.
iv) Point D is just below the plane surface
and outside the capillary, and below the
point C.
44
less than 1000, the flow of a fluid is streamline
while for Rn greater than 2000, the flow of
fluid is turbulent. When Rn is between 1000
and 2000, the flow of fluid becomes unsteady,
i.e., it changes from a streamline flow to a
turbulent flow.
Fig. 2.27 (a): Streamline flow. 2.6.1 Viscosity:
When we pour water from a glass, it flows
freely and quickly. But when we pour syrup
or honey, it flows slowly and sticks to the
container. The difference is due to fluid friction.
This friction is both within the fluid itself and
between the fluid and its surroundings. This
Fig. 2.27 (b): Turbulent flow.
property of fluids is called viscosity. Water
Can you tell? has low viscosity, whereas syrup or honey has
high viscosity. Figure 2.28 shows a schematic
What would happen if two streamlines section of viscous flow and Fig. 2.29 that of a
intersect? non viscous flow. Note that there is no dragging
force in the non-viscous flow, and all layers are
Activity moving with the same velocity.
46
2.7 Stokes’ Law:
to plate X. If there are no external forces
In 1845, Sir George Gabriel Stokes (1819-
applied, this momentum transfer would
1903) stated the law which gives the viscous
reduce speed of the plate Y to zero with
force acting on a spherical object falling
respect to the plate X.
through a viscous medium (see Fig. 2.31).
Reduction in the velocity of the
molecules in the direction of laminar flow
is due to the fact that their directions after
collision are random. This randomness, to be
discussed in Chapter 3, results in an increase
in the thermal energy of the fluid at the cost
of its macrosopic kinetic energy. That is, the
process is dissipative, or frictional.
In liquids there is an additional, Fig 2.31: Spherical object moving through a
stronger interaction between molecules in viscous medium.
adjacent layers, due to the intermolecular The law states that, “The viscous force
forces that distinguish liquid from gases. (Fv) acting on a small sphere falling through
As a result, there is a transfer of momentum a viscous medium is directly proportional
from faster-moving layers to slower-moving to the radius of the sphere (r), its velocity
layers, which results in a viscous drag. (v) through the fluid, and the coefficient of
viscosity (η) of the fluid”.
Fv rv
Remember this
The empirically obtained constant of
Coefficient of viscosity of a fluid changes proportionality is 6π .
with change in its temperature. For Fv 6 rv --- (2.36)
most liquids, the coefficient of viscosity This is the expression for viscous force
decreases with increase in their temperature. acting on a spherical object moving through
a viscous medium. The above formula can be
It probably depends on the fact that at
higher temperatures, the molecules are derived using dimensional analysis.
farther apart and the cohesive forces or
Example 2.8: A steel ball with radius
inter-molecular forces are, therefore, less
effective. Whereas, in gases, the coefficient 0.3 mm is falling with velocity of 2 m/s at
of viscosity increases with the increase a time t, through a tube filled with glycerin,
in temperature. This is because, at high having coefficient of viscosity 0.833 Ns/m2.
temperatures, the molecules move faster Determine viscous force acting on the steel
and collide more often with each other, ball at that time.
giving rise to increased internal friction. Solution: Given
r = 0.3 mm = 0.3 × 10-3 m, v = 2 m/s,
Table 2.4 Coefficient of viscosity at different
temperatures. η = 0.833 Ns/m2.
Coefficient of We have, F 6 rv
Fluid Temperature Viscosity F = 6 × 3.142 × 0.833 x 0.3 × 10-3 × 2
Ns/m2 Therefore, F = 9.422 × 10-3 N
00C 0.017 x 10-3 2.7.1 Terminal Velocity:
Air
40 C
0
0.019 x 10-3 Consider a spherical object falling
200C 1 x 10-3 through a viscous fluid. Forces experienced by
Water
100 C
0
0.3 x 10-3 it during its downward motion are,
Machine 160C 0.113 x 10-3 1. Viscous force (Fv), directed upwards.
oil 380C 0.034 x 10-3 Its magnitude goes on increasing with
increase in its velocity.
47
2. Gravitational force, or its weight (Fg), This is the expression for the terminal velocity
directed downwards, and of the sphere. From Eq. (2.37) we can also write,
3. Buoyant force or upthrust (Fu), directed 2 r g
2
9 v
48
Av is the volume rate of flow of a fluid,
i.e.,
dV dV
Av = . The quantity is the volume
dt dt
of a fluid per unit time passing through any
Fig. 2.33: Steady
cross section of the tube of flow. It is called
flow fluid.
the volume flux. Similarly, ρdV/dt =dm/dt is
called mass flux.
Equation (2.40) is called the equation of
less space) to accommodate particles behind continuity in fluid dynamics. The continuity
it hence its velocity increases. When a particle equation says that the volume rate of flow of
enters a wider section, it slows down because an incompressible fluid for a steady flow is
there is more space. Because the fluid is the same throughout the flow.
incompressible, the particles moves faster
through a narrow section and slow down while Do you know?
moving through wider section. If the fluid does
When water is released from a dam, the
not move faster in a narrow regain, it will be
amount of water is mentioned in terms of
compressed to fit into the narrow space.
Thousand Million Cubic feet (TMC). One
Consider a tube of flow as shown in
TMC is 109 cubic feet of water per second.
Fig. 2.33. All the fluid that passes through
Basic unit of measuring flow is cusec. One
a tube of flow must pass through any cross
cusec is one cubic feet per sec (28.317 lit
section that cuts the tube of flow. We know per sec).
that all the fluid is confined to the tube of flow.
Fluid can not leave the tube or enter the tube. Example 2.11: As shown in the given figure,
Consider section A1 and A2 located at a piston of cross sectional area 2 cm2 pushes
points A and B respectively as shown in the liquid out of a tube whose area at the
Fig. 2.33. Matter is neither created nor outlet is 40 mm2. The piston is pushed at a
destroyed within the tube enclosed between rate of 2 cm/s. Determine the speed at which
section A1 and A2. Therefore, the mass of the the fluid leaves the tube.
fluid within this region is constant over time.
That means, if mass m of the fluid enters the
section A1 then equal mas of fluid should leave
the section A2.
Let the speed of the fluid which crosses
the section EFGH at point A in time interval Solution: Given,
∆t be v1. Thus, the volume of the fluid entering A1 = 2 cm2 = 2 × 10-4 m2
the tube through the cross section at point A v1 = 2 cm/s = 2 × 10-2 m/s
is ρA1v1∆t. Similarly, let the speed of the fluid A2 = 40 mm2 = 40 × 10-6 m2
be v2 at point B. The fluid crosses the section From equation of continuity, A1v1 = A2v2
PQRS of area A2 in time interval ∆t. Thus, the Therefore,
A v 2 10 4 2 10 2
mass of the fluid leaving the tube through the v 2 1 1 0.1m / s
cross section at B is ρA2v2∆t. A2 40 10 6
As fluid is incompressible, the mass of the
fluid entering the tube at point A is the same as
Use your brain power
the mass leaving the tube at B.
Mass of the fluid in section EFGH = mass A water pipe with a diameter of 5.0 cm is
of fluid in section PQRS connected to another pipe of diameter 2.5
ρA1v1∆t = ρA2v2∆t --- (2.39) cm. How would the speeds of the water flow
A1v1 = A2v2 or, Av = constant --- (2.40) compare?
49
surrounding fluid is equal to the sum of the
Do you know? change in the kinetic energy and the change in
the gravitational potential energy.
1. How does an aeroplane take off? Figure 2.34 shows flow of an ideal fluid
2. Why do racer cars and birds have typical through a tube of varying cross section and
shape? height. Consider an element of fluid that lies
3. Have you experienced a sideways jerk between cross sections P and R.
while driving a two wheller when a Let,
heavy vehicle overtakes you? • v1 and v2 be the speed the fluid at the lower
4. Why does dust get deposited only on one
end P and the upper end R respectively.
side of the blades of a fan?
• A1 and A2 be the cross section area of the
5. Why helmets have specific shape?
fluid at the lower end P and the upper end
2.9 Bernoulli Equation: R respectively.
On observing a river, we notice that the • p1 and p2 be the pressures of the fluid at the
speed of the water decreases in wider region lower end P and the upper R respectively.
whereas the speed of water increases in the • d1 and d2 be the distances travelled by the
regions where the river is narrow. From this fluid at the lower and P and the upper and
we might think that the pressure in narrower R during the time interval dt with velocities
regions is more than that in the wider region. v1 and v2 respectively.
However, the pressure within the fluid in the • p1 A1 and p2 A2 be the forces acting on the
narrower parts is less while that in wider parts equation of continuity, (Eq. 2.40), the
is more. volume dV of the fluid passing through any
Swiss scientist Daniel Bernoulli (1700- cross section during time interval dt is the
1782), while experimenting with fluid inside same; i.e.,
pipes led to the discovery of the concept dV = A1d1 = A2d2 --- (2.41)
mentioned above. He observed, in his There is no internal friction in the fluid as
experiment, that the speed of a fluid in a narrow the fluid is ideal. In practice also, for a fluid like
region increases but the internal pressure of a water, the loss in energy due to viscous force is
fluid in the same narrow region decreases. This negligible. So the only non-gravitational force
phenomenon is called Bernoulli’s principle. that does work on the fluid element is due to the
pressure of the surrounding fluid. Therefore,
the net work, W, done on the element by the
surrounding fluid during the flow from P to R
is,
W = p1A1d1 – p2A2d2
The second term in the above equation has
a negative sign because the force at R opposes
the displacement of the fluid. From Eq. (2.41)
the above equation can be written as,
W = p1dV – p2dV
Fig. 2.34: Flow of fluid through a tube of ∴ W = (p1-p2) dV --- (2.42)
varying cross section and height. As the work W is due to forces other than
Bernoulli’s equation relates the speed of a the conservative force of gravity, it equals the
fluid at a point, the pressure at that point and change in the total mechanical energy i.e.,
the height of that point above a reference level. kinetic energy plus gravitational potential
It is an application of work – energy theorem energy associated with the fluid element.
for a fluid in flow. While deriving Bernoulli’s i.e., W = ∆K.E. + ∆P.E. --- (2.43)
equation, we will prove that the net work The mechanical energy for the fluid
done on a fluid element by the pressure of the between sections Q and R does not change.
50
At the beginning of the time interval
dt, the mass and the kinetic energy A different way of interpreting the
Bernoulli’s equation:
of the fluid between P and Q is, ρ 1
A1d1, and
1
A1d1 v12 respectively. At
p1 p2 v 22 v12 g h2 h1
2
2 Dimensionally, pressure is energy per unit
the end of the time interval dt, the kinetic volume. Both terms on the right side of the
energy of the fluid between section R and S is above equation have dimensions of energy
1 per unit volume. Hence, quite often, the
A2 d2 v 22 . Therefore, the net change in the left side is referred to as pressure energy
2 per unit volume. The left side of equation
kinetic energy, ∆K.E., during time interval dt is called pressure head. The first term on
is, the right side is called the velocity head
1 1 and the second term is called the potential
∆K.E. = A2 d2 v 2 A1d1 v1
2 2
2 2 head.
1 1 In other words, the Bernoulli’s principle
∆K.E. = 2 dVv 2 2 dVv1
2 2
is thus consistent with the principle of
conservation of energy.
1
2
∆K.E. = dV v 2 v1
2
2
--- (2.44) Example 2.12: The given figure shows a
Also, at the beginning of the time interval streamline flow of a non-viscous liquid
dt, the gravitational potential energy of the having density 1000 kg/m3. The cross
mass m between P and Q is mgh1 = ρdVgh1. sectional area at point A is 2 cm2 and at
At the end of the interval dt, the gravitational point B is 1 cm2. The speed of liquid at the
potential energy of the mass m between R and point A is 5 cm/s. Both points A and B are
S is mgh2 = ρdVgh2. Therefore, the net change at the same horizontal level. Calculate the
in the gravitational potential energy, ∆P.E., difference in pressure at A and B.
during time interval dt is,
∆P.E. = ρdVgh2 - ρdVgh1
∆P.E. = ρdVg (h2- h1) --- (2.45) Solution: Given,
Substituting Eq. (2.42), (2.44) and (2.45) in ρ = 1000 kg/m3, A1 = 2 cm2 = 2 × 10-2 m2
Eq. (2.43) we get, A2 = 1 cm2 = 10-2 m2, v1 = 5 cm/s = 5 × 10-2
1 m/s and h1= h2
p1 p2 dV dV v 22 v12
2
From the equation of continuity,
A1v1 = A2v2
dVg h2 h1
Av 2 = 10 m/s
v 2 1 1 = 2 5 10
1
2
p1 p2 v 22 v12 A2 10 2
By Bernoulli’s equation,
g h2 h1 1
--- (2.46)
2
p1 p2 dV dV v 22 v12
This is Bernoulli’s equation. It states that
the work done per unit volume of a fluid by dVg h2 h1
the surrounding fluid is equal to the sum of (since, h2 h1 0 )
the changes in kinetic and potential energies 1
per unit volume that occur during the flow. p1 p2 dV dV v 22 v12
2
Equation (2.46) can also be written as,
1
1 1
p1 v12 gh1 p2 v22 gh2 ---(2.47) 1000 100 0.0025
2 2 2
= 500 × 99.99
1 2 p1 - p2 = 49998.75, Pa = 4.99 × 105 Pa
or, p v gh constant --- (2.48)
2
51
A 2
Use your brain power 1 2 v 22 2gh
Does the Bernoulli’s equation change when A1
the fluid is at rest? How? If A2<<A1, the above equation reduces to,
Applications of Bernoulli’s equation: v 2 = 2 gh --- (2.50)
a) Speed of efflux: This is the equation of the speed of a
The word efflux means fluid out flow. liquid flowing out through an orifice at a depth
Torricelli discovered that the speed of efflux ‘h’ below the free surface. It is the same as that
from an open tank is given by a formula of a particle falling freely through the height
identical to that of a freely falling body. ‘h’ under gravity.
Example 2.13: Doors of a dam are 20 m
below the surface of water in the dam. If
one door is opened, what will be the speed
of the water that flows out of the door?
(g = 9.8 m/s2)
Solution: Given, h = 20 m
From Toricelli’s law,
v = 2gh = 2 ×9.8 ×20 = 392
= 19.79 m/s
Fig. 2.35: Efflux of fluid from an orifice.
Consider a liquid of density ‘ρ’ filled in a b) Ventury tube:
tank of large cross-sectional area A1 having an A ventury tube is used to measure the
orifice of cross-sectional area A2 at the bottom speed of flow of a fluid in a tube. It has a
as shown in Fig. 2.35. Let A2<<A1. The liquid constriction in the tube. As the fluid passes
flows out of the tank through the orifice. Let through the constriction, its speed increases
v1 and v2 be the speeds of the liquid at A1 and in accordance with the equation of continuity.
A2 respectively. As both, inlet and outlet, are The pressure thus decreases as required by the
exposed to the atmosphere, the pressure at Bernoulli equation.
these position equals the atmosphere pressure
p0. If the height of the free surface above the
orifice is h, Bernoulli’s equation gives us,
1 1
p0 v12 gh p0 v 22 --- (2.49)
2 2
Using equation the of continuity we can write,
A Fig. 2.36: Ventury tube.
v1 = 2 v 2
A1 The fluid of density ρ flows through the
Substituting v1 in Eq.(2.49) we get, Ventury tube. The area of cross section is A1
2 at wider part and A2 at the constriction. Let the
1 A2 2 1 speeds of the fluid at A1 and A2 be v1 and v2,
v 2 gh v 22
2 A1 2 and the pressures, be p1 and p2 respectively.
2 From Bernoulli’s equation,
A2 2 1 1
v 2 2 gh v 2
2
p1 v12 p2 v 22
A
1 2 2
1
p1 p2 v 22 v12 --- (2.51)
2
A
2 gh v 2 v 22
2
2 2
A1 Figure 2.36 shows two vertical tubes connected
52
to the Ventury tube at A1 and A2. If the difference that below the wings increases. Due to this
in height of the liquid levels in the tubes is h, pressure difference, an upward force called the
we have, dynamic lift acts on the bottom of the wings of
p1 p2 ) gh a plane. When this force becomes greater than
the weight of aeroplane, the aeroplane takes
Substituting above equation in Eq. (2.51) we
off.
get,
d) Working of an atomizer:
2 gh v 22 v12 --- (2.52)
From the equation of continuity, A1v1 = A2v2,
substituting v1 in terms of v2 or vice versa in
Eq. (2.52) the rate of flow of liquid passing
through a cross section can be calculated by Fig. 2.38: Atomizer.
knowing the areas A1and A2.
The action of the carburetor of an
Example 2.13: Water flows through a automobile engine, paint-gun, scent-spray
tube as shown in the given figure. Find the or insect-sprayer is based on the Bernoulli’s
difference in mercury level, if the speed of principle. In all these, a tube T is dipped in a
flow of water at point A is 2 m/s and at point liquid as shown in Fig. 2.38. Air is blown at
B is 5 m/s. (g = 9.8 m/s) high speed over the tip of this tube with the help
Solution: Given, v1 = 2 m/s, v2 = 5 m/s of a piston P in the cylinder C. This high speed
We have, air creates low pressure over the tube, due to
2gh = v 22 −v12 which the liquid rises in it and is then blown off
therefore, in very small droplets with expelled air.
v 2 −v 2 25 4 21 e) Blowing off of roofs by stormy wind:
h= 2 1 = = 19.6 = 1.07 m
2g 2 9.8
c) Lifting up of an aeroplane:
Fig. 2.39: Airflow along a roof.
When high speed, stormy wind blows
over a roof top, it causes low pressure p above
the roof in accordance with the Bernoulli’s
principle. However, the air below the roof
(i.e. inside the room) is still at the atmospheric
Fig. 2.37: Airflow along an aerofoil. pressure p0. So, due to this difference in
The shape of cross section of wings pressure, the roof is lifted up and is then blown
of an aeroplane is as shown in Fig. 2.37. off by the wind as shown in Fig. 2.39.
When an aeroplane runs on a runway, due to
aerodynamic shape of its wings, the streamlines Observe and discuss
of air are crowded above the wings compared
to those below the wings. Thus, the air above Observe the shape of blades of a fan and
the wings moves faster than that below the discuss the nature of the air flow when fan
wings. According to the Bernoulli’s principle, is switched on.
the pressure above the wings decreases and
53
Internet my friend
5. https://opentextbc.ca/physicstestbook2/
1. http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
chapter/viscosity-and-laminar-flow-
hbase/pfric.html
poiseuilles-law/
2. https://opentextbc.ca/physicstestbook2/
6. http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
chapter/chapter-1/
hbase/html
3. https://opentextbc.ca/physicstestbook2/
7. http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
chapter/pressure/
hbase/pascon.html
4. https://opentextbc.ca/physicstestbook2/
8. http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
chapter/bernoullis-equation/
hbase/fluid.html#flucon
Exercises
55
3. Kinetic Theory of Gases and Radiation
Here, proportionality constant R is the
Can you recall?
universal gas constant, having the same
1. What are different states of matter? value 8.314 J mol-1 K-1, for all the gases, N is
2. How do you distinguish between solid, the number of molecules in the gas and NA is
liquid and gaseous states? the Avogadro number and is the number of
3. What are gas laws? molecules in one mole of gas.
4. What is absolute zero temperature? Alternatively,
5. What is Avogadro number? What is a PV = NkBT, --- (3.4)
mole? where kB is the Boltznann constant. R and
6. How do you get ideal gas equation from kB are related by the following relation:
the gas laws? R = NA kB --- (3.5)
7. How is ideal gas different from real The laws of Boyle, Charles, and Gay-
gases? Lussac are strictly valid for real gases, only
8. What is elastic collision of particles? if the pressure of the gas is not too high and
9. What is Dalton's law of partial pressures? the temperature is not close to the liquefaction
3.1. Introduction: temperature of the gas.
You have been introduced to the three A gas obeying the equation of state
common states of matter viz. solid, liquid PV = nRT at all pressures, and temperatures is
and gas. You have also studied the gas laws: an ideal gas.
Boyle's law, Charles' law, and Gay-Lussac's
law. The ideal gas equation can be obtained Equation of State: For a gas, its state is
from the three gas laws. specified by a number of physical quantities
The volume V of a gas is inversely such as pressure P, temperature T, volume
proportional to the pressure P, temperature V, internal energy E, etc. Hence, the
being held constant. Separately, volume V equation relating these quantities is known
and pressure P are directly proportional to as the equation of state.
temperature. In a nut shell, 3.2 Behaviour of a Gas:
Boyle's law: V ∝ 1/P at constant T --- (3.1) A stone thrown upwards in air reaches
Charles' law V ∝ T at constant P --- (3.2) a certain height and falls back to the ground.
Gay-Lussac's law: P ∝ T at constant V--- (3.3)
Its motion can be described well with the
All the three laws apply to fixed mass m
of an enclosed gas. help of Newton's laws of motion. A gas
Combining the three laws into a single enclosed in a container is characterized by its
relation for a fixed mass of gas yields ideal pressure, volume and, temperature. This is the
gas equation. Thus, macroscopic description of the gas. You know
PV P V that the particles of the gas (molecules) are in
PV ∝ T, or 1 1 = 2 2
T1 T2 constant motion. Unlike in the case of motion
Expressing the fixed mass of gas in the of the stone, it is very difficult to understand
above three laws in terms of number of moles the behaviour of a gas in terms of motion of
n of gas, PV ∝ nT, or PV = nRT, a single particle (molecule). The number of
where number of moles particles in the gas is itself so large (∼ 1023
mass of the gas ( M ) N particles per m3) that any attempt to relate the
= n =
molar mass ( M 0 ) NA macroscopic parameters P, V, T and E with the
(Molar mass is the mass of 1 mole of gas) motion of individual particles would be futile.
56
Hence, certain assumptions are made
regarding the particles (molecules) of a gas,
averages of physical quantities over the large
number of particles involved are obtained
and these averages are finally related to the
macroscopic parameters of the gas. This is the
approach of kinetic theory of gases. Fig. 3.1 (a): A gas with Fig. 3.1 (b): A typical
3.3 Ideal Gas and Real Gas: molecules dispersed in molecule in a gas
We know that a gas obeying ideal gas the container: A stop executing random
action photograph. motion.
equation at all pressures and temperatures is
The molecules of a gas are uniformly
an ideal gas. In an ideal gas intermolecular
interactions are absent. Real gases are dispersed throughout the volume of the gas
composed of atoms or molecules which do as shown in Fig 3.1(a). These molecules are
interact with each other. Hence, no real gas executing random motion. Typical path of
is truly ideal as defined here. If the atoms/ a molecule is shown in Fig. 3.1 (b). When
molecules of a real gas are so far apart that a molecule approaches another molecule,
there is practically no interatomic/ there is a repulsive force between them, due
intermolecular interaction, the real gas is to which the molecules behave as small
said to be in the ideal state. This can happen hard spherical particles. This leads to elastic
at sufficiently low density of the real gas. collisions between the molecules. Therefore,
At low pressures or high temperatures, both the speed and the direction of motion of
the molecules are far apart and therefore
the molecules change abruptly. The molecules
molecular interactions are negligible. Under
these conditions, behaviour of real gases also collide with the walls of the container.
is close to that of an ideal gas. Of course, Molecules exert force on each other only
the temperature of the real gas must be well during collisions. Thus, in between two
above its liquefaction temperature. Ideal gas successive collisions the molecules move
serves as a model to deduce certain properties along straight paths with constant velocity. It
of real gases at least when the real gas is in is convenient and useful to define mean free
the ideal state. You have studied deviation of
path (λ), as the average distance traversed by
real gas from ideal gas behaviour in XIth Std.
Chemistry. a molecule with constant velocity between
two successive collisions. The mean free path
Can you tell? is expected to vary inversely with the density
N
1. Why is the deviation of real gas from of the gas , where N is the number of
V
ideal gas behavior observed at high molecules enclosed in a volume V. Higher the
pressure and low temperature? density, more will be the collisions and smaller
2. What is the effect of size of the will be the mean free path λ. It is also seen that
molecules of a real gas, as against the λ is inversely proportional to the size of the
ideal gas comprising point particles, on
molecule, say the diameter d. Smaller the size
the properties of the gas ?
3. Does an ideal gas exist in reality? of the molecule, less is the chance for collision
and larger is the mean free path. Further, λ is
3.4 Mean Free Path:
inversely proportional to d2, not just d, because
How do the molecules of an ideal gas
it depends on the cross section of a molecule. It
move? These molecules are in continuous
can be shown that
random motion such as Brownian motion you 1
have studied in XIth Std. Chemistry. --- (3.6)
2 d 2 ( N / V )
57
Example: 3.1 Obtain the mean free path
of nitrogen molecule at 0 °C and 1.0 atm
pressure. The molecular diameter of
nitrogen is 324 pm (assume that the gas is
ideal).
Solution: Given T = 0 °C = 273 K, P = 1.0
atm = 1.01×105 Pa and d = 324 pm = 324 ×
10-12 m.
N P Fig. 3.2: A cubical box of side L. It contains
For ideal gas PV = NkBT, ∴ = . n moles of an ideal gas. The figure shows a
V k BT molecule of mass m moving towards the
Using Eq. (3.6), mean free path shaded
1 k BT wall of the cube with velocity v .
The gas molecules are continuously
N 2 d 2 P
2 d 2 moving randomly in various directions,
V
colliding with each other and hitting the walls
1.38 10 23
J / K 273 K
of the box and bouncing back. As a first
2 324 10 m 1.01 10 Pa
2
12 5
approximation, we neglect intermolecular
collisions and consider only elastic collisions
0.8 10 7 m
Note that this is about 247 times molecular with the walls. (It is not unphysical to assume
diameter. this, because, as explained earlier, the mean
free path increases as the pressure is reduced.
If the pressure of a gas in an enclosure is Thus, pressure is so adjusted that the molecules
reduced by evacuating it, the density of do not collide with each other, but collide with
the gas decreases and the mean free path the walls). A typical molecule is shown in the
increases. You must have seen articles
Fig. 3.2 moving with the velocity v , about to
coated with metal films. The metals are
collide with the shaded wall of the cube. The
heated and evaporated in an enclosure.
wall is parallel to yz-plane. As the collision
The pressure in the enclosure is reduced
is assumed to be elastic, during collision, the
so that the mean free path of air molecules
is larger than the dimensions of the component vx of the velocity will get reversed,
enclosure. The atoms in the metal vapour keeping vy and vz components unaltered.
then do not collide with the air molecules.
Consider two dimensional elastic collision
They reach the target and get deposited.
of a particle with a wall along the y-axis
3.5 Pressure of Ideal Gas: as shown in the accompanying figure. It
We now express pressure of an ideal
can be easily seen that the vx component is
gas as a kinetic theory problem. Let there be
reversed, vy remaining unchanged.
n moles of an ideal gas enclosed in a cubical
box of volume V (= L3) with sides of the box
parallel to the coordinate axes, as shown in Fig.
3.2. The walls of the box are kept at a constant
temperature T. The question is: can we relate
the pressure P of the gas with the molecular
speeds? Here we will use the word molecular
speed rather than molecular velocity since the
kinetic energy of a molecule depends on the
velocity irrespective of its direction.
58
Considering all the molecules, their Considering other molecules 2, 3, 4 ... with
average y and z components of the velocities the respective x components of velocities vx2, vx3,
are not changed by collisions with the vx4,..., the total average force on the wall from
shaded wall. This can be understood from Eq. (3.8), is
the fact that the gas molecules remain evenly m 2
distributed throughout the volume and do not
L
v x1 v 2x 2 v 2x 3 ...
get any additional motion in +y or -y and +z ∴The average pressure
or -z directions. Thus the y and z components Average force
P
remain unchanged during collision with the Area of shaded wall
wall parallel to the yz-plane.
Hence the change in momentum of the
m v 2x1 v 2x 2 ...
particle is only in the x component of the L L2
momentum, ∆px is given by The average of the square of the x component
∆px = final momentum - initial momentum of the velocities is given by
= (-mvx) - (mvx) = - 2 mvx --- (3.7) v 2x1 v 2x 2 v 2x 3 ... v 2N
vx
2
60
Example 3.2: At 300 K, what is the rms molecule moves along a straight line, then only
speed of Helium atom? [mass of He atom is x coordinate and only one velocity component
4u, 1u = 1.66 × 10-27 kg; kB = 1.38 × 10-23 J/K] vx will be sufficient to describe its location and
Solution: Given T = 300 K, motion along a straight line.
m = 4 × 1.66 × 10-27 kg We say that the molecule is free to
1 3 execute 3, 2, and 1 dimensional translational
Average =K. E . = mv 2 k BT
2 2 23 motion in the above examples. In other words,
3k T 3 1.38 10 300
v2 B the molecule in these examples has 3, 2, and 1
m 4 1.66 10 27
degrees/degree of freedom.
187.05 10 4 Degrees of freedom of a system are
v rms v 2 13.68 10 2 defined as the total number of coordinates or
1368 m / s independent quantities required to describe
the position and configuration of the system
3.8 Law of Equipartition of Energy:
completely.
We have seen that the kinetic energy of a
3.8.2 Diatomic Molecules:
single molecule is
1 1 1
K.E. mv 2x mv 2y mv 2z
2 2 2
For a gas at a temperature T, the average kinetic
energy per molecule denoted as K . E . is
1 1 1
K .E. mv 2x mv 2y mv 2z
2 2 2
But we know that the mean energy per Fig. 3.3: The two independent axes z and y
3 of rotation of a diatomic molecule such as O2
molecule is k T. Since there is no preferred
2 B lying along the x-axis.
direction x or y or z, Monatomic gas like helium contains He
1 1 1 1
= mv 2x = mv 2y mv 2z = k BT atoms. An He atom has 3 translational degrees
2 2 2 2 of freedom (dof). Consider for example, O2 or
--- (3.19) N2 molecule with the two atoms lying along
Thus the mean energy associated with the x-axis. The molecule has 3 translational
every component of translational kinetic dof. In addition, it can rotate around z-axis and
energy which is quadratic in the velocity y-axis. Figure 3.3 depicts rotation of molecule
1
components in x, y and z directions is k BT about the z-axis. Like wise, rotation is possible
2
and therefore the total translational energy about the y-axis. (Note that rotation around
contribution of the molecule is (3/2)kBT. the x-axis is not a rotation in the sense that it
3.8.1 Degrees of Freedom: does not involve change of positions of the two
In the above discussion, the molecule atoms of the molecule). In general, a diatomic
as a whole is free to move from one point molecule can rotate about its centre of mass
to the other in the three dimensional space. in two directions that are perpendicular to
If it is restricted to move in a plane surface its molecular axis. The molecules like O2,
which is two dimensional, then only two are therefore, said to possess 2 additional
coordinates say x and y will be sufficient to dof namely 2 rotational dof. Each of these
describe its location and two components vx, 2 dof contribute to rotational kinetic energy.
vy will describe its motion in the plane. If a It can be shown that if Iz and Iy are moments
61
of inertia about z and y axes with ωz and ωy, 1
k BT . Thus each mode or dof for vibrational
the respective angular speeds, the rotational 2 1
1 1 motion contributes 2 × k BT to the total
kinetic energies will be I z ω z and I y ω y2
2
internal energy. 2
2 2
for rotation around the two axes. Thus for a Hence for a non-rigid diatomic gas in
diatomic molecule, the total energy due to thermal equilibrium at a temperature T, the
translational and rotational dof is mean kinetic energy associated with the
E = E (translational) +E (rotational) translational motion of molecule along the
1
1 1 1 three directions is 3 × k BT , the mean kinetic
mv 2x mv 2y mv 2z 2
2 2 2 energy associated with the rotational motions
1 1 --- (3.20) 1
I z z2 I y y2 about two perpendicular axes is 2 × k BT
2 2 2
The above expression contains quadratic 1
and total vibrational energy is 2 × k BT
terms that correspond to various dof of a 2
diatomic molecule. Each of them contributes corresponding to kinetic and potential energy
1 terms. Considering the above facts law of
k BT to the total energy of the molecule. In
2 equipartition of energy is stated as: for a gas
the above discussion, an implicit assumption in thermal equilibrium at a temperature T,
was made that the rotating molecule is the average energy for molecule associated
a rigid rotator. However, real molecules 1
contain covalent bonds between the atoms with each quadratic term is k BT . The
2
and therefore can perform additional motion law of equipartition of energy is valid for
namely vibrations of atoms about their mean high temperatures and not for extremely low
positions like a one-dimensional harmonic temperatures where quantum effects become
oscillator. Such molecules therefore possess important.
additional dof corresponding to the different 3.9 Specific Heat Capacity:
modes of vibration. In diatomic molecules like You know that when the temperature of
O2, N2 and CO, the atoms can oscillate along a gas is increased, even a small rise causes
the internuclear axis only. This motion adds considerable change in volume and pressure.
energy associated with the vibrations to the Therefore two specific heats are defined for
total energy of the molecule. gases, namely specific heat at constant volume
E = E (translational) +E (rotational)+ CV and specific heat at constant pressure CP.
E (vibrational) --- (3.21) Mayer’s relation gives an expression that
The term E (vibrational) consists of two connects the two specific heats.
contributions - one from the kinetic energy 3.9.1 Mayer’s Relation:
term and the other from the potential energy Consider one mole of an ideal gas that
term. is enclosed in a cylinder by light, frictionless
1 1 2
E (vibrational) mu kr --- (3.22)
2
airtight piston. Let P, V and T be the pressure,
2 2
where u is the velocity of vibrations of the volume and temperature respectively of the
atoms of the molecule, r is the separation gas. If the gas is heated so that its temperature
between the atoms performing oscillations rises by dT, but the volume remains constant,
and k is related to the force constant. The terms then the amount of heat supplied to the gas,
in Eq. (3.22) are quadratic in velocity and dQ1, is used to increase the internal energy
position respectively and each will contribute of the gas (dE). Since, volume of the gas is
constant, no work is done in moving the piston.
62
∴ dQ1 = dE = CV dT --- (3.23)
Example 3.3: Given the values of the
where CV is the molar specific heat of the gas
two principal specific heats, SP = 3400 cal
at constant volume.
kg-1 K-1 and SV = 2400 cal kg-1 K-1 for the
On the other hand, if the gas is heated to
hydrogen gas, find the value of J if the
the same temperature, at constant pressure,
universal gas constant R = 8300 J kg-1 K-1.
volume of the gas increases by an amount say
dV. The amount of heat supplied to the gas Solution: Given
is used to increase the internal energy of the SP = 3400 cal kg-1 K-1,
gas as well as to move the piston backwards SV = 2400 cal kg-1 K-1,
to allow expansion of gas (the work done to R = 8300 J kg-1 K-1.
R
move the piston dW = PdV) SP – SV = M 0 J from Eq. (3.27)
dQ2 = dE + dW = CP dT --- (3.24) 8300
where CP is the molar specific heat of the gas 3400 - 2400 = as M0 = 2 for H2 gas
2J
at constant pressure. Hence, J 8300 4.15 J / cal .
But dE = CV dT from Eq. (3.23) as the internal 2 1000
energy of an ideal gas depends only on its Example 3.4: The difference between the
temperature. two molar specific heats of a gas is 8000 J
∴ CP dT = CV dT + dW kg-1 K-1. If the ratio of the two specific heats
or, (CP – CV) dT = P dV --- (3.25) is 1.65, calculate the two molar specific
For one mole of gas, heats.
PV = RT Solution: Given
C
∴ P dV= R dT, since pressure is constant. CP – CV = 8000 J kg-1 K-1and P = 1.65 .
CV
Substituting in Eq. (3.25), we get
∴ CP = 1.65 CV and 1 . 65
C V − C V = 8000.
(CP – CV) dT = R dT
Solving these, we get
∴ CP – CV = R --- (3.26) 8000
This is known as Mayer’s relation CV = = 12307.69 J kg-1 K-1 and
0.65
between CP and CV. CP = 8000 + CV = 20307.69 J kg-1 K-1
The above relation has been derived It is interesting to use the law of
assuming that the heat energy and mechanical equipartition of energy and calculate the
work are measured in the same units. Generally, specific heat of gases.
heat supplied is measured in calories and work (a) Monatomic Gases: For a monatomic gas
done is measured in joules. The above relation enclosed in a container, held at a constant
then is modified to CP - CV = R/J where J is temperature T and containing NA atoms, each
mechanical equivalent of heat. atom has only 3 translational dof. Therefore,
Also CP = M0SP and CV = M0SV, where 3
average energy per atom is k BT and the total
M0 is the molar mass of the gas and SP and 2
SV are respective principal specific heats. (In internal energy per mole is
3
many books, cP and cV are used to denote the E = N A k BT
2
principal specific heats). Thus,
∴Molar specific heat at constant volume
M0SP – M0SV = R/J
dE 3 3
R C= = N A kB = R --- (3.28)
∴SP – SV = M 0J --- (3.27) V
dT 2 2
5
Using Eq. (3.26), CP = R --- (3.29)
2
63
CP 5 vibrational motion. The number of dof, f,
--- (3.30) for the vibrational motion of a polyatomic
CV 3
(b) Diatomic Gases: For a gas consisting of molecule depends on the geometric structure of
diatomic molecules such as O2, N2, CO, HCl, the molecule i.e., the arrangement of atoms in
enclosed in a container held at a constant a molecule. Each such dof contributes average
1
temperature T, if treated as a rigid rotator, energy 2 × k BT from kinetic energy and
each molecule will have 3 translational and 2
potential energy terms. Therefore for 1 mole of
2 rotational dof. According to the law of a polyatomic gas, the internal energy is
equipartition of energy, the internal energy of
one mole of gas is 3 3 2
E N A k BT N A k BT f N A k BT
2 2 2
3 2 5
E N A k BT N A k BT N A k BT ( 3 f ) N A k BT
2 2 2
The molar specific heat at constant and the molar specific heats at constant volume
volume will be and constant pressure are given as
5 5 CV = (3 + f) R --- (3.37)
=CV = N A kB R --- (3.31)
2 2
7 and CP = (4 + f) R --- (3.38)
Using Eq. (3.26), CP = R --- (3.32) CP 4 f
2
CP 7 ∴ C 3 f --- (3.39)
--- (3.33) V
CV 5
Can you recall?
For diatomic gas containing non rigid
vibrating molecules, internal energy per mole 1. What are the different modes of transfer
is of heat?
3 2 2 2. What are electromagnetic waves?
E N A k BT N A k BT N A k BT 3. Does heat transfer by radiation need a
2 2 2
7 material medium?
= N A k BT
2
The molar specific heat at constant Do you know?
7 7
volume will = be Cv = N A kB R --- (3.34) If a hot body and a cold body are kept in
2 2 vacuum, separated from each other, can
9
Using Eq. (3.26), CP = R --- (3.35) they exchange heat? If yes, which mode
2
C 9 of transfer of heat causes change in their
P --- (3.36) temperatures? If not, give reasons.
CV 7
(c) Polyatomic Gases : Gases which have 3.10 Absorption, Reflection and
molecules containing more than two atoms are Transmission of Heat Radiation:
termed as polyatomic gases, e.g., ammonia gas In XIth Std. you have studied that heat can
where each molecule has one N atom and three be transferred by conduction, convection and
H atoms. Each molecule of the polyatomic radiation. The first two modes of heat transfer
gas has 3 translational dof. Only linear require a material medium for transmission
molecules have 2 dof for rotation. All other of heat but radiation does not need a material
polyatomic molecules can perform rotations medium. The most common example of heat
about three mutually perpendicular axes transfer by the radiation mode that we come
through their center of mass, hence they have across every day is the transfer of heat and
3 dof for rotation also. Polyatomic molecules light from the Sun to the earth and to us. In this
have more than 1 dof for different modes of
64
section, we shall discuss radiation in detail. of heat incident is called the coefficient of
As the term ‘radiation’ refers to one mode absorption.
of transfer of heat, the term ‘radiation’ also Coefficient of reflection or reflectance
refers to continuous emission of energy from (r): The ratio of amount of radiant energy
the surface of any body because of its thermal reflected to the total energy incident is called
energy. This emitted energy is termed as radiant the coefficient of reflection.
energy and is in the form of electromagnetic Coefficient of transmission or transmittance
waves. Radiation is therefore the fastest mode (tr): The ratio of amount of radiant energy
of transfer of heat. The process of transfer of transmitted to total energy incident is called
heat by radiation does not require any material the coefficient of transmission.
medium since electromagnetic waves travel
Since all the three quantities a, r and
through vacuum. Heat transfer by radiation
tr are ratios of thermal energies, they are
is therefore possible through vacuum as well
dimensionless quantities.
as through a material medium transparent to
this radiation. Physical contact of the bodies If r = 0 and a = 0, then tr = 1, all the incident
that are exchanging heat is also not required. energy is transmitted through the object i.e., it
When the radiation falls on a body that is not is a perfect transmitter. The object is said to be
transparent to it, e.g., on the floor or on our completely transparent to the radiation.
hands, it is absorbed and the body gets heated A substance through which heat radiations
up. The electromagnetic radiation emitted by can pass is known as a diathermanous
the bodies, which are at higher temperature substance. For a diathermanous body, tr ≠ 0. A
with respect to the surroundings, is known as diathermanous body is neither a good absorber
thermal radiation. nor a good reflector.
3.10.1 Interaction of Thermal Radiation Examples of diathermanous substances
and Matter: are glass, quartz, sodium chloride, hydrogen,
Whenever thermal radiation falls on the oxygen, dry air etc.
surface of an object, some part of heat energy On the other hand, if tr = 0 and a + r = 1,
is reflected, some part is absorbed and the i.e., the object does not transmit any radiation,
remaining part is transmitted. it is said to be opaque to the radiation.
Let Q be the total amount of thermal Substances which are largely opaque to
energy incident on the surface of an object thermal radiations i.e., do not transmit heat
and Qa, Qr and Qt be the respective amounts radiations incident on them, are known as
of heat absorbed, reflected and transmitted by athermanous substances.
the object: Examples of athermanous substances are
Q Qa Qr Qt ; water, wood, iron, copper, moist air, benzene
Q Q Q etc.
dividing by Q, 1 a r t
Q Q Q If tr = 0 and a = 0, then r = 1, all the
∴ a + r + tr = 1 --- (3.40) incident energy is reflected by the object i.e., it
Q Qr Qt is a perfect reflector. A good reflector is a poor
where a a , r and t r
Q Q Q absorber and a poor transmitter.
are the coefficients of absorption, reflection If r = 0 and tr = 0 then a = 1, all the
and transmission, respectively. incident energy is absorbed by the object. Such
Coefficient of absorption or absorptive an object is called a perfect blackbody. (We
power or absorptivity (a): The ratio of will discuss this in detail later in this chapter)
amount of heat absorbed to total quantity
65
The values of a, r and tr also depend on For the study of radiation, a simple
the wavelength of the incident radiation, in arrangement illustrated in Fig. 3.4, which was
addition to the material of the object on which designed by Ferry, can be used as a perfect
it is incident. Hence, it is possible that an blackbody.
object may be athermanous or diathermanous 3.11.1 Ferry’s Blackbody:
for certain wavelengths, but is a good absorber It consists of a double walled hollow
for certain other wavelengths. sphere having tiny hole or aperture, through
3.11 Perfect Blackbody:
which radiant heat can enter (Fig. 3.4). The
A body, which absorbs the entire radiant
space between the walls is evacuated and
energy incident on it, is called an ideal
outer surface of the sphere is silvered. The
or perfect blackbody. Thus, for a perfect
blackbody, a = 1. Any surface that absorbs all inner surface of sphere is coated with lamp-
the energy incident on it, and does not reflect black. There is a conical projection on the
any energy, therefore, appears black (unless its inner surface of sphere opposite the aperture.
temperature is very high to be self-luminous). The projection ensures that a ray travelling
Lamp black or platinum black that absorb along the axis of the aperture is not incident
nearly 97% of incident radiant heat, resemble normally on the surface and is therefore not
a perfect blackbody. reflected back along the same path. Radiation
entering through the small hole has negligible
Do you know?
chance of escaping back through the small
• Can a perfect blackbody be realized in hole. A heat ray entering the sphere through
practice? the aperture suffers multiple reflections and is
• Are good absorbers also good emitters? almost completely absorbed inside. Thus, the
Consider two objects, which are opaque aperture behaves like a perfect blackbody. In
to thermal radiation, having the same a similar construction, Wien used a cylindrical
temperature and same surface area. The body with a vertical slit as the aperture.
surface of one object is well-polished and the This gives greater effective area as a perfect
surface of the other object is painted black. blackbody.
The well-polished object reflects most of the
energy falling on it and absorbs little. On the
other hand, the black painted object absorbs
most of the radiation falling on it and reflects
little. But the rate of emission of thermal
radiation must be equal to rate of absorption
for both the objects, so that temperature is
maintained. Black painted object absorbs
more, hence it must radiate more to maintain
the temperature. Therefore, good absorbers are Fig. 3.4: Ferry’s blackbody.
always good emitters and poor absorbers are Similar working can be achieved using
poor emitters. Since each object must either a cavity radiator that consists of a block of
absorb or reflect the radiation incident on it, a material with internal cavity. The inner and
poor absorber should be a good reflector and outer surfaces are connected by a small hole.
vice versa. Hence, a good reflector is also a The radiation falling on the block that enters
poor emitter. This is the reason for silvering through the hole, cannot escape back from it.
the walls of vacuum bottles or thermos flasks. Hence, the cavity acts as a blackbody. When
66
the block is heated to high temperature, thermal from XIth Std. of a cup of hot tea (Ttea > Troom)
radiation is emitted. This is called cavity or a plate containing ice (Tice < Troom) kept
radiation and resembles the radiation emitted on a table, both attain the room temperature
by a blackbody. Its nature depends only on the after some time. At room temperature also, all
temperature of the cavity walls and not on the bodies radiate as well as absorb radiation, but
shape and size of the cavity or the material of their rate of emission and rate of absorption
the cavity walls. In the kinetic theory of gases, are same, hence their temperature remains
we discussed the theory, properties and various constant. You can therefore infer that hot
phenomena of an ideal gas rather than dealing bodies would radiate more than cooler bodies.
with real gases, similarly it is convenient to At room temperature (in fact for
work with an ideal blackbody. temperatures T lower than 800 ºC), the
3.12 Emission of Heat Radiation : thermal radiation corresponds to wavelengths
In 1792, Pierre Prevost published a theory longer than those of visible light and hence
of radiation known as theory of exchange of we do not see them. When the body is heated,
heat. According to this theory, all bodies at the radiated energy corresponds to shorter
wavelengths. For temperatures around
all temperatures above 0 K (absolute zero
800 ºC, part of the energy emitted is in the
temperature) radiate thermal energy and at
visible range and body appears red. At around
the same time, they absorb radiation received
3000 ºC, it looks white hot. The filament
from the surroundings. The amount of thermal of a tungsten lamp appears white hot as its
radiation emitted per unit time depends on temperature is around 3000 ºC
the nature of emitting surface, its area and its We have thus seen that all bodies
temperature. Hotter bodies radiate at higher radiate electromagnetic radiation when their
rate than the cooler bodies. Light coloured temperature is above the absolute zero of
bodies reflect most of the visible radiation temperature.
whereas dark coloured bodies absorb most of Amount of heat radiated by a body
the incident visible radiation. depends on
For a body, the absorbed radiation • The absolute temperature of the body (T)
(being energy) increases the kinetic energy • The nature of the body – the material,
of the constituent atoms oscillating about nature of surface – polished or not, etc.
their mean positions. You have learnt earlier • Surface area of the body (A)
that the average translational kinetic energy • Time duration of for which body emits
radiation (t)
determines the temperature of the body, the
The amount of heat radiated, Q, is
absorbed radiation therefore causes a rise in
directly proportional to the surface area (A)
the temperature of the body. The body itself
and time duration (t). It is therefore convenient
also radiates, therefore its energy decreases, to consider the quantity of heat radiated per
causing lowering of temperature. If a body unit area per unit time (or power emitted per
radiates more than it absorbs, its temperature unit area). This is defined as emissive power
decreases and vice versa. When the rate of or radiant power, R, of the body, at a given
absorption of radiation is same as the rate temperature T.
of emission of radiation, the temperature Q
R
of the body remains constant and the body At
Dimensions of emissive power are
is said to be in thermal equilibrium with its
[LoM1T-3] and SI unit is J m-2 s-1 or W/m2.
surroundings. You might recall the example
The nature of emitting surface, i.e., its
67
material or polishing is not a physical quantity. 3.13 Kirchhoff’s Law of Heat Radiation and
Hence, to discuss the material aspect, we its Theoretical Proof:
compare objects of different materials with Kirchhoff’s law of thermal radiation
identical geometries at the same temperature. deals with wavelength specific radiative
At a given temperature, a perfect blackbody emission and absorption by a body in
has maximum emissive power. Thus it is thermal equilibrium. It states that at a given
convenient to compare emissive power of a temperature, the ratio of emissive power to
given surface with that of the perfect blackbody coefficient of absorption of a body is equal to
at the same temperature. the emissive power of a perfect blackbody at
3.12.1 Coefficient of Emission or Emissivity: the same temperature for all wavelengths.
The coefficient of emission or emissivity
Since we can describe the emissive power
(e) of a given surface is the ratio of the emissive
of an ordinary body in comparison to a perfect
power R of the surface to the emissive power
blackbody through its emissivity, Kirchhoff’s
RB of a perfect black surface, at the same
law can also be stated as follows: for a body
temperature.
R emitting and absorbing thermal radiation in
e --- (3.41)
RB thermal equilibrium, the emissivity is equal to
For a perfect blackbody e = 1 , whereas its absorptivity.
for a perfect reflector e= 0 . Symbolically, a = e or more specifically
a(λ) = e(λ).
Use your brain power Thus, if a body has high emissive power,
it also has high absorptive power and if a
• Why are the bottoms of cooking utensils body has low emissive power, it also has low
blackened and tops polished?
absorptive power.
• A car is left in sunlight with all its
Kirchhoff’s law can be theoretically
windows closed on a hot day. After
some time it is observed that the inside proved by the following thought experiment.
of the car is warmer than outside air. Consider an ordinary body A and a perfect
Why? blackbody B of identical geometric shapes
• If surfaces of all bodies are continuously placed in an enclosure. In thermal equilibrium,
emitting radiant energy, why do they both bodies will be at same temperature as that
not cool down to 0 K? of the enclosure.
Everyday objects are not ideal Let R be the emissive power of body A,
blackbodies. Hence, they radiate at a rate RB be the emissive power of blackbody B and
less then that of the blackbody at the same a be the coefficient of absorption of body A.
temperature. Also for these objects, the rate If Q is the quantity of radiant heat incident on
each body in unit time and Qa is the quantity
does depend on properties such as the colour
of radiant heat absorbed by the body A, then
and composition of the surface, in addition
Qa = a Q. As the temperatures of the body A
to the temperature. All these effects together
and blackbody B remain the same, both must
are taken care of in the term emissivity e. For
emit the same amount as they absorb in unit
an ordinary body, 0 < e < 1 depending on the
time. Since emissive power is the quantity of
nature of the surface, e.g., emissivity of copper
heat radiated from unit area in unit time, we
is 0.3. Emissivity is larger for rough surfaces
can write
and smaller for smooth and polished surfaces.
Quantity of radiant heat absorbed by
Emissivity also varies with temperature and
body A= Quantity of heat emitted by body A
wavelength of radiation to some extent.
68
or, a Q = R --- (3.42) indicates the power radiated at different
For the perfect blackbody B, wavelengths. Experimental observations
Q = RB --- (3.43) indicated that the spectral distribution
Dividing Eq. (3.42) by Eq.(3.43), we get depended only on the absolute temperature T
R of a blackbody and was independent of the
a=
RB material.
R
or, =RB --- (3.44)
a
R
But =e from Eq. (3.41), ∴ a = e.
RB
Hence, Kirchhoff’s law is theoretically proved.
Can you give two applications of Kirchhoff’s
law in daily life?
3.14 Spectral Distribution of Blackbody
Radiation:
The radiant energy emitted per unit
area per unit time by a blackbody depends
on its temperature. Hot objects radiate
Fig. 3.5: Radiant power of a blackbody per unit
electromagnetic radiation in a large range of
range of wavelength as a function of wavelength.
frequencies. Hence, the rate of emission per
From experimental curves, it is observed
unit area or power per unit area of a surface
is defined as a funtion of the wavelength λ of that
the emitted radiation. At low temperature, the 1. at a given temperature, the energy is not
power radiated is small and primarily lies in uniformly distributed in the spectrum (i.e.,
the long wavelength region. As the temperature as a function of wavelength) of blackbody,
is increased, rate of emission increases fast. At 2. at a given temperature, the radiant power
each temperature, the radiant energy contains emitted initially increases with increase of
a mixture of different wavelengths. At higher wavelength, reaches it’s maximum and then
temperatures, the total energy radiated per decreases. The wavelength corresponding
unit time increases and the proportion of to the radiation of maximum intensity,
energy emitted at higher frequencies or shorter λmax , is characteristic of the temperature
wavelengths also increases. of the radiating body. (Remember, it is not
Lummer and Pringsheim studied the the maximum wavelength emitted by the
energy distribution of blackbody radiation as a object),
function of wavelength. They kept the source of 3. area under the curve represents total energy
radiation (such as a cavity radiator) at different emitted per unit time per unit area by the
temperatures and measured the radiant power
blackbody at all wavelengths,
corresponding to different wavelengths. The
4. the peak of the curves shifts towards
measurements were represented graphically
the left – shorter wavelengths, i.e., the
in the form of curves showing variation of
value of λmax decreases with increase in
radiant power per unit area as a function temperature,
of wavelength λ at different constant 5. at higher temperatures, the radiant power
temperatures as shown in Fig. 3.5. Spectral or total energy emitted per unit time per
distribution of power radiated by a body unit area (i.e., the area under the curve)
69
corresponding to all the wavelengths energy to another of lower energy. As long
increases, as the oscillator is in one of the quantized
6. at a temperature of 300 K (around room states, it does not emit or absorb energy.
temperature), the most intense of these This model of Planck turned out to be the
waves has a wavelength of about 5 × basis for Einstein’s theory to explain the
10-6 m; the radiant power is smaller for observations of experiments on photoelectric
wavelengths different from this value. effect, as you will learn in Chapter 14.
Practically all the radiant energy at this
temperature is carried by waves longer 3.14.1 Wien’s Displacement Law :
than those corresponding to red light. It is observed that the wavelength, for
These are infrared radiations. which emissive power of a blackbody is
A theoretical explanation of the above maximum, is inversely proportional to the
observations could not be given by the then absolute temperature of the blackbody. This is
existing theories. Wien gave an expression Wien’s displacement law.
for spectral distribution from laws of 1
max
thermodynamics, which fitted the experimental T
observations only for short wavelengths. Lord b
Rayleigh and Sir James Jeans gave a formula or, max
T
from the equipartition of energy. This formula
∴ max T b --- (3.45)
fits well in the long wavelength regions but
where b is called the Wien’s constant and its
tends to infinity at short wavelengths. It was
value is 2.897 × 10-3 m K. λmax indicates the
therefore essential to propose a new model to
wavelength at which the blackbody dominantly
explain the behaviour of blackbody. Planck,
radiates. Thus, it corresponds to the dominant
being aware of the shortcomings of the two
colour of the radiating body and is a function
models, combined the two models using an
of its temperature. You might have heard of
empirical formula and could describe the
white dwarfs and red giants, white dwarfs are
observed spectrum quite well.
hot stars with surface temperature ~ 10000 K
while red giants are cooler corresponding to
Do you know?
surface temperature ~ 3000 K.
The idea of quantization of energy This law is useful to determine
was first proposed by Planck to explain temperatures of distant stars, Sun, moon etc.
the blackbody spectrum or the cavity Example 3.5: Calculate the value of
radiations. Planck proposed a model in λmax for solar radiation assuming that
terms of the atomic processes. He considered surface temperature of Sun is 5800 K
the atoms of the walls of the cavity as (b = 2.897 ×10-3 m K). In which part of the
tiny electromagnetic oscillators with electromagnetic spectrum, does this value
characteristic frequencies that exchange lie?
energy with the cavity. This energy was Solution: Given
supposed to have only specific values T = 5800 K and b = 2.897 × 10-3 m K.
E = nhν, where ν is the frequency of
Using Eq. (3.45),
oscillator, h is a universal constant that
2.897 10 3 mK
has a value 6.626 × 10-34 J s and n can take max
only positive integral values. The oscillators 5800 K
would not radiate energy continuously but 4.995 10 7 m 4995 Å .
only in “jumps” or “quanta” corresponding This value lies in the visible region of
to transitions from one quantized level of the electromagnetic spectrum.
70
the energy radiated per unit area per unit time
= σT
4
Can you tell?
λmax, the wavelength corresponding to Energy absorbed from surroundings per
unit area per unit time = σ T0
4
maximum intensity for the Sun is in the
blue-green region of visible spectrum. Why Therefore net loss of energy by perfect
does the Sun then appear yellow to us? blackbody per unit area per unit time
= T 4 T0 4 = (T 4 T0 4 ).
3.15 Stefan-Boltzmann Law of Radiation: For an ordinary body, net loss of energy per
We shall now discuss the temperature
unit area per unit time = e T T0 .
4 4
dependence of thermal radiation emitted per On the other hand, if the body is at a
unit time by a blackbody. In 1879, Josef Stefan temperature lower than the surrounding i.e., T
proposed an empirical relation between the rate
at which heat is radiated (the radiant power
< T0, then e T0 T will be the net gain
4 4
∴
R1
T14 T0 4
1100 4 300 4 • https://chem.libretexts.org/Bookshelves/
Physical_and_Theoretical_Chemistry_
R2
T2 4 T0 4 700 4 300 4
Textbook_Maps/Map%3A_Physical_
R1 14560 182 Chemistry_(McQuarrie_and_
=
or, =
R2 2320 29 Simon)/01%3A_The_Dawn_of_
the_Quantum_Theory/1.01%3A_
∴ R1 :R2 = 182 : 29 Blackbody_Radiation_Cannot_Be_
Example 3.9: Assuming that the temperature Explained_Classically
at the surface of the Sun is 6000 K, find out • http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
the size of a virtual star (in terms of the size hbase/Kinetic/kinthe.html
of Sun) whose surface temperature is 3000 • h t t p s : / / w w w . y o u t u b e . c o m /
K and the power radiated by the virtual star watch?v=Qsa4aAdpHfy
is 25 times the power radiated by the Sun.
• h t t p s : / / w w w . y o u t u b e . c o m
Treat both, the Sun and virtual star as a watch?v=buPuKAcKqZw
blackbody.
Solution: Given,
TSun = 6000 K,
Tstar = 3000 K,
Pstar = 25 × PSun
Power radiated by the Sun
72
Exercises
73
14. Show that rms velocity of an oxygen 21. The emissive power of a sphere of area
molecule is 2 times that of a sulfur 0.02 m2 is 0.5 kcal s-1 m-2. What is the
dioxide molecule at S.T.P. amount of heat radiated by the spherical
15. At what temperature will oxygen surface in 20 second?
molecules have same rms speed as [Ans: 0.2 kcal]
helium molecules at S.T.P.? (Molecular 22. Compare the rates of emission of heat by
masses of oxygen and helium are 32 and a blackbody maintained at 727 ºC and at
4 respectively) 227 ºC, if the blackbodies are surrounded
[Ans: 2184 K] by an enclosure (black) at 27 ºC. What
16. Compare the rms speed of hydrogen would be the ratio of their rates of loss of
molecules at 127 ºC with rms speed of heat ?
oxygen molecules at 27 ºC given that [Ans: 18.23:1]
molecular masses of hydrogen and 23. Earth’s mean temperature can be
oxygen are 2 and 32 respectively. assumed to be 280 K. How will the curve
[Ans: 8: 3 ] of blackbody radiation look like for this
17. Find kinetic energy of 5 litre of a gas at temperature? Find out λmax. In which
S.T.P. given standard pressure is 1.013 × part of the electromagnetic spectrum,
5 2
10 N/m . does this value lie?
[Ans: 0.7597] [Ans: 1.035 × 10-5 m, microwave region]
18. Calculate the average molecular kinetic 24. A small-blackened solid copper
energy (i) per kmol (ii) per kg (iii) per sphere of radius 2.5 cm is placed in an
molecule of oxygen at 127 ºC, given that evacuated chamber. The temperature of
molecular weight of oxygen is 32, R is the chamber is maintained at 100 ºC. At
-1 -1
8.31 J mol K and Avogadro’s number what rate energy must be supplied to the
23 -1
NA is 6.02 x 10 molecules mol . copper sphere to maintain its temperature
6
[Ans: 4.986 × 10 J, 1.56 × 10 J 2
at 110 ºC? (Take Stefan’s constant σ to
-21
8.28 × 10 J] be 5.76 × 10-8 J s-1 m-2 K-4 and treat the
19. Calculate the energy radiated in one sphere as blackbody.)
minute by a blackbody of surface area [Ans: 0.962 W]
2
100 cm when it is maintained at 227 ºC. 25. Find the temperature of a blackbody if
[Ans: 2126.25 J] its spectrum has a peak at (a) λmax = 700
20. Energy is emitted from a hole in nm (visible), (b) λmax = 3 cm (microwave
an electric furnace at the rate of 20 W, region) and (c) λmax = 3 m (FM radio
when the temperature of the furnace is waves) (Take Wien's constant b = 2.897
727 ºC. What is the area of the hole? × 10-3 m K).
(Take Stefan’s constant σ to be 5.7 × [Ans: (a) 4138 K, (b) 0.0966 K,
-8 -1 -2 -4
10 J s m K ) (c) 0.966 × 10-3 K]
[Ans: 3.5 × 10-4 m2]
74
4. Thermodynamics
Remember this
Figure 4.3 (b): Thermodynamic systems; open When transfer of energy takes place
system, closed system, and isolated system. between a system and its environment, we
A thermodynamic process is a process in observe the following conventions.
which the thermodynamic state of a system is 1. When the energy is transferred to
changed. For example, water contained in a a system from its environment, it
vessel with a lid on it is an open system. When is positive. We say that the system gains
the pot is heated externally, water starts boiling (or absorbs) energy.
after some time and steam is produced which 2. When the energy is transferred from
exerts pressure on the walls of the vessel. In the system to its environment, it
this case, the state of the water in the container is negative. We say that the system
is changed. This is because, the temperature loses (or releases) energy.
(T ), the volume (V ), and the pressure (P ) of
78
some gas in it. This cylinder is provided with
a movable, massless, and frictionless piston at
one end as shown. The gas inside the cylinder
is our system and the rest is its environment.
Let the temperature of the gas be TS and that
Fig. 4.4 (a): Energy flows into the system. of the environment be TE.
Consider Fig. 4.4 which shows energy Internal energy of the system (the gas) can
transfer between a system and its environment. be changed in two different ways or by both.
Let TS and TE be the temperatures of the system
and its environment respectively. Let Q be the
energy transferred between the system and
its environment. As shown in Fig. 4.4 (a),
TS > TE , the system gains energy, and Q is
positive.
81
more heat is added to the system than the
system, (b) the work done by the system
work done by it. The internal energy of the
during this change, and (c) the change
system increases, (∆U > 0). Figure 4.8. (b)
in the internal energy of the system.
Given, the volume of water changes from
1.0 × 10-3 m3 in liquid form to 1.671 m3
when in the form of steam.
Solution : (a) Liquid water changes
to steam by absorbing the heat of
Fig. 4.8 (b): Decrease in internal energy
vaporization. In case of water, this is
(∆U < 0)
Q = L.m shows the case when more work is done by the
kJ
Q 2256 1.0 kg 2256 kJ system than the heat added to it. In this case,
kg the internal energy of the system decreases,
(b) The work done can be calculated by (∆U < 0). Figure 4.8.(c) shows the case when
using Eq. (4.1). Here, the pressure is heat added to the system and the work done
1.01×105 Pa and the change in volume is by it are the same. The internal energy of the
dV = (1.671 m3 - 1.0x10-3 m3) system remains unchanged, (∆U = 0).
The work done is,
W = pdV = (1.01×105Pa) × (1.671 m3
-1.0x10-3 m3)
= 1.69x105 J = 169kJ
(c) Change in the internal energy of the
system can be calculated by using Eq. (4.3).
Fig. 4.8 (c): No change in internal energy
∆U = Q - W
(∆U = 0)
= 2265 kJ - 169 kJ = 2096 kJ The law of conservation of energy we
This energy is positive which means studied in XIth Std. was applicable to an
that there is an increase in the internal isolated system, i.e., to a system in which there
energy of water when it boils. This energy is no exchange of energy. The first law of
is used to separate water molecules from thermodynamics, Eq. (4.3) and Eq. (4.4) is an
each other which are closer in liquid water extension of the law of conservation of energy
than in water in vapour form. to systems which are not isolated, i.e., systems
Can you explain how the work done that can exchange energy. This exchange can
by the system is utilized? be in the form of work W, or heat Q. The first
law of thermodynamics is thus a generalization
The quantities W and Q can be positive, of the law of conservation of energy.
negative or zero, therefore, ∆U can be positive, We started this discussion on the basis
negative, or zero. Figure 4.8 shows these three of the microscopic view (kinetic theory) of
cases. Figure 4.8. (a) shows the case when internal energy. In practice, this is not useful
because it does not help us in calculating the
internal energy of a system. In physics, we
need some measurable quantities so that the
internal energy of a system can be measured,
though indirectly. Equation (4.3), ∆U Q - W,
Fig. 4.8 (a) : Increase in internal energy
(∆U > 0). provides this method. The internal energy
82
appears as the difference between the heat Q Property of a system or a system variable:
supplied to (or released by) the system and It is any measurable or observable
the work W done by (or done on) the system. characteristic or property of a system when
Both are measurable quantities. In physics, the system remains in equilibrium. A property
we generally discuss volume expansion of a is also called a state variable of the system.
gas when heat is added to it. In this case, the We will use the term variable to describe
heat added and the resulting expansion of the characteristic of a system. For example,
gas can be measured. The expansion of a gas pressure, volume, temperature, density and
to do work in moving a piston in an internal mass of a system are some of the variables
combustion engine can also be measured. that are used to describe a system. These
are measurable properties and are called
Example 4.4: 104 kJ of work is done on macroscopic variables of a system.
certain volume of a gas. If the gas releases Intensive and Extensive variables:
125 kJ of heat, calculate the change in Intensive variables do not depend on the
internal energy (in kJ) of the gas. size of the system. Extensive variables depend
Solution: We know from the first law of on the size of the system. Consider a system
thermodynamics that ∆U = Q - W in equilibrium. Let this system be divided into
Given, W = 104 kJ. This work is done on two equal compartments, each with half the
the gas, hence we write W = - 104 kJ. original volume. We notice that the pressure
Similarly, the heat is released by the gas p, the temperature T, and the density ρ are
and we write Q = - 125 kJ. the same in both compartments. These are
Therefore, from the first law of intensive variables. The total mass M, and the
thermodynamics, we have, internal energy U of the system are equally
∆U = |Q| - |W| divided in the two compartments and are
∴ ∆U = (125 - 104) = 21 kJ extensive variables of the system.
4.6.1 Thermodynamic Equilibrium:
Remember this A system is in thermodynamic equilibrium
if the following three conditions of equilibrium
The first law of thermodynamics gives the are satisfied simultaneously. These are,
relationship between the heat transfer, the 1) Mechanical equilibrium, 2) Chemical
work done, and the change in the internal equilibrium, and 3) Thermal equilibrium.
energy of a system. 1) Mechanical equilibrium: When there are
4.6 Thermodynamic state variables no unbalanced forces within the system and
between the system and its surrounding, the
Earlier, we have discussed thermal
system is said to be in mechanical equilibrium.
equilibrium and understood the concept
The system is also said to be in mechanical
of temperature and the Zeroth law of
equilibrium when the pressure throughout
thermodynamics. Thermodynamics is not
the system and between the system and its
the study of changes in temperature of a
surrounding is the same. Whenever some
system only. As we have seen earlier, when
unbalanced forces exist within the system,
temperature of a system changes (it gains or
they will get neutralized with time to attain
releases energy), its other properties can also the condition of equilibrium. A system is in
change. Let us understand these properties. mechanical equilibrium when the pressure in
We will define the term property of a it is the sane throughout and does not change
thermodynamic system first. with time.
83
2) Chemical equilibrium: A system is said to air may not be uniform throughout. Similarly,
be in chemical equilibrium when there are no the fuel (a mixture of petrol vapour) in the
chemical reactions going on within the system, cylinder of an automobile engine undergoing
or there is no transfer of matter from one part an explosive chemical reaction when ignited
of the system to the other due to diffusion. A by a spark is not an equilibrium state. This
system is in chemical equilibrium when its is because its temperature and pressure are
chemical composition is the sane throughout not uniform. Such system which is not in
and does not change with time. equilibrium cannot be described in terms of
3) Thermal equilibrium: When the the state variables. Eventually, the air in first
temperature of a system is uniform throughout case, and the fuel in the second case reach a
and does not change with time, the system is uniform temperature and pressure and attain
said to be in thermal equilibrium. We have thermal and mechanical equilibrium with its
discussed thermal equilibrium at length earlier. surroundings. Thus it attains thermodynamic
equilibrium.
Activity In simple words, thermodynamic state
Identify different thermodynamic systems variables describe the equilibrium states
and study their equilibrium. Classify of a system. The various state variables
them in to one of the categories we just are not always independent. They can be
discussed. mathematically related. The mathematical
relation between the state variables is called
4.6.2 Thermodynamic State Variables and
the equation of state. For example, for an
Equation of State
ideal gas, the equation of state is the ideal gas
Every equilibrium state of a
equation,
thermodynamic system is completely described
pV = nRT --- (4.5)
by specific values of some macroscopic
Where, p, V and T are the pressure, the volume
variables, also called state variables. For
and the temperature of the gas, n is the number
example, an equilibrium state of a gas is
of moles of the gas and R is the gas constant.
completely described by the values of its
For a fixed amount of the gas, i.e., for given n,
pressure p, volume V, temperature T, and mass
there are thus, only two independent variables.
m. Consider a mixture of gases or vapours as
It could be p and V, or p and T, or V and T.
in case of the fuel in an automobile engine. Its
state can be described by the state variables
but we also need its composition to describe
its state.
Fig. 4.9: Non equilibrium state. Fig. 4.10: A typical p-V diagram.
A thermodynamic system is not always in The graphical representation of equation
equilibrium. Figure 4.9 shows such case. For of state of a system (of a gas) is called the
example, when an inflated ball is punctured, p - V diagram, or the p - V curve (the pressure
the air inside it suddenly expands to the – volume curve), or the indicator diagram of
atmosphere. This is not an equilibrium state. the system. Figure 4.10 shows a typical p-V
During the rapid expansion, pressure of the diagram for an ideal gas at some constant
84
temperature. The pressure-volume curve for
a constant temperature is called an isotherm.
Real gases may have more complicated
equations of state and therefore, a complicated
p-V diagram. (The Van-der–Wall’s equation
with various corrections for example, is
complicated for a real gas and is equally
interesting). The equation of state of a system
(usually a gas confined to a cylinder with a Fig. 4.11 (a): Positive work with varying pressure.
movable, frictionless and massless piston) and decreases. The work done by the gas in this
its p - V diagram are very useful in studying case is positive because the volume of the gas
its behavior. In the following sections, we will has increased.
discuss some systems and their behavior using Similarly, Fig. 4.11 (b) shows compression
p - V diagrams. due to inward displacement of the piston. The
4.6.3 The p - V diagram: pressure of the gas is increased and the work
Consider Eq. (4.2), i.e., done by the gas is now negative.
Vf Vf
W dW pdV
Vi Vi
The integral in this equation can be
evaluated if we know the relation between
the pressure p and the volume V, or the path
between the limits of integration. Equation.
(4.2) can be represented graphically.
Fig. 4.11 (b): Negative work with varying
A gas confined to a cylinder with a pressure.
movable, frictionless, and massless piston can Figure 4.11 (c) shows the p-V diagram
be, 1) expanded with varying pressure (Figure when the volume of the gas changes from
4.11 a), or 2) it can be compressed with varying Vi to Vf at a constant pressure. The curve is
pressure Fig. 4.11 (b), or 3) it can expand at actually a line parallel to the volume axis. The
constant pressure Fig. 4.11 (c). work done during volume change at constant
The area under the curve in the p-V pressure is W = p (Vf - Vi ), (Only in this case
the integration is p (dV)).
diagram, is the graphical representation of the
value of the integral in Eq. (4.2). Since this
integral represents the work done in changing
the volume of the gas, the area under the p-V
curve also represents the work done in this
process.
85
changes are very slow. We will discuss such (Vi, pi). The final state of the system is shown
processes in some details in a later section. by the point B with its coordinates given by
4.7 Thermodynamic Process: (Vf , pf). The curve 1 (path 1) shown in the
A thermodynamic process is a procedure Fig. 4.12 (a) is one of the many ways (paths) in
by which the initial state of a system changes which we can change the system from state A
to its final state. During such a change, there to the state B. When the system changes itself
may be a transfer of heat into the system from from A to B along the path 1, both its pressure
its environment, (positive heat), for example and volume change. The pressure decreases
when water boils heat is transferred to water. while the volume increases. The work done
Heat may be released from the system to its by the system is positive (because the volume
environment (negative heat). Similarly, some increases). It is given by the area under the
work can be done by the system (positive curve 1 as shown in the Fig. 4.12 (b).
work), or some work can be done on the system
(negative work). When the piston in a cylinder
is pushed in, some work is done on the system.
We know that these changes should occur
infinitesimally slowly so that the system
is always in thermodynamic equilibrium.
Such processes in which changes in the state
variables of a system occur infinitesimally Fig. 4.12 (b): Pressure and volume both change.
slowly are called quasi static systems. Second way to change the state from A
When a thermodynamic system changes to state B is path 2 as shown in Fig. 4.12 (c).
from its initial state to its final state, it passes In this case, the volume increases to Vf from
through a series of intermediate states. This the point A up to the point C at the constant
series of intermediate states when plotted on a pressure pi. The pressure then decrease to pf as
p - V diagram is called a path. The p - V curve shown. The volume remains constant during
or the p - V diagram, shown in Fig. 4.11 is such this change. The system is now in the state B
a path. It tells us the way a system has gone with its coordinates given by (Vf , pf).
through a change.
4.7.1 Work Done During a Thermodynamic
Process:
87
free expansion. A common example of free 1. Reversible and Irreversible Processes:
expansion is abrupt puncturing of an inflated We know that when two objects at
balloon or a tyre. different temperatures are brought in thermal
It is experimentally observed that when an contact they reach a thermal equilibrium. In this
ideal gas undergoes a free expansion, there is process, the object at higher temperature loses
no change of temperature. Therefore, the final its heat and the object at lower temperature
state of the gas in this case also, is the same gains heat. (But we never observe that after
as the first case. The intermediate states or the some time, the two objects are back to their
paths during the change of state in the first and initial temperatures). The object that was
the second case are different. But the initial previously hot never becomes hot again and
and the final states are the same in both cases. the previously cold object never becomes cold
Figures 4.13 (a) and (b) represent two different again once they reach thermal equilibrium.
ways of taking a system from the initial state
That means the two objects at different
to the final state. This means we have two
temperatures reaching thermal equilibrium
different paths connecting the same initial and
is an irreversible process. Such processes
the final states of a system.
do not restore the initial state of the system.
In case of the method shown in
Puncturing an inflated balloon or a tyre,
Fig. 4.13 (a) there is an exchange of heat. In
rubbing our palms together, burning a candle
case of the method shown in Fig. 4.13 (b),
are some familiar examples of irreversible
there is no exchange of heat and also, the
system does not do any work at all because thermodynamic processes.
there is no displacement of any piston or any Some processes such as melting of
other surface. ice, freezing of water, boiling of water,
To conclude, heat transferred to a system condensation of steam can be reversed.
also depends on the path. That means the initial sates of the system
4.7.3 Classification of Thermodynamic can be restored. These are some familiar
Processes: thermodynamic processes that are reversible.
As we have seen earlier, a thermodynamic A thermodynamic process (change) can
state can be described by its pressure p, be a reversible process (change) or it can be an
volume V, and temperature T. These are the irreversible process (change).
state variables of a system. At present, we will
restrict our description of a thermodynamic
system only to its pressure, volume and
temperature.
A process by which two or more of
these variables can be changed is called a
thermodynamic process or a thermodynamic
change. As we have discussed earlier, there Fig. 4.14 (a): p-V diagram of Reversible process.
can be a number of different ways to change Earlier, we have seen that a thermodynamic
these parameters, that is, there are different process can be represented by a p - V diagram.
thermodynamic processes. But in practice, for A reversible process is a change that can be
the sake of measurement, any one of the state retraced in reverse (opposite) direction. The
variables is held constant and other two are path of a reversible thermodynamic process
varied. This leads us to a very useful way of is the same in the forward and the reverse
classifying thermodynamic processes. direction. Figure 4.14 (a) shows the path of
88
a reversible thermodynamic process. This 1. Many processes such as a free expansion
path shows a reversible expansion of a gas or an explosive chemical reaction take the
followed by its reversible compression. Such system to non-equilibrium states.
changes are very slow and there is no loss of 2. Most processes involve friction, viscosity
any energy in the process and the system is or some other dissipative forces. For
back to its initial state after it is taken along example, an object sliding on a surface
the reverse path. Reversible processes are stops after moving through some distance
ideal processes. A real thermodynamic process due to friction and loses its mechanical
will always encounter some loss due to friction energy in the form of heat to the surface
or some other dissipative forces. and it gets heated itself. The dissipative
forces are always present everywhere and
can be minimized at best, but cannot be
fully eliminated.
Remember this
89
can be good thermal conductors (for an done in bringing out the expansion from the
isothermal process) or can be thermally initial volume Vi to the final volume Vf is given
insulating (for an adiabatic process). by, Vf
90
3. Isobaric process:
Example 4.5: It is a constant pressure process. Boiling
0.5 mole of gas at temp 300 K expands water at constant pressure, normally at
isothermally from an initial volume of 2.0L atmospheric pressure, is an isobaric process.
to final volume of 6.0L. (a) What is the work Figure (4.16) shows the p-V diagram of an
isobaric process. It is called as an isobar. The
done by the gas ? (R = 8.31 J mol-1 K-1),
different curves shown on the maps provided
(b) How much heat is supplied to the gas? by the meteorology department are isobars.
Solution: (a) The work done in isothermal They indicate the locations having same
Vf pressure in a region. For an isobaric process,
expansion is W = nRTln
Vi none of the quantities ∆U, Q and W is zero.
Where n = 0.5, Vf = 6L, Vi = 2L
8.319 6L
W = 0.5 mol 300 K . ln
mol K 2L
= 1.369 kJ.
(b) From the first law of thermodynamics,
the heat supplied in an isothermal process
is spent to do work an a system. Therefore,
Q = W = 1.369 kJ. Fig. 4.16 : p - V diagram of an isobaric process.
Can you explain the significance of Thermodynamics of Isobaric process:
positive sign of the work done and the heat? The pressure of a system remains constant
in this process i.e. ∆p = 0. Consider an ideal
gas undergoing volume expansion at constant
Remember this pressure. If Vi and Ti are its volume and
Always remember for an isothermal temperature in the initial state of a system and
process: Vf and Tf are its final volume and temperature
1. Equation of state: pV = constant respectively, the work done in the expansion is
2. ∆T = 0. Constant temperature process, given by
perfect thermal equilibrium with W pdV p V f V i nR T f Ti --- (4.10)
environment. Also, the change in the internal energy of
3. ∆U = 0. No change in internal
a system is given by,
energy, energy is exchanged with the
environment. U nCV T nCV T f Ti --- (4.11)
4. Q = W. Energy exchanged is used to do Where, CV is the specific heat at constant
work. volume and ∆T = (Tf - Ti) is the change in its
5. W = p ∆V temperature during the isobaric process.
6. An isothermal change is a very slow According to the first law of
change. The system exchanges heat
thermodynamics, the heat exchanged is given
with its environment and is in thermal
by, Q = ∆U + W
equilibrium with it throughout the change.
Using the previous two equations we get,
Q nCV T f Ti nR T f Ti
Use your brain power
Q V
nC nR f i
T
T
Show that the isothermal work may also be
p Q nC p T f Ti --- (4.12)
expressed as W = nRTln i .
p Where, Cp is the specific heat at constant
f pressure C p CV R .
91
Equation (4.12) tells that the temperature p-V diagram of an isochoric process. For an
of a system changes in an isobaric process isochoric process, ∆V =0, and we have, from
therefore, its internal energy also changes the first law of thermodynamics, ∆U = Q.
(Eq. 4.11). The heat exchanged (Eq. 4.12) This means that for an isochoric change, all
is partly used for increasing the temperature the energy added in the form of heat remains
and partly to do some work. The change in in the system itself and causes an increase
the temperature of the system depends on the in its internal energy. Heating a gas in a
specific heat at constant pressure Cp. constant volume container or diffusion of a
gas in a closed chamber are some examples of
Example 4.6: isochoric process.
One mole of an ideal gas is initially kept in
a cylinder with a movable frictionless and
massless piston at pressure of 1.0mPa, and
temperature 27°C. It is then expanded till its
volume is doubled. How much work is done
if the expansion is isobaric?
Solution: Work done in isobaric process
given by W = p∆V = (Vf - Vi).
Vf = 2Vi ∴ W = 2pVi. Fig. 4.17: p-V diagram of isochoric process.
Vi can be found by using the ideal gas Thermodynamics of Isochoric process:
equation for initial state. For an isochoric process, we have, ∆V =0.
pi Vi = nRTi for n = 1 mol, The system does not do any work and all the
RT 300 energy supplied to the system is converted
Vi i 8.31 24.9 10 4 m 3 into its internal energy. The first law of
pi 1 10 6
When a system expands adiabatically, W is W pdV
positive (work is done by the system) and ∆U Vi
is negative, the internal energy of the system Using Eq. (4.16) we have,
Vf
dV
decreases. When a system is compressed W C
adiabatically, W is negative (work is done on Vi
V
the system), and ∆U is positive. The internal V 1
Vf
nR Ti T f p f V f piVi
Thermodynamics of Adiabatic process:
For an adiabatic process we have, W --- (4.20)
pV γ
= constant = C --- (4.16) 1 1
where, γ is the ratio of the specific heat at
Equation (4.20) implies that when work is done
constant pressure to the specific heat at
Cp by the gas, i.e., when the gas expands, W > 0,
constant volume, i.e., γ = and Ti > Tf. This mean that the gas will cool
CV
γ is also called adiabatic ratio. For down. Similarly, if the work is done on the gas,
moderate temperature changes, the value of γ i.e., if the gas is compressed W < 0, and Ti < Tf.
This means that the gas will warm up.
5
is for monoatomic gases, 7 for diatomic
3 5
93
1
Remember this W
1
PVi i Pi Pf Pi Pf
Always remember for an adiabatic process: (1.01 105 )(1.0 10 3 )
γ
1. Equation of state: pV = constant. 1
1 .0 10 3
m 3
2. Q = 0. No exchange of heat with the 1.4 1 ( 44.88 105 )
surroundings. The system is perfectly 15
insulated from its environment, or the
494 J
change is very rapid.
(c) To calculate final temperature Tf
3. ∆U = - W. All the work is utilized
consider,
to change the internal energy of the 1
Vf
system. T f Ti ( 300 K) (15) 0.40
4. ∆T ≠ 0. Temperature of the system Vi
changes. 886 K 613C
5. Adiabatic expansion causes cooling The pressure involved in this process
and adiabatic compression causes is about 45 atm. This is an adiabatic
heating up of the system. compression. The temperature of the gas
6. W nR Ti T f p f V f piVi
is increased without any transfer of heat.
Similar heating is used in automobile
1 1 (diesel) engines. The fuel used in the engine
7. Most of the times, an adiabatic change is heated rapidly to such a high temperature
is a sudden change. During a sudden that it ignites without any spark plug.
change, the system does not find (d)
any time to exchange heat with its (i) Pressure in isothermal process is given by
environment. pi Vi = pf Vf
piVi
Example 4.7: An ideal gas of volume =pf = 15 atm
Vf
1.0L is adiabatically compressed to (ii) There will be no change in the temperature
(1/15)th of its initial volume. Its initial because it is an isothermal process.
pressure and temperature is 1.01 ×105 Pa (iii) Work done in isothermal process is
and 27°C respectively. Given CV for ideal given by V
gas = 20.8J/mol.K and γ = 1.4. Calculate (a) W nRT ln f , n 0.405
Vi
final pressure, (b) work done, and (c) final
0.0405 831 300 ( 0.270 )
temperature. (d) How would your answers
change, if the process were isothermal ? 2726 J
Solution: (a) To calculate the final pressure The work done during adiabatic process is
pf . This can be calculated by using very much less than the work done during
isothermal process. Can you explain
V this? What happens to this work which is
pi p f i
V apparently 'lost' ?
f
(1.01 105 Pa ) (15)1.4
Use your brain power
44.8 105 Pa (about 45 atm) .
(b) To calculate the work done, 1. Why is the p-V curve for adiabatic
W
p f V f piVi process steeper than that for isothermal
process? 2. Explain formation of clouds at
1 high altitude.
94
Work done in the process from B to A
Can you tell? along path 1 is given by the area under this
curve. In this process volume is decreasing
When the temperature of a system is
increased or decreased in an adiabatic therefore the work done is negative.
heating or cooling, is there any transfer of The total work done during the
heat to the system or from the system? complete cycle, from A to B along path 2
and form B to A along path 1 is the area
6. Cyclic Process:
enclosed by the closed loop. This is the
A thermodynamic process that returns a
difference between the area under the curve
system to its initial state is a cyclic process.
1 and that under the curve 2. Since the area
In this process, the initial and the final state is under curve 1 is negative and larger than
the same. Figure 4.19 shows the p-V diagram the area under the curve 2, the area of the
of a cyclic process. For a cyclic process, the loop is also negative. That means the work
total change in the internal energy of a system is done by the system is negative.
is zero. (∆U = 0). According to the first law (b) This is a cyclic process which means
of thermodynamics, we have, for a cyclic the initial and the final state of the
process, system is the same. For a cyclic process
Q = W --- (4.21) ∆U = 0, so Q = W = - 1000 J. That is,
1000 joules of heat must be rejected by the
system.
2 (c) If the direction of the cycle is changed
the work done will be positive. The system
will do work. Form this example we
1 conclude that: The total work done in a
cyclic process is positive if the process
is goes around the cycle in a clockwise
direction. The total work done in a cyclic
Fig. 4.19: p-V diagram of cyclic process. process is negative if the process goes
around the cycle in a counterclockwise
Remember this direction.
Working of all heat engines is a cyclic
process. Can you tell?
97
There is a fundamental limit on the efficiency The operating cycle begins at the point A
of a heat engine set by the second law of in the cycle. The working substance, the gas in
thermodynamics, which we will discuss later. this case, absorbs heat at constant volume and
Using Eq. (4.22) and Eq. (4.23) we can no work is done by the gas or on the gas. The
write the efficiency of a heat engine as, pressure is increased till the point B is reached.
W Q Q The temperature of the gas also increases and
1 C 1 c --- (4.25)
QH QH QH its internal energy increases.
The gas starts expanding by pushing the
Equation (4.25) gives the thermal
piston away and its volume changes from
efficiency of a heat engine. It is a ratio of the
the point B to the point C. Because the gas
quantities which represent energy. Therefore,
expands, its pressure is reduced. The gas does
it has no units but, we must express W, QH, and
work in this part of the cycle.
QC in the same units.
When the point C is reached, the excess
4.8.2 The Heat Engine Cycle and the p-V
heat, the heat that is not utilized in doing work
Diagram:
by the gas, is rejected. The gas cools down and
As discussed previously, the working
its internal energy decreases. This process is
of a heat engine is a well defined sequence
again at constant volume. The pressure of the
of operations. It is a cyclic thermodynamic
gas is reduced and point D on the p-V diagram
process. We know that a thermodynamic
is reached.
process can be represented by a p-V diagram.
The gas is now compressed. Its volume
We will now discuss the p-V diagram of a
decreases and its pressure increases. The
heat engine. Keep in mind that this is a p-V
change continues till the point A is reached.
diagram of a general heat engine. There are
The cycle is complete and the system is ready
different ways of operating a heat engine. We
for the next cycle.
will discuss some such heat engines in the
Thus, the p-V diagram is a visual tool
following sections.
for the study of heat engines. The working
A heat engine uses energy absorbed in the
substance of a heat engine is usually a gaseous
form of heat to do work and then rejects the
mixture. Study of the p-V diagram helps us
heat which cannot be used to do work. Heat is
understand the behavior of the three state
absorbed in one part of the cycle, work is done
variables of a gas throughout the operational
in another part, and the unused heat is rejected
cycle.
in yet other part of the cycle. The p-V diagram
The operation of a heat engine is a cyclic
of a typical heat engine is shown in Fig. (4.21).
process therefore, its p-V diagram is a closed
loop. The area of the loop represents the work
done during one complete cycle.
Since work is done by the gas, or on
the gas, only when its volume changes, the
p-V diagram provides a visual interpretation
of the work done during one complete cycle.
Similarly, the internal energy of the gas
depends upon its temperature. Hence, the
p-V diagram along with the temperatures
calculated from the ideal gas law determines
Fig. 4.21: p-V diagram of a typical heat engine. the changes in the internal energy of the gas.
98
We can calculate the amount of heat added or Figure 4.22 shows the concept of
rejected from the first law of thermodynamics. transferring heat from a cold region to a hot
Thus, a p-V diagram helps us analyze the region in a schematic way. Heat from the
performance of any heat engine which uses a cold region is carried to the hot region by
gas as its working substance. the refrigerant. It extracts heat from a cold
4.9 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps: region due to forced evaporation. The heat of
So far, we have discussed a heat engine evaporation of the refrigerant thus absorbed is
which takes heat from a source at higher rejected by compressing and condensing it into
temperature and rejects it to a sink at lower liquid at a higher temperature. All this process
temperature. The input provided to the working is carried out in a mechanism involving a
substance (a gas or a mixture of gasoline and compressor and closed tubing such as seen at
air) in a heat engine is in the form of heat the back of a house hold refrigerator.
which is converted into mechanical work as
output. Figure 4.20 shows this in the form of an
energy flow diagram. Refrigerators and heat
pumps are heat engines that work in backward
direction. They convert mechanical work into
heat.
4.9.1 Heat Flow from a Colder Region to a
Hotter Region:
According to the second law of
Fig. 4.22: Schematic diagram of transferring
thermodynamics (to be discussed in the next
heat from a cold region to a hot region.
article), heat cannot flow from a region of
4.9.2 Refrigerator:
lower temperature to a region of higher
Refrigeration is a process of cooling
temperature on its own. We can force heat to
a space or substance of a system and/or to
flow from a region of lower temperature to a
maintain its temperature below its ambient
region of higher temperature by doing work on
temperature. In simple words, refrigeration is
the system (or, on the working substance of a
artificial cooling.
heat engine). Refrigerators or air-conditioners
and heat pumps are examples of heat engines
which cause heat to be transferred from a
cold region to a hot region. Usually, this is
achieved with the aid of phase change of a
fluid, called the refrigerant. The refrigerant
is forced to evaporate and then condense by
successively decreasing and increasing its
pressure. It can, therefore, ‘pump’ energy
Fig. 4.23 (a): Schematics of a refrigerator.
from a region at lower temperature to a region
A refrigerator extracts heat from
of higher temperature. It extracts the heat of
a cold region (inside the chamber, or
vaporization of the refrigerant from the cold
the compartments) and delivers it to the
region and rejects it to the hotter region outside
surrounding (the atmosphere) thus, further
the refrigerator. This results in cooling down
cooling the cold region. That’s the reason
the cold region further.
why if you place your hand behind a working
99
refrigerator, you can feel the warm air. But up as heat is transferred to it from the contents
the interior of the refrigerator is cold. An air of the fridge. This takes place at constant
conditioner also works on similar principles. pressure, so it's an isobaric expansion.
Figure 4.23 (a) shows the schematics of Step 3: The gas is transferred to a compressor,
the mechanism used in a typical refrigerator. which does most of the work in this process.
It consists of a compressor, an expansion The gas is compressed adiabatically, heating
valve, and a closed tube which carries the it and turning it back to a liquid.
refrigerant. Part of the tube, called the cooling
Step 4: The hot liquid passes through coils on
coil, is in the region which is to be cooed at
the outside of the fridge, and heat is transferred
lower temperature and lower pressure. The
to the atmosphere. This is an isobaric
other part which is exposed to the surrounding
(generally, the atmosphere) is at a higher compression process.
temperature and higher pressure. A fluid The compressor is driven by an external
such as (fluorinated hydrocarbons) is used as energy source and it does the work |W| on the
refrigerant. Normally, the cold and the hot part working substance during each cycle.
of the coil contain the refrigerant as a mixture 4.9.3 Performance of a Refrigerator:
of liquid and vapour phase in equilibrium. Consider the energy flow diagram of
a refrigerator Fig. 4.23 (b). It shows the
relation between the work and heat involved
in transferring heat from a low temperature
region to a high temperature region. This is a
cyclic process in which the working substance,
the refrigerant in this case, is taken back to the
initial state.
For a refrigerator, the heat absorbed
by the working substance is QC and the heat
rejected by it is QH. A refrigerator absorbs
heat at lower temperature and rejects it at
Fig. 4.23 (b): Energy flow diagram of a
higher temperature, therefore, we have,
refrigerator. QC > 0, QH < 0, and W < 0. Hence, we write,
Figure 4.23 (b) shows the energy flow |W| and |QH| = - QH. In this case, we apply
diagram of a refrigerator. As you can see, the first law of thermodynamics to the cyclic
the heat extracted from a cold reservoir is process. For a cyclic process, the internal
supplemented by the mechanical work done energy of the system in the initial state and
(on the refrigerant) by the compressor and the the final state is the same, therefore, from
total energy is rejected at the hot reservoir. The Eq. (4.21), we have,
refrigerant goes through the following steps in QH QC W , or QH QC W 0
one complete cycle of refrigeration.
QH QC –W
Step 1: The fluid passes through a nozzle and
For a refrigerator, QH < 0, and W < 0, therefore,
expands into a low-pressure area. Similar to
QH Qc W ---(4.26)
the way carbon dioxide comes out of a fire
From the Fig.4.23 (b), we realize that the
extinguisher and cools down, the fluid turns
heat |QH| rejected by the working substance at
into a gas and cools down. This is essentially
the hot reservoir is always greater than the heat
an adiabatic expansion.
QC received by it at the cold reservoir. Note
Step 2: The cool gas is in thermal contact with
that the Eq. (4.26), derived for a refrigerator
the inner compartment of the fridge. It heats
100
and the Eq. (4.23), derived for a heat engine, Qc
are the same. They are valid for a heat engine an air conditioner is defined by K = . It is
W
and also for a refrigerator. important to consider the rate of heat removed
Q H and the power P required for removing the
The ratio c indicates the performance
W heat.
of a refrigerator and is called the coefficient We define the rate of heat removed as
of performance (CoP), K, or quality factor, Q
or Q-value of a refrigerator. Larger is the the heat current H = c , where, t is the time
ratio, better is the refrigerator. That means a t
refrigerator has the best performance when in which heat Qc is removed. Therefore, the
the heat extracted by the refrigerant at the coefficient of performance of an air conditioner
cold reservoir is maximum by doing minimum can be calculated as,
work in one operating cycle. Qc Ht H
=K = = --- (4.28)
From Eq. (4.26), W Qc QH W Pt P
Qc Qc Typical values of K are 2.5 to 3.0 for room air
K --- (4.27) conditioners.
W Qc QH
All the quantities on the right side of Do you know?
Eq. (4.27) represent energy and are measured
in the same energy units. The coefficient of Capacity of an air conditioner is expressed
performance, K of a refrigerator is, therefore, a in tonne. Do you know why?
Before refrigerator and AC was
dimensionless number. For a typical household
invented, cooling was done by using
refrigerator, K ≈ 5.
blocks of ice. When cooling machines were
invented, their capacity was expressed
Remember this
in terms of the equivalent amount of ice
Refrigerator transfers heat from inside a melted in a day (24 hours). The same term
closed space to its external environment so is used even today.
that inside space is cooled to temperature 4.9.5 Heat Pump:
below the ambient temperature.
Heat pump is a device which works
similar to a refrigerator. It is used to heat a
Do you know? building or a similar larger structure by cooling
the air outside it. A heat pump works like a
Capacity of a refrigerator is expressed in
litre. It is the volume available inside a refrigerator operating inside out. In this case,
refrigerator. the evaporator coils are outside and absorb
heat from the cold air from outside. The
4.9.4 Air conditioner:
condenser coils are inside the building. They
Working of an air conditioner and a
release the absorbed heat to the air inside the
refrigerator is exactly similar. It differs from a
thus, warming the building.
refrigerator only in the volume of the chamber/
room it cools down. For an air conditioner, the Remember this
evaporator coils are inside the room that is to be
cooled and the condenser is outside the room. Heat flow from a hot object to a cold object
The air cooled by the evaporator coils inside is spontaneous whereas, work is always
the room is circulated by a fan placed inside required for the transfer of heat from a
the air conditioning unit. The performance of colder object to a hotter object.
101
4.10 Second Law of Thermodynamics: These practical observations form the basis of
4.10.1 Limitations of the First Law of a very important principle of thermodynamics,
Thermodynamics: the Second law of thermodynamics.
The First law of thermodynamics tells us The Second law of thermodynamics is
that heat can be converted into work and work a general principle which puts constraints
can also be converted into heat. It is merely upon the direction of heat transfer and the
a quantitative statement of the equivalence of efficiencies that a heat engine can achieve.
heat and work. It has the following limitations. A
(a) It does not tell us whether any particular
Fig. 4.24 (a): Energy
process can actually occur. According to the of an object at two
first law of thermodynamics, heat may, on its B
different hights.
own, flow from an object at higher temperature
to one at lower temperature and it can also,
on its own, flow from an object at lower
temperature to one at higher temperature. We
know that practically, heat cannot flow from
an object at lower temperature to another
Fig. 4.24 (b):
at higher temperature. The First law of Limitations on efficiency
thermodynamics does not predict this practical of a heat engine.
observation.
(b) According to the First law, we could
convert all (100%) of the heat available to Consider an object A at certain height
us into work. Similarly, all the work could of h above the ground and another object B
be converted into heat. Again, we know that of the same mass a height of h/2 as shown in
practically this is not possible. Fig. 4.24 (a). We know that potential energy
Thus, the First law of thermodynamics of the object B is half that of the object A. That
does not prevent us from converting heat means we can extract only half the energy
entirely into work or work entirely into heat. from the object B. Similarly, if a heat engine
These limitations lead to the formulation of as shown in Fig. 4.24 (b) operates between
another law of thermodynamics called the the temperatures of 800 K and 400 K, i.e., if it
Second law of thermodynamics. We will receives heat at 800 K and rejects it at 400 K,
discuss this at a later stage in this chapter. its maximum efficiency can be 50%.
We have seen earlier in section 4.7.3 that 4.10.2 The second law of thermodynamics,
an irreversible process defines the preferred statement:
direction of an irreversible process. It is also We now know that heat can be converted
found that it is impossible to build a heat into work by using a heat engine. However,
engine that has 100% efficiency Eq. (4.25). our practical experience says that entire
That is, it is not possible to build a heat engine heat supplied to the working substance can
that can completely convert heat into work. never be converted into mechanical work.
Similarly, for a refrigerator it is impossible Second law of thermodynamics helps us to
to remove heat without doing any work on a understand this. According to the second law
system. That is, the coefficient of performance, of thermodynamics, “It is impossible to extract
Eq. (4.28) of a refrigerator can never be infinite. an amount of heat QH from a hot reservoir
and use it all to do work W. Some amount of
102
heat QC must be exhausted to a cold reservoir. This means that energy will not
This prohibits the possibility of a perfect heat flow spontaneously from an object at
engine”. low temperature to an object at a higher
Sometimes it is also called as the ‘Engine temperature. This rules out the possibility
Law’ or the ‘Engine Statement’ of the Second of a perfect refrigerator. The statements
law of thermodynamics. about refrigerators are also applicable to air
conditioners and heat pumps, which work on
the same principles.
This is the ‘Second form’ or
Fig. 4.25 (a): Second law Clausius statement of the Second law of
of thermodynamics. thermodynamics. Sometimes it is also
called as the ‘Refrigerator Law’ or the
‘Refrigerator Statement’ of the Second law of
thermodynamics.
105
2. Efficiency of a Carnot engine is independent temperature TH. Useful work is done by the
of its working substance. gas in this part of the cycle.
We can also show that “A Carnot • Isochoric process (BC): Part of the heat
refrigerator has a greater coefficient of absorbed (QH) by the gas in the previous
performance among all the refrigerators part of the cycle is released by the gas to
working between the same two temperatures.” the refrigerator. This heat (Q) is used in the
4.12 Sterling Cycle: next part of the cycle. The gas cools down
to temperature TC.
• Isothermal compression (CD): The heat
generated in this part of the cycle (QC)
is rejected to the coolant (sink). The
temperature of the gas is maintained at TC
during this process.
• Isobaric heat absorption (DA): The
compressed gas absorbs heat (Q) during
this process. Its temperature is increased to
T H.
The cycle repeats when the process
reaches the point A.
Internet my friend
107
4. A gas contained in a cylinder fitted with 11. The figure shows the V-T diagram for
a frictionless piston expands against a one cycle of a hypothetical heat engine
constant external pressure of 1 atm from which uses the ideal gas. Draw (a) the
a volume of 5 litres to a volume of 10 p-V diagram and p-T diagram of the
litres. In doing so it absorbs 400 J of system.
thermal energy from its surroundings. V
Determine the change in internal energy
of system. [Ans: 106.65 J]
5. A system releases 125 kJ of heat while
104 kJ of work is done on the system.
Calculate the change in internal energy.
T
[Ans: ∆U = 21 kJ]
6. Efficiency of a Carnot cycle is 75%. p
V V
[Ans: AB = 2.4 × 106 J, CD = 8 × 105 J, BC and
[Ans: 7.85 × 104 J]
DA zero, because constant volume change]
108
5. Oscillations
a definite interval of time is called periodic
Can you recall? motion. A body performing periodic motion
goes on repeating the same set of movements.
1. What do you mean by linear motion
and angular motion? The time taken for one such set of movements
2. Can you give some practical examples is called its period or periodic time. At the end
of oscillations in our daily life? of each set of movements, the state of the body
3. What do you know about restoring is the same as that at the beginning. Some
force? examples of periodic motion are the motion
4. All musical instruments make use of of the moon around the earth and the motion
oscillations, can you identify, where? of other planets around the sun, the motion of
5. Why does a ball floating on water
electrons around the nucleus, etc. As seen in
bobs up and down, if pushed down and
released? Chapter 1, the uniform circular motion of any
object is thus a periodic motion.
5.1 Introduction: Another type of periodic motion in
Oscillation is a very common and which a particle repeatedly moves to and
interesting phenomenon in the world of Physics. fro along the same path is the oscillatory or
In our daily life we come across various vibratory motion. Every oscillatory motion is
examples of oscillatory motion, like rocking periodic but every periodic motion need not be
of a cradle, swinging of a swing, motion of the oscillatory. Circular motion is periodic but it is
pendulum of a clock, the vibrations of a guitar not oscillatory.
or violin string, up and down motion of the The simplest form of oscillatory periodic
needle of a sewing machine, the motion of the motion is the simple harmonic motion in which
prongs of a vibrating tuning fork, oscillations every particle of the oscillating body moves
of a spring, etc. In these cases, the motion to and fro, about its mean position, along a
repeated after a certain interval of time is a certain fixed path. If the path is a straight line,
periodic motion. Here the motion of an object the motion is called linear simple harmonic
is mostly to and fro or up and down. motion and if the path is an arc of a circle,
Oscillatory motion is a periodic motion. In it is called angular simple harmonic motion.
this chapter, we shall see that the displacement, The smallest interval of time after which the to
velocity and acceleration for this motion can be and fro motion is repeated is called its period
represented by sine and cosine functions. These (T) and the number of oscillations completed
functions are known as harmonic functions. per unit time is called the frequency (n) of the
Therefore, an oscillatory motion obeying such periodic motion.
functions is called harmonic motion. After
studying this chapter, you will be able to Can you tell?
understand the use of appropriate terminology
to describe oscillations, simple harmonic Is the motion of a leaf of a tree blowing in
motion (S.H.M.), graphical representations the wind periodic?
of S.H.M., energy changes during S.H.M., 5.3 Linear Simple Harmonic Motion
damping of oscillations, resonance, etc. (S.H.M.):
5.2 Explanation of Periodic Motion: Place a rectangular block on a smooth
Any motion which repeats itself after frictionless horizontal surface. Attach one end
109
of a spring to a rigid wall and the other end to f kx --- (5.1)
the block as shown in Fig. 5.1. Pull the block where, k is a constant that depends upon the
of mass m towards the right and release it. The elastic properties of the spring. It is called the
block will begin its to and fro motion on either force constant. The negative sign indicates
side of its equilibrium position. This motion is that the force and displacement are oppositely
linear simple harmonic motion. directed.
If the block is displaced towards left from
its equilibrium position, the force exerted by
the spring on the block is directed towards the
right and its magnitude is proportional to the
displacement from the mean position. (Fig.
5.1(c))
Thus, f = - kx can be used as the equation
of motion of the block.
Now if the block is released from the
rightmost position, the restoring force exerted
by the spring accelerates it towards its
equilibrium position. The acceleration (a) of
the block is given by,
f k
a x --- (5.2)
m m
Fig. 5.1 (a), (b) and (c): Spring mass oscillator. where, m is mass of the block. This shows
that the acceleration is also proportional to
Remember this
the displacement and its direction is opposite
For such a motion, as a convention, we shall to that of the displacement, i.e., the force and
always measure the displacement from the acceleration are both directed towards the
mean position. Also, as the entire motion mean or equilibrium position.
is along a single straight line, we need not As the block moves towards the mean
use vector notation (only ± signs will be position, its speed starts increasing due to
enough). its acceleration, but its displacement from
Fig. 5.1(b) shows the equilibrium position the mean position goes on decreasing. When
in which the spring exerts no force on the the block returns to its mean position, the
block. If the block is displaced towards the displacement and hence force and acceleration
right from its equilibrium position, the force are zero. The speed of the block at the mean
exerted by the spring on the block is directed position becomes maximum and hence its
towards the left [Fig. 5.1(a)]. On account of its kinetic energy attains its maximum value.
elastic properties, the spring tends to regain its Thus, the block does not stop at the mean
original shape and size and therefore it exerts a position, but continues to move beyond the
restoring force on the block. This is responsible mean position towards the left. During this
to bring it back to the original position. This process, the spring is compressed and it exerts
force is proportional to the displacement but its a restoring force on the block towards right.
direction is opposite to that of the displacement. Once again, the force and displacement are
If x is the displacement, the restoring force f is oppositely directed. This opposing force
given by, retards the motion of the block, so that the
110
speed goes on reducing and finally it becomes
zero. This position is shown in Fig. 5.1(c). In Activity
this position the displacement from the mean
position and restoring force are maximum. Some experiments described below can be
This force now accelerates the block towards performed in the classroom to demonstrate
the right, towards the equilibrium position. The S.H.M. Try to write their equations.
process goes on repeating that causes the block
to oscillate on either side of its equilibrium (a) A hydrometer is
(mean) position. Such oscillatory motion along immersed in a glass jar
a straight path is called linear simple harmonic filled with water. In the
motion (S.H.M.). Linear S.H.M. is defined as equilibrium position
the linear periodic motion of a body, in which it floats vertically in
force (or acceleration) is always directed water. If it is slightly
towards the mean position and its magnitude depressed and released, it bobs up and down
is proportional to the displacement from the performing linear S.H.M.
mean position. (b) A U-tube is filled with a sufficiently long
column of mercury. Initially when both the
Use your brain power
If there is friction between a block and
the resting surface, how will it govern the
motion of the block?
arms of U tube are exposed
Remember this to atmosphere, the level of
A complete oscillation is when the object mercury in both the arms
goes from one extreme to other and back to is the same. Now, if the level of mercury
the initial position. in one of the arms is depressed slightly
The conditions required for simple harmonic and released, the level of mercury in each
motion are: arm starts moving up and down about the
1. Oscillation of the particle is about a equilibrium position, performing linear
fixed point. S.H.M.
2. The net force or acceleration is always
directed towards the fixed point. 5.4 Differential Equation of S.H.M. :
3. The particle comes back to the fixed In a linear S.H.M., the force is directed
point due to restoring force. towards the mean position and its magnitude
Harmonic oscillation is that oscillation is directly proportional to the displacement
which can be expressed in terms of a single of the body from mean position. As seen in
harmonic function, such as x a sin t or Eq. (5.1),
x a cos t f = - kx
Non-harmonic oscillation is that oscillation where k is force constant and x is displacement
from the mean position.
which cannot be expressed in terms of single
According to Newton’s second law of motion,
harmonic function. It may be a combination
f = ma ∴ ma = - kx --- (5.3)
of two or more harmonic oscillations such
dx
as x = a sin ω t + b sin2 ω t , etc. The velocity of the particle is, v=
dt
111
dv d2x d2x
and its acceleration, a = = 2 ∴ 2 x
2
--- (5.6)
dt dt dt
Substituting it in Eq. (5.3), we get d2x
d2x But a = 2 is the acceleration of the particle
m 2 kx dt
dt performing S.H.M.
d2x k ∴ a 2 x --- (5.7)
2 x 0 --- (5.4)
dt m This is the expression for acceleration in terms
k of displacement x.
Substituting 2 , where ω is the d2x
angular frequency, m From Eq. (5.6), we have 2 2 x
dt
d2x d dx
∴ 2
x
dt dt
2x 0 --- (5.5)
2
dt
Eq. (5.5) is the differential equation of linear dv
2 x
S.H.M. dt
dv dx
2 x
Can you tell? dx dt
dv
Why is the symbol ω and also the term v 2 x
dx
angular frequency used for a linear motion? v dv 2 x dx
Example 5.1 A body of mass 0.2 kg Integrating both the sides, we get
v dv x dx
2
performs linear S.H.M. It experiences
a restoring force of 0.2 N when its v2 2x2
C , --- (5.8)
displacement from the mean position is 4 2 2
cm. Determine (i) force constant (ii) period
of S.H.M. and (iii) acceleration of the where C is the constant of integration.
body when its displacement from the mean Let A be the maximum displacement
position is 1 cm. (amplitude) of the particle in S.H.M.
Solution: (i) Force constant, When the particle is at the extreme
k = f / x position, velocity (v) is zero.
= (0.2)/ 0.04 = 5 N/m Thus, at x A,v 0
(ii) Period T 2 / Substituting in Eq. (5.8), we get
m 0.2 2 A2
0 C
= 2 2 = 0.4π s 2
k 5
(iii) Acceleration 2 A2
C --- (5.9)
k 5 2
a 2 x x 0.04 1 m s 2
m 0 .2 Using C in Eq. (5.8), we get
5.5 Acceleration (a), Velocity (v) and v2 2 x 2 2 A2
Displacement (x) of S.H.M. : 2 2 2
We can obtain expressions for the
v 2 2 A2 x 2
acceleration, velocity and displacement of
a particle performing S.H.M. by solving the v A2 x 2 --- (5.10)
differential equation of S.H.M. in terms of This is the expression for the velocity of a
displacement x and time t. 2 particle performing linear S.H.M. in terms of
d x displacement x .
From Eq. (5.5), we have 2x 0 dx
dt 2
Substituting v = in Eq. (5.10), we get
dt
112
dx
A2 x 2 In the cases (i) and (ii) above, we have used
dt
dx the phrase, “if the particle starts S.H.M…...”
dt More specifically, it is not the particle that
A2 x 2
starts its S.H.M., but we (the observer)
Integrating both the sides, we get
dx start counting the time t form that instant.
A2 x 2 dt The particle is already performing its
motion. We start recording the time as per
x our convenience. In other words, t = 0 (or
sin 1 t --- (5.11)
A initial condition) is always subjective to the
Here φ is the constant of integration. To observer.
know φ , we need to know the value of x at
any instance of time t, most convenient being Expressions of displacement (x), velocity (v)
t = 0. and acceleration (a) at time t:
x Asin t --- (5.12) From Eq. (5.12), x Asin t
dx
This is the general expression for the v A cos t
dt
displacement (x) of a particle performing
dv
linear S.H.M. at time t. Let us find expressions a A 2 sin t
dt
for displacement for two particular cases.
Case (i) If the particle starts S.H.M. from the Example 5.2: A particle performs linear
mean position, x = 0 at t = 0 S.H.M. of period 4 seconds and amplitude
x
Using Eq. (5.11), we get sin 1 0 or 4 cm. Find the time taken by it to travel a
A
Substituting in Eq. (5.12), we get distance of 1 cm from the positive extreme
x A sin t --- (5.13) position.
This is the expression for displacement at any Solution: x Asin t
instant if the particle starts S.H.M. from the Since particle performs S.H.M. from
π
mean position. Positive sign to be chosen if it positive extreme position, φ = and
2
starts towards positive and negative sign for from data
starting towards negative. x A 1 3cm
2
Case (ii) If the particle starts S.H.M. from the 3 4 sin t
extreme position, x Aat t 0 T 2
3 2 π
x
sin 1 or
3 ∴ cos t = cos t
A 2 2 4 4 2
c
Substituting in Eq. (5.12), we get
∴ t 41.4 41.4
t = 0.46s
0
3 2 180
x A sin t or x A sin t
2 2 180
∴ x A cos t --- (5.14) Or , 2 t 41.4
t 0.46 s
This is the expression for displacement at any
Example 5.3: A particle performing
instant, if the particle starts S.H.M. from the
linear S.H.M. with period 6 second is
extreme position. Positive sign for starting
at the positive extreme position at t = 0.
from positive extreme position and negative
The particle is found to be at a distance
sign for starting from the negative extreme
of 3 cm from this position at time t = 7s,
position.
before reaching the mean position. Find the
113
amplitude of S.H.M.
x Asin ∴ xmax A
Solution: x Asin( t ) 2
Thus, at the extreme position the displacement
Since particle starts (t = 0) from positive
of the particle performing S.H.M. is maximum.
extreme position, φ = π/2 and x A 3
2) Velocity: According to Eq. (5.10) the
x A sin t magnitude of velocity of the particle performing
2
2 S.H.M. is v A2 x 2
A 3 Asin t At the mean position, x 0 v max A .
T 2
A3 2 Thus, the velocity of the particle in S.H.M.
sin 7 is maximum at the mean position.
A 6 2
A3 7 At the extreme position, x A v min 0.
sin Thus, the velocity of the particle in S.H.M.
A 3 2
A3 1 is minimum at the extreme positions.
sin cos 3) Acceleration: The magnitude of the
A 3 2 3 2
acceleration of the particle in S.H.M is ω 2 x
2 A 6 A
At the mean position x= 0 , so that the
A 6cm
acceleration is minimum. ∴ a min 0 .
Example 5.4: The speeds of a particle At the extreme positions x A , so that the
performing linear S.H.M. are 8 cm/s and acceleration is maximum amax = ω A
2
115
If ks is the effective spring constant (as if Let f 1 k1e,f 2 k 2 e, be the individual
there is a single spring that gives the same restoring forces.
total extension for the same force), we can If kp is the effective spring constant, a
write,
f 1 1 1 1 1 single spring of this spring constant will be
e f stretched by the same extension e, by the
ks k1 k 2 k s k1 k 2
same stretching force f.
For a number of such (massless) springs, in f k p e f 1 f 2 k1e k 2 e
series, 1 1 1 1 k p k1 k 2 ki
k s k1 k 2
i k
i
For only two massless springs of For m such identical massless springs of
spring constant k each, in parallel, k p = mk
spring constant k each, in series,
kk Product 5.7 Reference Circle Method:
ks 1 2
k1 k 2 Sum Figure 5.3 shows a rod rotating along a
For n such identical massless springs, in vertical circle in the x-y plane. If the rod is
k illuminated parallel to x-axis from either side
series, k s = by a linear source parallel to the rod, as shown
n
in the Fig. 5.3, the shadow (projection) of the
rod will be produced on the y-axis. The tip of
this shadow can be seen to be oscillating about
the origin, along the y-axis.
Fig. A
117
on a diameter, of the respective quantities for
the reference circular motion. The angular − 3
is at A , heading to the mean position.
displacement t can thus be used as 2
the phase of S.H.M. as it varies continuously Determine the phase angle.
with time. In this case, it will be called as the Solution:
c c
3
phase angle. A sin 1 A 1 or 2
2 3 3
Special cases:
(i) Phase θ = 0 indicates that the particle From negative side, the particle is heading to
is at the mean position, moving to the the mean position. Thus, the phase angle is
positive, during the beginning of the first in the fourth quadrant for that oscillation.
c
oscillation. Phase angle 360 0 or 2 c
1 2
is the beginning of the second oscillation, 3
and so on for the successive oscillations. As it is the third oscillation, phase
(ii) Phase 180 0 or c indicates that during
2 2 1 4 2
its first oscillation, the particle is at the 3
mean position and moving to the negative. c
17
6
Similar state in the second oscillation will 3 3
have phase 360 180 or 2 ,
0 c
2 Acceleration a A 2 sin t
for the successive oscillations.
3
c
(a)
(b)
(b)
(c)
Special cases: (i) If the two S.H.M.s are in has potential energy (elastic - in the case of
a spring, gravitational - for a pendulum,
phase, ( φ1 - φ2 ) = 0°, ∴ cos ( φ1 - φ2 ) = 1. magnetic - for a magnet, etc.). Total energy of
R A12 A22 2 A1A2 A1 A2 . Further, the particle performing an S.H.M. is thus the
if A1 = A2 = A, we get R = 2A sum of its kinetic and potential energies.
Consider a particle of mass m, performing
(ii) If the two S.H.M.s are 90° out of phase, a linear S.H.M. along the path MN about the
( φ1 - φ2 ) = 90° ∴cos ( φ1 - φ2 ) = 0. mean position O. At a given instant, let the
∴ R A12 A22 Further, if A1= A2 = A, we particle be at P, at a distance x from O.
get, R = 2 A
(iii) If the two S.H.M.s are 180° out of phase,
( φ1 - φ2 ) = 180° ∴cos ( φ1 - φ2 ) = -1 Fig. 5.8: Energy in an S.H.M.
∴ R A A 2 A1 A2 ∴ R A1 A2
2
1
2
2 Velocity of the particle in S.H.M. is given
Further, if A1 = A2 = A, we get R = 0 as v A2 x 2 A cos t ,
120
where x is the displacement of the particle constant, the total energy of the particle at any
performing S.H.M. and A is the amplitude of point P is constant (independent of x and t). In
S.H.M. other words, the energy is conserved in S.H.M.
Thus, the kinetic energy, If n is the frequency in S.H.M., 2 n .
1 1
Using this in Eq. (5.24), we get
Ek m 2 A 2 x 2 k A 2 x 2 --- (5.21) 1
E m 2 n A2 2 2 n 2 A2 m
2
2 2
This is the kinetic energy at displacement x. 2
At time t, it is A2
2 m 2
2 --- (5.25)
1 1 T
Ek mv 2 mA2 2 cos 2 t Thus, the total energy in S.H.M. is directly
2 2
proportional to (a) the mass of the particle
1
kA 2 cos 2 t --- (5.22) (b) the square of the amplitude (c) the square
2
of the frequency (d) the force constant, and
Thus, with time, it varies as cos 2 θ .
inversely proportional to square of the period.
The restoring force acting on the particle
at point P is given by f = - kx where k is the force Can you tell?
constant. Suppose that the particle is displaced
further by an infinitesimal displacement dx To start a pendulum swinging, usually you
against the restoring force f. The external work pull it slightly to one side and release.
done (dW) during this displacement is • What kind of energy is transferred to the
dW f dx kx dx kxdx mass in doing this?
• Describe the energy changes that occur
The total work done on the particle to
when the mass is released.
displace it from O to P is given by
x x
1 • Is/are there any other way/ways to start
W dW kx dx kx 2
2 the oscillations of a pendulum? Which
0 0
energy is supplied in this case/cases?
This should be the potential energy (P.E.)
Special cases: (i) At the mean position, x = 0
Ep of the particle at displacement x.
and velocity is maximum.
1 1 1
E p kx 2 m 2 x 2 --- (5.23) Hence E Ek max m 2 A2 and potential
2 2 2
At time t, it is energy E p 0
1 1 min
E p kx 2 kA2 sin 2 t (ii) At the extreme positions, the velocity of the
2 2
particle is zero and x A
1
mA2 2 cos 2 t 1
Hence E E p m 2 A2 and kinetic
2 max 2
Thus, with time, it varies as sin 2 θ . energy Ek min 0
The total energy of the particle is the sum As the particle oscillates, the energy
of its kinetic energy and potential energy. changes between kinetic and potential. At the
E Ek E p mean position, the energy is entirely kinetic;
Using Eq. (5.21) and Eq. (5.23), we get while at the extreme positions, it is entirely
1 1
E m 2 A2 x 2 m 2 x 2
2 2
potential. At other positions the energy is
partly kinetic and partly potential. However,
1 1 1
E m 2 A2 kA 2 m v max ---(5.24)
2
the total energy is always conserved.
2 2 2 (iii) If K . E .= P. E .,
This expression gives the total energy
1 A
of the particle at point P. As m, ω and A are
2
1
m 2 A2 x 2 mω 2 x 2 x
2 2
121
A E The distance between the point of
Thus at x , the K.E. = P.E. = for a suspension and centre of gravity of the bob
2 2
particle performing linear S.H.M. (point of oscillation) is called the length of the
A 1 11 E pendulum. Let m be the mass of the bob and
(iv) At x , P.E. kx 2 kA 2
2 2 42 4 T' be the tension in the string. The pendulum
K.E. 3 P.E remains in equilibrium in the position OA,
A with the centre of gravity of the bob, vertically
Thus, at x , the energy is 25% potential below the point of suspension O. If now the
2
and 75% kinetic. pendulum is displaced through a small angle
The variation of K.E. and P.E. with θ (called angular amplitude) and released, it
displacement in S.H.M. is shown in Fig. (5.9) begins to oscillate on either side of the mean
(equilibrium) position in a single vertical
plane. We shall now show that the bob
performs S.H.M. about the mean position for
small angular amplitude θ .
Rigid support
4 1.7 10 5
B 2 10 5 Wbm 2 or T
3.4
directly proportional to the speed v of the vane m 2 m
and the block The damping increases the period (slows down
Fd bv the motion) and decreases the amplitude.
Where b is the damping constant and negative 5.15 Free Oscillations, Forced Oscillations
sign indicates that Fd opposes the velocity. and Resonance:
For spring constant k, the force on the Free Oscillations: If an object is allowed
block from the spring is Fs kx . to oscillate or vibrate on its own, it does so
Assuming that the gravitational force with its natural frequency (or with one of its
on the block is negligible compared to Fd and natural frequencies). For example, if the bob
Fs , the total force acting on the mass at any of a simple pendulum of length l is displaced
time t is and released, it will oscillate only with the
F Fd Fs 1 g
ma Fd Fs frequency n which is called its
2 l
ma bv kx natural frequency and the oscillations are
ma bv kx 0 free oscillations. However, by applying a
d2x dx periodic force, the same pendulum can be
m 2 b kx 0 --- (5.35)
dt dt made to oscillate with different frequency. The
The solution of Eq. (5.35) describes the oscillations then will be forced oscillations
motion of the block under the influence of a and the frequency is driver frequency or forced
damping force which is proportional to the frequency.
speed.
127
Consider the arrangement shown in absorbs maximum energy from the source. In
the Fig. 5.15. There are four pendula tied to such case, it is said to be in resonance with
a string. Pendula A and C are of the same the source (pendulum A). For unequal natural
length, pendulum B is shorter and pendulum frequencies on either side (higher or lower), the
D is longer. Pendulum A is having a solid energy absorbed (hence, the amplitude) is less.
rubber ball as its bob and will act as the driver If the activity is repeated for a set of pendula
pendulum or source pendulum. Other three of different lengths and squares of their
pendula are having hollow rubber balls as their amplitudes are plotted against their natural
bobs and will act as the driven pendula. As the frequencies, the plot will be similar to that
pendula A and C are of the same lengths, their shown in the Fig. 5.16. The peak occurs when
natural frequencies are the same. Pendulum the forced frequency matches with the natural
B has higher natural frequency as it is shorter frequency, i.e., at the resonant frequency.
and pendulum D is of lower natural frequency
than that of A and C.
1. Choose the correct option. (D) The kinetic energy is equal to total
i) A particle performs linear S.H.M. energy at time T/4.
starting from the mean position. Its
amplitude is A and time period is T. At
the instance when its speed is half the
maximum speed, its displacement x is
3 2
(A) A (B) A
3 2. Answer in brief.
2
1 i) Define linear simple harmonic motion.
(C) A 2 (D) A ii) Using differential equation of linear
2 S.H.M, obtain the expression for (a)
ii) A body of mass 1 kg is performing linear
velocity in S.H.M., (b) acceleration in
S.H.M. Its displacement x (cm) at t S.H.M.
(second) is given by iii) Obtain the expression for the period of a
x = 6 sin (100t + π/4). Maximum kinetic simple pendulum performing S.H.M.
energy of the body is iv) State the laws of simple pendulum.
(A) 36 J (B) 9 J v) Prove that under certain conditions a
(C) 27 J (D) 18 J magnet vibrating in uniform magnetic
field performs angular S.H.M.
iii) The length of second's pendulum on the
3. Obtain the expression for the period of a
surface of earth is nearly 1 m. Its length magnet vibrating in a uniform magnetic
on the surface of moon should be [Given: field and performing S.H.M.
acceleration due to gravity (g) on moon 4. Show that a linear S.H.M. is the
is 1/6 th of that on the earth’s surface] projection of a U.C.M. along any of its
(A) 1/6 m (B) 6 m diameter.
1 5. Draw graphs of displacement, velocity
(C) 1/36 m (D) m and acceleration against phase angle,
6
iv) Two identical springs of constant k are for a particle performing linear S.H.M.
from (a) the mean position (b) the
connected, first in series and then in
positive extreme position. Deduce your
parallel. A metal block of mass m is conclusions from the graph.
suspended from their combination. The 6. Deduce the expressions for the kinetic
ratio of their frequencies of vertical energy and potential energy of a particle
oscillations will be in a ratio executing S.H.M. Hence obtain the
(A) 1:4 (B) 1:2 (C) 2:1 (D) 4:1 expression for total energy of a particle
v) The graph shows variation of performing S.H.M and show that the
total energy is conserved. State the
displacement of a particle performing
factors on which total energy depends.
S.H.M. with time t. Which of the 7. Deduce the expression for period of
following statements is correct from the simple pendulum. Hence state the factors
graph? on which its period depends.
(A) The acceleration is maximum at 8. At what distance from the mean position
time T. is the speed of a particle performing
(B) The force is maximum at time 3T/4. S.H.M. half its maximum speed. Given
(C) The velocity is zero at time T/2. path length of S.H.M. = 10 cm.
[Ans: 4.33 cm]
129
9. In SI units, the differential equation 18. The period of oscillation of a body of
2
d x mass m1 suspended from a light spring
of an S.H.M. is 2
36 x . Find its
dt is T. When a body of mass m2 is tied to
frequency and period. the first body and the system is made to
[Ans: 0.955 Hz, 1.05 s] oscillate, the period is 2T. Compare the
10. A needle of a sewing machine moves masses m1 and m2 [Ans: 1/3]
along a path of amplitude 4 cm with
19. The displacement of an oscillating
frequency 5 Hz. Find its acceleration
particle is given by x asin t bcos t
1
30 s after it has crossed the mean where a, b and ω are constants. Prove
that the particle performs a linear S.H.M.
position. [Ans: 34.2 m/s2]
with amplitude A a 2 b 2
11. Potential energy of a particle performing
20. Two parallel S.H.M.s represented by
linear S.H.M is 0.1 π2 x2 joule. If mass of
x1 = 5sin (4π t + π/3) cm and x2 = 3sin
the particle is 20 g, find the frequency of
(4πt + π/4) cm are superposed on a
S.H.M. [Ans: 1.581 Hz]
particle. Determine the amplitude and
12. The total energy of a body of mass 2 kg
epoch of the resultant S.H.M.
performing S.H.M. is 40 J. Find its speed
[Ans: 7.936 cm, 54° 23']
while crossing the centre of the path.
21. A 20 cm wide thin circular disc of mass
[Ans: 6.324 cm/s]
200 g is suspended to a rigid support
13. A simple pendulum performs S.H.M of
from a thin metallic string. By holding
period 4 seconds. How much time after
the rim of the disc, the string is twisted
crossing the mean position, will the
through 60o and released. It now performs
displacement of the bob be one third of
its amplitude. [Ans: 0.2163 s] angular oscillations of period 1 second.
14. A simple pendulum of length 100 cm Calculate the maximum restoring torque
performs S.H.M. Find the restoring force generated in the string under undamped
acting on its bob of mass 50 g when the conditions. (π3 ≈ 31)
displacement from the mean position is [Ans: 0.04133 N m]
3 cm. -2
[Ans: 1.48 × 10 N] 22. Find the number of oscillations
15. Find the change in length of a second’s performed per minute by a magnet is
pendulum, if the acceleration due to vibrating in the plane of a uniform field
gravity at the place changes from 9.75 of 1.6 × 10-5 Wb/m2. The magnet has
m/s2 to 9.8 m/s2. moment of inertia 3 × 10-6 kg/m2 and
[Ans: Decreases by 0.0051 m] magnetic moment 3 A m2.
16. At what distance from the mean position [Ans:38.19 osc/min.]
is the kinetic energy of a particle 23. A wooden block of mass m is kept
performing S.H.M. of amplitude 8 cm, on a piston that can perform vertical
three times its potential energy? vibrations of adjustable frequency and
[Ans: 4 cm] amplitude. During vibrations, we don’t
17. A particle performing linear S.H.M. want the block to leave the contact
of period 2π seconds about the mean
with the piston. How much maximum
position O is observed to have a speed
frequency is possible if the amplitude of
of b 3 m / s , when at a distance b
vibrations is restricted to 25 cm? In this
(metre) from O. If the particle is moving
case, how much is the energy per unit
away from O at that instant, find the
mass of the block? (g ≈ π2 ≈ 10 m s -2)
time required by the particle, to travel a
[Ans: nmax = 1/s, E/m = 1.25 J/kg]
further distance b. [Ans: π/3 s]
130
6. Superposition of Waves
The water is displaced locally where the stone
Can you recall? actually falls in water. The disturbance slowly
spreads and distant particles get disturbed from
1. What is wave motion?
their position of rest. The wave disturbs the
2. What is a wave pulse?
particles for a short duration during its path.
3. What are common properties of
waves? These particles oscillate about their position
4. What happens when a wave of rest for a short time. They are not bodily
propagates? moved from their respective positions. This
5. What are mechanical waves? disturbance caused by the stone is actually a
6. What are electromagnetic waves? wave pulse. It is a disturbance caused locally
7. How are mechanical waves different for a short duration.
from electromagnetic waves? A wave, in which the disturbance
8. What are sound waves? produced in the medium travels in a given
6.1 Introduction: direction continuously, without any damping
You may be familiar with different waves and obstruction, from one particle to another,
like water waves, sound waves, light waves, is a progressive wave or a travelling wave
mechanical waves, electromagnetic waves e.g., the sound wave, which is a pressure wave
etc. A mechanical wave is a disturbance consisting of compressions and rarefactions
produced in an elastic medium due to periodic travelling along the direction of propagation
vibrations of particles of the medium about of the wave.
their respective mean positions. In this 6.2.1 Properties of progressive waves:
process, energy and momentum are transferred 1) Each particle in a medium executes the
from one particle to another. Thus, a wave same type of vibration. Particles vibrate
carries or transfers energy from one point to about their mean positions performing
another., but there is no transfer of matter or simple harmonic motion.
particles of the medium in which the wave 2) All vibrating particles of the medium
is travelling. Another type of waves, known have the same amplitude, period and
as electromagnetic waves, do not require frequency.
material medium for their propagation; these 3) The phase, (i.e., state of vibration of a
are non-mechanical waves. We have studied particle), changes from one particle to
sound waves (which are mechanical waves), another.
their properties and various phenomena like 4) No particle remains permanently at rest.
echo, reverberation, Doppler effect related to Each particle comes to rest momentarily
these waves in earlier classes. In this Chapter, while at the extreme positions of vibration.
we will study mechanical waves, reflection 5) The particles attain maximum velocity
of these waves, principle of superposition of when they pass through their mean
waves, various phenomena like formation of positions.
stationary waves, beats, and their applications. 6) During the propagation of wave, energy
6.2 Progressive Wave: is transferred along the wave. There is no
Have you seen ripples created on the transfer of matter.
surface of water when a stone is dropped in it? 7) The wave propagates through the medium
131
with a certain velocity. This velocity are rad m-1, m and rad s-1 respectively. If
depends upon properties of the medium. T is the time period of oscillation, then
8) Progressive waves are of two types - n = 1/T = ω /(2π) is the frequency of oscillation
transverse waves and longitudinal waves. measured in Hz (s-1). If the wave is travelling
9) In a transverse wave, vibrations of to the left i.e., along the negative x-direction,
particles are perpenduclar to the direction then the equation for the disturbance is
of propogation of wave and produce crests
y x , t Asin kx t --- (6.3)
and troughs in their medium of travel.
In longitudinal wave, vibrations of
Can you tell?
particles produce compressions and
rarefactions along the direction of What is the minimum distance between any
propagation of the wave. two particles of a medium which always
10) Both, the transverse as well as the have the same speed if a sine wave travels
longitudinal, mechanical waves can through the medium?
propagate through solids but only 6.3 Reflection of Waves:
longitudinal waves can propagate through When a progressive wave, travelling
fluids.
through a medium, reaches an interface
You might recall that when a mechanical
separating two media, a certain part of the
wave passes through an elastic medium, the
wave energy comes back in the same medium.
displacement of any particle of the medium
at a space point x at time t is given by the The wave changes its direction of travel. This is
expression called reflection of a wave from the interface.
y x , t f x vt --- (6.1) Reflection is the phenomenon in which
where v is the speed at which the disturbance the sound wave traveling from one medium
travels through the medium to the right to another comes back in the original medium
(increasing x). The factor x vt appears with slightly different intensity and energy. To
because the disturbance produced at the point x understand the reflection of waves, we will
= 0 at time t reaches the point x = x′ on the right consider three examples below.
at time (t + x′/v) or we say that the disturbance 6.3.1 Reflection of a Transverse Wave:
of the particle at time t at position x = x′
actually originated on the left side at time (t
- x′/v). Thus Eq. (6.1) represents a progressive
wave travelling in the positive x-direction with
a constant speed v. The function f depends on Fig. 6.1: Reflection of a wave pulse sent as a
the motion of the source of disturbance. If the crest from a rarer medium to a denser medium.
source of disturbance is performing simple Example 1
harmonic motion, the wave is represented as a • Take a long light string AB. Attach one
sine or cosine function of (x - vt) multiplied by end of the string to a rigid support at B.
a term which will make (x - vt) dimensionless. (Here, for the wave pulse traveling on the
string, the string is the rarer medium and
Generally we represent such a wave by the
the rigid support acts as a denser medium.)
following equation
y x , t Asin kx t • By giving a jerk to the free end A of the
--- (6.2)
string, a crest is generated in the string.
where A is the amplitude of the wave, k = 2π/λ
• Observe what happens when this crest
is the wave number, λ and ω are the wavelength
moves towards B?
and the angular frequency of the wave and • Observe what happens when the crest
v = ω /k is the speed. The SI units of k, λ and ω reaches B?
132
• Perform the same activity repeatedly and • Observe the part of wave pulse reflected
observe carefully. Try to find the reasons back on the heavy string.
of movements in above observations. • Produce a wave pulse as a crest on the
Example 2 light string Q moving towards the junction
point O.
• Observe the part of wave pulse reflected
on the light string.
• What difference do you observe when the
Fig.6.2: Reflection of a wave pulse sent as a wave pulse gets reflected on the light string
crest from a denser medium to a rarer medium. and when the wave pulse gets reflected on
the heavy string?
• Take a long light string AB. Attach the
• Try to find reasons behind your
end B of the string to a ring which can
slide easily on a vertical metal rod without observations.
friction. (Here string is the denser medium In example 1, when crest moves along the
while end B attached to the sliding ring is string towards B, it pulls the particles of string
at the interface of a rarer medium as it can in upward direction. Similarly when the crest
move freely.) reaches B at rigid support, it tries to pull the
• Give a jerk to free end A of the string. point B upwards. But being a rigid support,
• Observe what happens when crest reaches B remains at rest and an equal and opposite
the point B attached to the ring. reaction is produced on the string according
• Try to find the reason of the observed to Newton’s third law of motion. The string is
movement. pulled downwards. Thus crest gets reflected as
Example 3 a trough (Fig. 6.1) or a trough gets reflected as a
crest. Hence from example 1, we can conclude
that when transverse wave is reflected from a
rigid support, i.e., from a denser medium, a
crest is reflected as a trough and a trough is
reflected as a crest. You have learnt in Xth and
(a) XIth Std. that there is a phase difference of π
radian between the particles at a crest and at
a trough. Therefore we conclude that there is
a phase change of π radian on reflection from
the fixed end, i.e., from a denser medium.
In example 2, we observe that when the
(b)
crest reaches the point B, it pulls the ring
Fig. 6.3: Reflection of a crest from (a) denser upwards and causes the ring to move upward.
medium (in this case a heavy string) and (b)
The wave is seen to get reflected back as a
rarer medium (in this case a light string).
crest and no phase change occurs on reflection
• Take a heavy string P and a light string
from a rarer medium (Fig. 6.2).
Q and join them. Suppose they are joined
In example 3, we find that a crest
at point O. (Heavy string acts as a denser
travelling from the heavy string gets reflected
medium and light string is the rarer as a crest from the lighter string, i.e., reflection
medium.) at the surface when a wave is travelling from
• Produce a wave pulse as a crest on the heavy a denser medium to a rarer medium causes a
string P moving towards the junction O. crest to be reflected as a crest (Fig. 6.3 (a)).
133
But in example 3 (Fig. 6.3 (b)), when a crest
travels from the lighter string to the heavy
string, the crest is reflected as a trough and
vice versa.
6.3.2 Reflection of a Longitudinal Wave:
Consider a longitudinal wave travelling
from a rarer medium to a denser medium. In
a longitudinal wave compression is a high
Fig. 6.5: Reflection of a longitudinal wave from
pressure region while rarefaction is a low
a rarer medium.
pressure region. When compression reaches 6.4 Superposition of Waves:
the denser medium, it tries to push the particles Suppose you wish to listen to your
of that medium. But the energy of particles in favourite music. Is it always possible
the rarer medium is not sufficient to compress particularly when there are many other sounds
the particles of denser medium. According to from the surroundings disturbing you. How can
Newton’s third law of motion, an equal and the background sounds be blocked? Of course,
opposite reaction comes into play. As a result, the mobile lover generation uses headphones
the particles of rarer medium get compressed. and enjoys listening to its favorite music.
Thus, when the longitudinal wave travels But you cannot avoid the background sound
from a rarer medium to a denser medium, a completely. Why?
compression is reflected as a compression and We know that sound waves are
a rarefaction is reflected as a rarefaction. There longitudinal waves propagating through an
is no change of phase during this reflection elastic medium. When two waves travelling
(Fig. 6.4). through a medium cross each other, each
wave travels in such a way as if there is no
other wave. Each wave sets the particles of
the medium into simple harmonic motion.
Thus each particle of the medium is set into
two simple harmonic motions due to the two
waves. The total displacement of the particles,
at any instant of time during travelling of
these waves, is the vector sum of the two
Fig. 6.4: Reflection of a longitudinal wave from displacements. This happens according to the
a denser medium. principle of superposition of waves, which
When longitudinal wave travels from a states that, when two or more waves, travelling
denser medium to a rarer medium (Fig. 6.5), through a medium, pass through a common
a compression is reflected as a rarefaction. point, each wave produces its own displacement
Here reversal of phase takes place, i.e., phase at that point, independent of the presence of
changes by π radians. the other wave. The resultant displacement
When compression reaches a rarer at that point is equal to the vector sum of the
medium from denser medium, it pushes the displacements due to the individual wave at that
particles of rare medium. Due to this, particles point. As displacement is a vector, we must add
of the rarer medium get compressed and move the individual displacements by considering
forward and a rarefaction is left behind. Thus their directions. There is no change in the
a compression gets reflected as a rarefaction. shape and nature of individual waves due to
Similarly a rarefaction gets reflected as a superposition of waves. This principle applies
compression (Fig. 6.5). to all types of waves like sound waves, light
134
waves, waves on a string etc. and we say that propagation after superposition are shown
interference of waves has taken place. in Figs. 6.6 (a) to 6.6 (f). Suppose two
You might have seen singers using a special waves cross each other between t = 2 s and
type of headphones during recording of t = 4 s, as shown in Figs. 6.6 (c), (d) and
songs. Those are active noise cancellation (e). Here the two wave pulses superpose,
headphones, which is the best possible the resultant displacement is equal to the
solution to avoid background sound. sum of the displacements (full line) due to
Active noise cancellation headphones individual wave pulses (dashed lines). This
consist of small microphones one on each is constructive interference. The displacement
earpiece. They detect the ambient noise due to wave pulses after crossing at t = 5 s and
that arrives at the ears. A special electronic t = 6 s are shown in Figs. 6.6 (f) and (g). After
circuit is built inside the earpiece to create crossing each other, both the wave pulses
sound waveforms exactly opposite to the continue to maintain their individual shapes.
arriving noise. This is called antisound. 6.4.2 Superposition of Two Wave Pulses
The antisound is added in the earphones so of Equal Amplitude and Opposite Phases
as to cancel the noise from outside. This is Moving towards Each Other :
possible due to superposition of waves, as
the displacements due to these two waves
cancel each other. The phenomena of
interference, beats, formation of stationary
waves etc. are based on the principle of
superposition of waves.
Let us consider superposition of two wave
pulses in two different ways.
6.4.1 Superposition of Two Wave Pulses of
Equal Amplitude and Same Phase Moving
towards Each Other :
Fig. 6.7: Superposition of two wave pulses of
equal amplitude and opposite phases moving
towards each other.
The propagation of approaching wave
pulses, their successive positions after every
second, their superposition and propagation
after superposition are shown in Fig. 6.7 (a) to
Fig. 6.7 (e).
These wave pulses superimpose at
t = 2 s and the resultant displacement (full
line) is zero, due to individual displacements
(dashed lines) differing in phase exactly
Fig. 6.6: Superposition of two wave pulses
by 180°. This is destructive interference.
of equal amplitude and same phase moving
towards each other. Displacement due to one wave pulse is
The propagation of approaching wave cancelled by the displacement due to the
pulses, their successive positions after other wave pulse when they cross each other
every second, their superposition and their (Fig. 6.7 (c)). After crossing each other, both
135
the wave pulses continue and maintain their phase, the resultant amplitude is
individual shapes. A A12 2A1 A2 cos A2 2 (A1 A2 ) 2
6.4.3 Amplitude of the Resultant Wave = |A1- A2|
Produced due to Superposition of Two Waves: The resultant amplitude is minimum when
Consider two waves having the same frequency ϕ = π.
but different amplitudes A1 and A2. Let these If the amplitudes of the waves are equal i.e.,
waves differ in phase by ϕ . The displacement A1 = A2 = A (say), then the resultant amplitude
of each wave at x = 0 is given as is zero.
y1 A1 sin t
Thus, the maximum amplitude is the
y 2 A2 sin t sum of the two amplitudes when the phase
According to the principle of superposition difference between the two waves is zero and
of waves, the resultant displacement at x = 0 is the minimum amplitude is the difference of
y y1 y 2 the two amplitudes when the phase difference
or, y A1 sin t A2 sin t between the two waves is π.
y A1 sin t A2 sin t cos A2 cos t sin
The intensities of the waves are
proportional to the squares of their amplitudes.
y A1 A2 cos sin t A2 sin cos t
Hence, when ϕ = 0
If we write
I max ( Amax ) 2 ( A1 A2 ) 2 --- (6.8)
A1 A2 cos A cos --- (6.4)
and when ϕ = π
and A2 sin Asin --- (6.5)
I min ( Amin ) 2 (A1 A2 ) 2 --- (6.9)
we get
Therefore intensity is maximum when the
y Acos sin t Asin cos t
two waves interfere in phase while intensity is
∴ y Asin t --- (6.6)
minimum when the two waves interfere out of
This is the equation of the resultant
phase.
wave. It has the same frequency as that of the
You will learn more about superposition
interfering waves. The resultant amplitude A
of waves in Chapter 7 on Wave Optics.
is given by squaring and adding Eqs. (6.4) and
(6.5). Example 6.1: The displacements of two
A2 cos 2 A2 sin 2 A1 A2 cos A2 2 sin 2
2 sinusoidal waves propagating through a
A2 A12 2 A1 A2 cos A2 2 cos 2 A2 2 sin 2 string are given by the following equations
∴ A A1 2A1 A2 cos A2
2 2
--- (6.7) y1 4 sin 20 x 30t
Special cases: y 2 4 sin 25 x 40t
1. When ϕ = 0, i.e., the waves are in phase, where x and y are in centimeter and t is in
the resultant amplitude is second.
a) Calculate the phase difference between
A A12 2 A1 A2 cos 0 A2 2 (A1 A2 ) 2
these two waves at the points x = 5 cm and
= A1 + A2
t = 2 s.
The resultant amplitude is maximum when
b) When these two waves interfere, what
ϕ = 0.
are the maximum and minimum values of
If the amplitudes of the waves are equal i.e.,
the intensity?
A1 = A2 = A (say), then the resultant amplitude
Solution: Given
is 2A.
y1 4 sin 20 x 30t
2. When ϕ = π, i.e., the waves are out of
136
and y 2 4 sin 25 x 40t ∴ frequency n = 1/T = (1/16) × 103 s-1
a) To find phase difference when x = 5 cm = 62. 5 Hz
and t = 2 s: As shown in Fig. (b), points A, B, and C
correspond to mean positions, but the string
y1 4 sin 20 5 30 2
is moving in one direction at point A and
4 sin 100 60 4 sin 40 in the opposite direction at point B. Thus,
y 2 4 sin 25 5 40 2 out of the two consecutive particles at
their mean positions, one will be moving
4 sin 125 80 4 sin 45
upwards while the other will be moving
∴ Phase difference is 5 radian because ϕ downwards. The distance between them
= |45 – 40| = 5 radian. is 2.0 cm. Therefore distance between two
b) To find the maximum and minimum consecutive particles moving in the same
values of the intensity : direction will be 2 × 2 cm = 4 cm. Thus the
Amplitudes of the two waves are A1 = 4 cm wavelength λ = 4 cm = 0.04 m
and A2 = 4 cm, Speed of wave v = n × λ = 62.5 × 0.04
∴ I max A1 A2 4 4 64
2 2
= 2.5 m/s.
when the phase difference is zero 6.5 Stationary Waves:
We have seen the superposition of two
and I A A 2 4 4 2 0 wave pulses, having same amplitudes and either
min 1 2
when the phase difference is π. same phase or opposite phases, and changes
in the resultant amplitude pictorially in section
Example 6.2: A progressive wave travels
6.4. We have also derived the mathematical
on a stretched string. A particle on this
expression for the resultant displacement when
string takes 4.0 ms to move from its mean
two waves of same frequency superimpose as
position to one of its extreme positions. The given by Eqs. (6.4) to (6.6). Now we are going
distance between two consecutive points on to study an example of superposition of waves
the string which are at their mean positions having the same amplitude and the same
(at a certain time instant) is 2.0 cm. Find frequency travelling in opposite directions.
the frequency, wavelength and speed of the 6.5.1 Formation of Stationary Waves:
wave. Imagine a string stretched between two
Solution : fixed points. If the string is pulled at the
middle and released, we get what is know as a
(a) stationary wave. Releasing of string produces
two progressive waves travelling in opposite
directions. These waves are reflected at the
fixed ends. The waves produced in the string
(b) initially and their reflected waves combine
to produce stationary waves as shown in
Fig. 6.8 (a).
A particles takes 4.0 × 10-3 s to travel from
its mean position to extreme position. This
is a quarter of the complete oscillation as
shown in Fig. (a). Hence, the particle will
take 4 × 4.0 × 10-3 s = 16 × 10-3 s to complete Fig. 6.8 (a): Formation of stationary
waves on a string. The two sides arrows
one oscillation. indicate the motion of the particles of the string.
137
6.5.2 Equation of Stationary Wave on a point on the string oscillates with the same
Stretched String: frequency ω (same as that of the individual
Consider two simple harmonic progressive progressive wave). All the particles of the
waves of equal amplitudes (a) and wavelength string pass through their mean positions
(λ) propagating on a long uniform string in simultaneously twice during each vibration.
opposite directions (remember 2π/λ = k and The string as a whole is vibrating with
2πn = ω). frequency ω with different amplitudes at
The equation of wave travelling along the different points. The wave is not moving either
x-axis in the positive direction is to the left or to the right. We therefore call such
x a wave a stationary wave or a standing wave.
y1 a sin{2 nt } --- (6.10)
Particles move so fast that the visual effect is
The equation of wave travelling along the formation of loops. It is therefore customary
x-axis in the negative direction is to represent stationary waves as loops. In case
x of a string tied at both the ends, loops are seen
y 2 a sin 2 nt --- (6.11)
when a stationary wave is formed because
When these waves interfere, the resultant each progressive wave on a string is a traverse
displacement of particles of string is given by wave. When two identical waves travelling
the principle of superposition of waves as along the same path in opposite directions
y y1 y 2 interfere with each other, resultant wave is
x x called stationary wave.
y a sin 2 nt a sin 2 nt
Condition for node:
Nodes are the points of minimum
By using,
displacement. This is possible if the amplitude
C D CD
sin C sin D 2 sin cos
2
,we is minimum (zero), i.e.,
2 2 x
get 2a cos 0,
2 x
y 2a sin 2 nt cos
2 x
2 x or, cos = 0,
y = 2 a cos sin 2 nt or, --- (6.12)
or, 2 x ,3 ,5 ,……….
Using 2a cos 2 x A in Eq. (6.12), we get 2 2 2
3 5
y A sin( 2 nt ) ∴ x = , , ,
4 4 4
As ω = 2πn, we get, y A sin t . i.e., x 2 p 1 where p = 1, 2, 3, ………
This is the equation of a stationary wave 4
The distance between two successive nodes is
which gives resultant displacement due to two λ.
simple harmonic progressive waves. It may be 2
noted that the terms in position x and time t Condition for antinode:
appear separately and not as a combination Antinodes are the points of maximum
2π (nt ± x/λ). displacement,
Hence, the wave is not a progressive i.e., A 2a
wave. x is present only in the expression for 2 x
∴ 2a cos 2a
the amplitude. The amplitude of the resultant
2 x
wave is given as A 2a cos . It is a 2 x
or, cos 1
periodic function of x i.e., the amplitude is
varying periodically in space. The amplitudes 2 x
∴ 0, , 2 , 3
are different for different particles but each
138
3 through a medium along the same path in
or, x 0, , , , .. opposite directions.
2 2
p 2. If two identical transverse progressive
i.e., x where p = 0, 1, 2,3…. waves superimpose or interfere, the
2
The distance between two successive antinodes resultant wave is a transverse stationary
is λ . Nodes and antinodes are formed wave as shown in Fig. 6.8 (a).
2 • When a transverse stationary wave is
alternately. Therefore, the distance between a produced on a string, some points on the
λ string are motionless. The points which do
node and an adjacent antinode is .
4 not move are called nodes.
When sin ω t = 1, at that instant of time,
• There are some points on the string which
all the particles for which cos kx is positive
oscillate with greatest amplitude (say A).
have their maximum displacement in positive
They are called antinodes.
direction. At the same instant, all the particles
• Points between the nodes and antinodes
for which cos kx is negative have their
vibrate with values of amplitudes between
maximum displacement in negative direction.
0 and A.
When sin ω t = 0, all the particles cross their
3. If two identical longitudinal progressive
mean positions, some of them moving in the
waves superimpose or interfere, the
positive direction and some in the negative
resultant wave is a longitudinal stationary
direction.
wave. Figure 6.8 (b) shows a stationary
Longitudinal waves e.g. sound waves sound wave produced in a pipe closed at
travelling in a tube /pipe of finite length one end.
are relected at the ends in the same way as • The points, at which the amplitude of the
transverse waves along a string are reflected particles of the medium is minimum (zero),
at the ends. Interference between these
are called nodes.
waves travelling in opposite directions gives
• The points, at which the amplitude of the
rise to standing waves as shown in Fig. 6.8
particles of the medium is maximum (say
(b). We represent longitudinal stationary
wave by a loop but the actual motion of the A), are called antinodes.
particles is along the length of the loop and not • Points between the nodes and antinodes
perpendiculat to it. vibrate with values of amplitudes between
0 and A
4. The distance between two consecutive
Fig. 6.8 (b): Figure on the λ
left shows standing waves nodes is and the distance between two
2
in a conventional way while consecutive antinodes is λ .
figure on the right shows 2
the actual oscillations of 5. Nodes and antinodes are produced
material particles for a alternately. The distance between a node
longitudinal stationary and an adjacent antinode is λ .
wave. Points A and N 4
6. The amplitude of vibration varies
denote antinodes and nodes
periodically in space. All points vibrate
respectively.
with the same frequency.
7. Though all the particles (except those
6.5.3 Properties of Stationary Waves: at the nodes) possess energy, there is
1. Stationary waves are produced due to no propagation of energy. The wave is
superposition of two identical waves (either localized and its velocity is zero. Therefore,
transverse or longitudinal waves) traveling we call it a stationary wave.
139
8. All the particles between adjacent nodes 6. All particles between two consecutive
(i.e., in one loop) vibrate in phase. There nodes are moving in the same direction
is no progressive change of phase from and are in phase while those in adjacent
one particle to another particle. All the loops are moving in opposite directions
particles in the same loop are in the same and differ in phase by 180° in stationary
phase of oscillation, which reverses for the waves but in a progressive wave, phases of
adjacent loop. adjacent particles are different.
Musical instruments such as violin, tanpura,
are based on the principle of formation of Do you know?
stationary waves or standing waves.
• What happens if a simple pendulum is
Example 6.3: Find the distance between pulled aside and released?
two successive nodes in a stationary wave • What happens when a guitar string is
on a string vibrating with frequency 64 plucked?
Hz. The velocity of progressive wave that • Have you noticed vibrations in a drill
resulted in the stationary wave is 48 m s-1 . machine or in a washing machine? How
Solution: Given: do they differ from vibrations in the
Speed of wave = v = 48 m s-1 above two cases?
Frequency n = 64 Hz • A vibrating tuning fork of certain
We have v n frequency is held in contact with table
v 48 top and vibrations are noticed and then
∴ λ= = = 0.75m
n 64 another vibrating tuning fork of different
We know that distance between successive
frequency is held on table top. Are the
nodes
vibrations produced in the table top the
0.75 same for both the tuning forks? Why?
= = 0.375 m
2 2
6.6 Free and Forced Vibrations:
6.5.4 Comparison of Progressive Waves and The frequency at which an object tends
Stationary Waves:
to vibrate when hit, plucked or somehow
1. In a progressive wave, the disturbance
disturbed is known as its natural frequency.
travels form one region to the other with
In these vibrations, object is not under the
definite velocity. In stationary waves,
disturbance remains in the region where it influence of any outside force.
is produced, velocity of the wave is zero. When a simple pendulum is pulled aside
2. In progressive waves, amplitudes of all and released, it performs free vibrations with
particles are same but in stationary waves, its natural frequency. Similarly when a string
amplitudes of particles are different. of guitar is plucked at some point it performs
3. In a stationary wave, all the particles cross free vibrations with its natural frequency.
their mean positions simultaneously but in In free vibration, the body at first is
a progressive wave, this does not happen. given an initial displacement and the force is
4. In progressive waves, all the particles are then withdrawn. The body starts vibrating and
moving while in stationary waves particles continues the motion on its own. No external
at the position of nodes are always at rest. force acts on the body further to keep it in
5. Energy is transmitted from one region motion.
to another in progressive waves but in Free vibration of a system means that the
stationary waves there is no transfer of system vibrates at its natural frequency. In
energy. case of free vibrations, a body continuously
140
loses energy due to frictional resistance of conditions that constrain the possible
surrounding medium. Therefore, the amplitude wavelengths or frequencies of vibration
of vibrations goes on decreasing, the vibrations of the system. These are called the natural
of the body eventually stop and the body comes frequencies of normal modes of oscillations.
to rest. The minimum of these frequencies is termed the
The vibrations in a drill machine and in a fundamental frequency or the first harmonic.
washing machine are forced vibrations. Also The corresponding mode of oscillations is
the vibrations produced in the table top due to called the fundmental mode or fundamental
tuning forks of two different frequencies are tone. The term overtone is used to represent
different as they are forced vibrations due to higher frequencies. The first frequency higher
two tuning forks of different frequencies. than the fundamental frequency is called
In forced vibrations, an external periodic the first overtone, the next frequency higher
force is applied on a body whose natural period is the second overtone and so on. The term
is different from the period of the force. The 'harmonic' is used when the frequency of a
body is made to vibrate with a frequency equal particular overtone is an intergral multiple
to that of the externally impressed force. The of the fundamental frequency. In strings and
amplitude of forced vibrations depends upon air columns, the frequencies of overtoners
the difference between the frequency of external are integral multiples of the fundamental
periodic force and the natural frequency of the frequencies, hence they are termed as
body. If this difference is small, the amplitude harmonics. But all harmonics may not be
of forced vibrations is large and vice versa. If present in a given sound. The overtones are
the frequencies exactly match, it is termed as only those multiples of fundamental frequency
resonance and the amplitude of vibration is which are actually present in a given sound.
maximum. The harmonics may or may not be present in
An object vibrating with its natural the sound so produced.
frequency can cause another nearby object to To understand the concept of harmonics
vibrate. The second object absorbs the energy and overtones, let us study vibrations of air
transmitted by the first object and starts column.
vibrating if the natural frequencies of the two
6.7.1 End Correction:
objects match. You have seen the example of
two simple pendula supported from a string in When an air column vibrates either in a
the previous chapter. The second object is said pipe closed at one end or open at both ends,
to undergo forced vibrations. Strings or air boundary conditions demand that there is
columns can also undergo forced oscillations always an antinode at the open end(s) (since
if the frequency of the external source of sound the particles of the medium are comparatively
is close to the natural frequency of the system. free) and a node at the closed end (since there is
Resonance is said to occur and we hear a hardly any freedom for the particles to move).
louder sound. The antinode is not formed exactly at the open
6.7 Harmonics and Overtones: end but it is slightly beyond the open end as air
When a string or an air column is set is more free to vibrate there in comparison to
into vibrations by some means, the waves are the air inside the pipe. Also as air particles in
reflected from the ends and stationary waves the plane of open end of the pipe are not free
can be formed. An important condition to form to move in all directions, reflection takes place
stationary waves depends on the boundary at the plane at small distance outside the pipe.
141
The distance between the open end of the pipe
and the position of antinode is called the end
correction. According to Reynold, to the first Fig. 6.9 (a): Set-up for
generating vibrations
approximation, the end correction at an end is of air column in a
given by e = 0.3d, where d is the inner diameter pipe closed at one end.
of the pipe. Thus the length L of air column is The distance of the
antinode from the open
different from the length l of the pipe. end of the pipe has
been exaggerated.
For a pipe closed at one end
The corrected length of air column L = length This is the simplest mode of vibration of
of air column in pipe l + end correction at the air column closed at one end, known as the
open end. fundamental mode.
∴ Length of air column
∴ L = l + e --- (6.13)
L and 4 L
For a pipe open at both ends 4
where λ is the wavelength of fundamental
The corrected length of air column L = length
mode of vibrations in air column. If n is the
of air column in pipe l + end corrections at fundamental frequency, we have
both the ends. v n --- (6.15)
v
∴ L = l + 2e --- (6.14) n
v
6.7.2 Vibrations of air column in a pipe v
n --- (6.16)
closed at one end: 4L 4(l e )
The fundamental frequency is also known
Consider a long cylindrical tube closed at as the first harmonic. It is the lowest frequency
one end. It consists of an air column with rigid of vibration in air column in a pipe closed at
boundary at one end. When a vibrating tuning one end.
fork is held near the open end of the closed The next mode of vibrations of air column
pipe, sound waves are sent by the fork inside closed at one end is as shown in Fig. 6.9 (b).
the tube. Longitudinal waves traveling along Here the air column is made to vibrate in such
a pipe of finite length are reflected at the ends a way (as shown in Fig. 6.9 (b)) that it contains
as transverse waves are refelcted at the fixed a node at the closed end, an antinode at the
ends of a string. The phase of the reflected open end with one more node and antinode
wave depends on whether the end of the pipe in between. If n1 is the frequency and λ1 is the
is open or closed and how wide or narrow the wavelength of wave in this mode of vibrations
pipe is in compansion to the wavelength of in air column, we have, the length of the air
longitudinal wave like a sound wave. column L 31
4
At the closed end there is least freedom 4 L 4(l e )
1 --- (6.17)
for motion of air particles. Thus, there must be 3 3
a node at the closed end. The particles little The velocity in the second mode is given
beyond the open end are most free to vibrate. as v n11
As a result, an antinode must be formed little n1
v 3V
3V
beyond the open end. The lenght l of pipe and 1 4 L 4 (l e )
length L of air column are shown separately in ∴ n1 = 3n --- (6.18)
all the figures (refer Figs. 6.9 and 6.10). This frequency is the third harmonic. It is
The first mode of vibrations of air column the first overtone. Remember that the overtones
closed at one end is as shown in Fig. 6.9 (a). are always numbered sequentially.
142
Even though both the ends of the pipe are
open, the air inside the pipe is still bound by the
wall of the tube. As a result, the air inside the
pipe is little denser than the air outside. When
the waves travel to the other open end, there is
partial reflection at the open end. The partially
reflected waves superimpose with the incident
waves. Under suitable conditions, stationary
waves will be formed. There is maximum
freedom for motion of air column at both the
(b) (c)
ends as pipe is open at both ends.
Fig. 6.9 (b) and (c): First and second overtones
for vibrations of air column in a pipe closed Suppose a compression produced by a
at one end. The distance of the antinode from tuning fork travels through the air column. It
the open end of the pipe has been exaggerated.
The next higher mode of vibrations of air
column closed at one end is as shown in Fig.
6.10 (c). Here the same air column is made to
vibrate in such a way that it contains a node
at the closed end, an antinode at the open end
with two more nodes and antinodes in between.
If n2 is the frequency and λ2 is the wavelength
of the wave in this mode of vibrations in air
column, we have
5 (a) (b)
Length of air column L 2
4L 4(l + e ) 4
2 = --- (6.19) Fig. 6.10: First three
5 5
modes of vibrations of
The velocity this mode is given as air column in a pipe
v n2 2 open at both ends.
The distance of the
v 5V 5V
n2 ∴ n2 = 5 n -- (6.20) antinodes from the
2 4 L 4 (l e )
open ends of the pipe
This frequency is the fifth harmonic. It is has been exaggerated.
the second overtone. (c)
Continuing in a similar way, for the pth
overtone we get the frequency np as
gets reflected as a rarefaction at open end. The
np 2 p 1 n . -- (6.21)
rarefaction moves back and gets reflected as
Thus for a pipe closed at one end only odd
compression at the other end. It suffers second
harmonics are present and even harmonics are
reflection at open end near the source and then
absent.
interferes with the wave coming in by a path
6.7.3 Vibrations of air column in a pipe open
difference of 2L.
at both ends:
In this case boundary conditions are such The different modes of vibrations of air
that an antinode is present at each open end. column in pipe open at both ends are shown
When a source of sound like a tuning fork in Fig. 6.10 (a), (b) and (c). The fundamental
is held near one end of the pipe, it sends the tone or mode of vibrations of air column open
waves inside the pipe. at both ends is as shown in Fig. 6.10 (a). There
143
are two antinodes at two open ends and one n p p 1 n --- (6.28)
node between them. where n is the fundamental frequency and p =
∴ Length of air column L or, 2 L 0,1,2,3…
2
v v v It may be noted that
n
2 L 2(l 2 e ) ----(6.22)
1. Sound produced by an open pipe contains
and v = 2 nL ----(6.23) all harmonics. Its quality is richer than
This is the fundamental frequency or the that produced by a closed pipe.
first harmonic. It is the lowest frequency of 2. Fundamental frequency of vibration of air
vibration. column in an open pipe is double that of
The next possible mode of vibrations of the fundamental frequency of vibration in
air column open at both ends is as shown in a closed pipe of the same length.
Fig. 6.10 (b). Three antinodes and two nodes Using the formula and knowing values
are formed. of n, l and end correction velocity of sound
∴ Length of air column L 1 in air at room temperature can be calculated.
i.e., λ1 = L = (l +2e) ----(6.24) As discussed earlier, the antinodes are formed
little beyond the open ends of the pipe. It is
If n1 and λ1 are frequency and wavelength
however not possible to locate the positions
of this mode of vibration of air column
of the antinodes precisely. Therefore, in
respectively, then
experiments, the length of the pipe is measured
v n11
v v v and end corrections are incorporated.
n1
6.7.4 Practical Determination of End
1 L (l 2 e )
∴ n1 = 2 n --- (6.25) Connection:
This is the frequency of second harmonic An exact method to determine the end
or first overtone. correction, using two pipes of same diameter
In the next of vibrations of air column but different lengths l1 and l2 is as follows.
open at both ends (as shown in Fig. 6.10 (c)), For a pipe open at both ends:
four antinodes and three nodes are formed. = v 2=n1 L1 2 n2 L2 using Eq. (6.23)
3 n1 L1 n2 L2
∴Length of air column L 2
2 n1 l1 2 e n2 l2 2 e
2 L 2(l 2 e )
2 --- (6.26) nl n l n l nl
3 3
e 1 1 2 2 or 2 2 1 1 --- (6.29)
If n2 and λ2 are the frequency and 2 n2 n1 2 n1 n2
wavelength of this mode of vibration of air For a pipe closed at one end:
column respectively, then v n2 2 =v 4=
n1 L1 4 n2 L2
v 3v 3v n1 L1 n2 L2
n2
2 2 L 2 (l 2 e ) n1 l1 e n2 l2 e
n2 3n --- (6.27) nl n l n l nl --- (6.30)
e 1 1 2 2 or 2 2 1 1
2 n2 n1 2 n1 n2
This is the frequency of third harmonic or
second overtone. Remember this
Thus all harmonics are present as
For correct value of end correction, the inner
overtones in the modes of vibration of air
diameter of pipe must be uniform throughout
column open at both ends.
its length. It may be noted that effect of flow
Continuing in this manner, the frequency np for
of air and effect of temperature of air outside
pth overtone is, the tube has been neglected.
144
Example 6.4: An air column is of length Activity
17 cm long. Calculate the frequency of 5th Take a glass
overtone if the air column is (a) closed at tube open at both
one end and (b) open at both ends. (Velocity ends and clamp
of sound in air = 340 ms-1). it so that its one
Solution: Given end dips into a
Length of air column = 17cm = 0.17m glass cylinder
Overtone number p = 5 and velocity of containing water
sound in air = 340 ms-1. as shown in the
For an air column closed at one end, accompanying
figure. By
Fundamental frequency n v 340
4L 4 0.17 changing the
= 500 Hz position of the
For fifth overtone, n p 2 p 1 n tube at the clamp,
2 5 1 500 you can adjust the length of the air column
in the tube. Hold a vibrating tuning fork of
= 5500Hz
frequency 488 Hz or 512 Hz just above the
For an air column open at both ends,
v 340 open end of the tube and make the air column
Fundamental frequency n
2 L 2 0.17 vibrate. What is the difference between the
n = 1000Hz sounds that you hear? The sound will be
For fifth overtone, n p p 1 n louder. This is an example of resonance.
n 2 p 1 n and n
c
p
c c
4
This set-up is a resonance tube. Note the
4L
n = 6000 Hz heights of the air column when you hear
5
Example 6.5 : A closed pipe and an open louder sound. Interpret your observations.
pipe have the same length. Show that Take another tuning fork of the same
no mode of the closed pipe has the same frequency as the first one. Vibrate them
wavelength as any mode of the open pipe. together above the open end of the tube. Do
Solution: For a closed pipe (that is a pipe
you hear beats? If the two tuning forks are of
closed at one end and open at the other),
same frequency, you should not hear beats.
the frequency of allowed modes is given by
4 In practice, due to usage, frequencies change
n c p 2 p 1 n c and n c and in most of the cases, you will hear beats.
4L
using Eqs. (6.21) and (6.16) , where p is any If you do not hear beats, there can be two
integer. reasons : (i) frequencies of the two forks
4 L , where p is any integer. are exactly same or (ii) the frequencies are
pc
2 p 1 very much different (difference greater than
On the other hand, for an open pipe (that is 6-7 Hz) and we cannot recognize the beats.
pipe open at both the ends), the frequency of Then wind a piece of thread around the tong
allowed modes is given as n om 2 L , where of one of the tuning fork so that its frequency
m 1
m is an integer. changes slightly. Try to hear the beats. By
4 L 2L
If p m , it would mean 2 p 1 m 1 .
c c
changing the position of the thread, vary the
Or, 2 (m +1) = 2p + 1 which is not possible. frequency and note down your observations
Hence the two pipes cannot have modes systematically. What information you get
with the same frequency or wavelength. from this activity?
145
λ
Activity Length of loop = =l
2
Take two pipes of slightly different ∴λ = 2l
diameters, open at both the ends, so that The frequency of vibrations of the string,
one pipe can be moved freely inside v 1 T T
n v
the other. Keep the wider pipe fixed by 2l m m
clamping on a stand
This is the lowest frequency with which
and move the other
the string can vibrate. It is the fundamental
pipe up and down
by hand as shown in
the accompanying (a)
figure. Use a tuning
fork of frequency
320 Hz or 288 Hz
and keep it above the
open end of the fixed
pipe. Move the inner
tube and try to hear (b)
the various sound patterns and write down
your observations. Try to analyze the results
based on the knowledge you have from the
sound pattern formed with a pipe open at
both ends.
147
Linear density = mass per unit length the weights, the tension in the wire can be
= volume per unit length × density varied. The movable bridges allow us to
( r 2 l / l )ρ change the vibrating length AB of the wire.
1
As n ∝ , if T and l are constant, we get
m
1
n
r2
1 1
∴ n and n ∝ --- (6.36)
r
Thus the fundamental frequency of
vibrations of a stretched string is inversely
proportional to (i) the radius of string and (ii)
the square root of the density of the material of Fig. 6.12: Experimental set-up of a sonometer.
vibrating string. If the wire is plucked at a point midway
Example 6.8: A string 105 cm long is between the bridges, transverse waves are
produced in the wire. Stationary waves are
fixed at one end. The other end of string is
produced between the two bridges due to
moved up and down with frequency 15 Hz.
reflection of transverse wave at the bridges
A stationary wave, produced in the string,
and their superposition. Thus portion AB of
consists of 3 loops. Calculate the speed of the wire between the two bridges P and Q is
progressive waves which have produced the the vibrating length. Wire can also be made to
stationary wave in the string. vibrate by holding a vibrating tuning fork near
Solution: Given it. The frequency of vibration is then same
Length of string = l = 105 cm = 3 loops as that of the tuning fork. If this frequency
l 3 happens to be one of the natural frequencies of
2 the wire, standing waves with large amplitude
2 2
l 105 70 cm 0.70 m are set up in the wire since the two vibrate in
3 3
Speed of wave = v n resonance.
v 15 0.70 10.50 m s 1 To identify the resonance, a small piece of
paper, known as the rider R, is placed over the
6.8 Sonometer:
wire at a point in the middle of the length AB
A sonometer consists of a hollow
as determined by the position of the bridges P
rectangular wooden box called the sound box.
and Q. If the frequency of the tuning fork and
The sound box is used to make a larger mass
of the fundamental mode of vibration of the
of air vibrate so that the sound produced by
wire match (this is achieved by adjusting the
the vibrating string (metal wire in this case)
length AB of wire using the bridges P and Q),
gets amplified. The same principle is applied
the paper rider happens to be at the antinode
in stringed instruments such as the violin,
and flies off the wire.
guitar, tanpura etc. There are two bridges P
Sonometer can be used to verify the laws
and Q along the width of the box which can be
of a vibrating string.
moved parallel to the length of box. A metal
1) Verification of first law of a vibrating
wire of uniform cross-section runs along the
string:
length of the box over the bridges. It is fixed at
By measuring length of wire and its
one end and its other end passes over a pulley.
mass, the mass per unit length (m) of wire is
A hanger with suitable slotted weights can be
attached to the free end of wire. By changing determined. Then the wire is stretched on the
148
sonometer and the hanger is suspended from ∴ n ∝ T if l and m are constant. This is
its free end. A suitable tension (T) is applied the second law of a vibrating string.
to the wire by placing slotted weights on the 3) Verification of third law of a vibrating
hanger. The length of wire (l1) vibrating with string:
the same frequency (n1) as that of the tuning For verification of third law of a vibrating
fork is determined as follows. string, two wires having different masses per
A light paper rider is placed on the wire unit lengths m1 and m2 (linear densities) are
midway between the bridges. The tuning fork used. The first wire is subjected to suitable
is set into vibrations by striking on a rubber tension and made to vibrate in unison with
pad. The stem of tuning fork is held in contact given tuning fork. The vibrating length is noted
with the sonometer box. By changing distance as (l1). Using the same fork, the second wire
between the bridges without disturbing paper is made to vibrate under the same tension and
rider, frequency of vibrations of wire is the vibrating length (l2) is determined. Thus the
changed. When the frequency of vibrations of frequency of vibration of the two wires is kept
wire becomes exactly equal to the frequency of same under same applied tension T. It is found
tuning fork, the wire vibrates with maximum that,
l m = l m2
amplitude and the paper rider is thrown off. 1 1 2
In this way a set of tuning forks having l m = constant
1
different frequencies n1, n2, n3, …………are But by first law of a vibrating string, n ∝
1 l
used and corresponding vibrating lengths of
Therefore we get that, n ∝ , if T and l
wire are noted as l1, l2, l3……….by keeping m
the tension constant (T) . We will observe that are constant. This is the third law of vibrating
n1l1 = n2l2 = n3l3 =…….= constant, for constant string.
value of tension (T) and mass per unit length In this way, laws of a vibrating string are
(m). verified by using a sonometer.
∴nl = constant
1 Example 6.9: A sonometer wire of length
i.e., n ∝ , if T and m are constant.
l 50 cm is stretched by keeping weights
Thus, the first law of a vibrating string is equivalent of 3.5 kg. The fundamental
verified by using a sonometer. frequency of vibration is 125 Hz. Determine
2) Verification of second law of a vibrating the linear density of the wire.
string: Solution: Given, l = 50 cm = 0.5 m , T = 3.5
The vibrating length (l) of the given wire kg × 9.8 m/s2 = 34.3 N, n = 125 Hz
of mass per unit length (m) is kept constant for
1
T
verification of second law. By changing the n=
2l
m
tension the same length is made to vibrate in
1 T
∴n = 2
2
unison with different tuning forks of various
4l m
frequencies. If tensions T1, T2, T3……..
T
correspond to frequencies n1, n2, n3,………etc. ∴m = 2 2
4n l
we will observe that.
n1 n n 34.3
2 3 .. constant m
4 125 0.5
2 2
T1 T2 T3
n
= constant m 2.195 10 3 kgm 1
or
T
149
Example 6.10: Two wires of the same frequency
material and the same cross section are 420 Hz = p T and 490 Hz = p + 1 T
stretched on a sonometer in seccuession. 2l m 2l m
Length of one wire is 60 cm and that of the 490 p 1
other is 30 cm. An unknown load is applied 420 p
to the first wire and second wire is loaded or, n = 6
with 1.5 kg. If both the wires vibrate Using this value of p, for the frequency of
with the same fundamental frequencies, pth harmonic, we get
calculate the unknown load. 6 360 N 900
420 Hz = 3
= m/s
Solution: Two wires are given to be of the 2l 4.0 10 kg / m l
same material and having the same cross ∴ l = 900/420 m = 2.14 m
section,
m1 m2 m 6.9 Beats:
Same fundamental frequency, n= 1 n=
2 n This is an interesting phenomenon
l1 = 60 cm = 0.6 m, l2 = 30 cm = 0.3 m, based on the principle of superposition of
T2 = 1.5 ×9.8 N waves. When there is superposition of two
1 T1 sound waves, having same amplitude but
For the first wire, n1 =
2l1 m1 slightly different frequencies, travelling in the
For the second wire, n = 1 T2 same direction, the intensity of sound varies
2
n1 l2 T1 m2 2l2 m2 periodically with time. This phenomenon is
known as production of beats.
n2 l1 T2 m1
The occurrences of maximum intensity
n 0.3 T1 m are called waxing and those of minimum
n 0.6 1.5 9.8 m intensity are called waning. One waxing and
1 T1 successive waning together constitute one
1
2 1.5 9.8 beat. The number of beats heard per second is
T1 called beat frequency.
2
1.5 9.8 6.9.1 Analytical method to determine beat
T1 frequency:
or, 4 Consider two sound waves, having same
1.5 9.8
amplitude and slightly different frequencies n1
∴ 1 6 9.8 N
T
and n2. Let as some that they arrive in phase at
∴Applied load = 6 kg.
some point x of the medium. The displacement
Example 6.11: A wire has linear density
due to each wave at any instant of time at that
4.0 × 10-3 kg/m. It is stretched between
point is given as
two rigid supports with a tension of 360 N.
x
The wire resonates at a frequency of 420 y1 a sin 2 n1t
1
Hz and 490 Hz in two successive modes.
Find the length of the wire. x
y 2 a sin 2 n2 t
Solution: Given m = 4.0 × 10-3 kg/m, T = 2
360 N. Let the wire vibrate at 420 Hz and Let us assume for simplicity that the listener
490 Hz in its pth and (p+1)th harmonics. is at x = 0.
Then np = np where n is the fundamental ∴ y1 a sin( 2 n1t )
150
and y 2 a sin( 2 n2 t ) The number of waxing heard per second is the
According to the principle of superposition of reciprocal of period of waxing.
waves, ∴ frequency of beats, N = n1 – n2 --- (6.33)
y y1 y 2 The intensity of sound will be minimum
∴ y a sin 2 n1t a sin 2 n2 t when amplitude is zero (waning):
or, For minimum amplitude, A = 0,
n n n n
y 2a sin 2 1 2 t cos 2 1 2 t ∴ 2a cos 2 n1 n2 t 0
2 2 or, 2
--- (6.31) n n
cos 2 1 2 t 0
[By using formula, 2
C D CD n1 n2 3 5
sin C sin D 2 sin cos ]
2 2 ∴ 2 t , , ...
2 2 2 2
Rearranging the above equation, we get 1 3 5
2 n1 n2 2 n1 n2 ∴t= , , ,
y 2 a cos t sin t 2( n1 − n2 ) 2( n1 − n2 ) 2( n1 − n2 )
2 2
Therefore time interval between two
Substituting 2 a cos 2 ( n1 n2 ) t A 1
successive minima is also
( n1 − n2 )
, which is
2
n n
and 1 2 n , we get
expected.
2
y Asin 2 nt --- (6.37)
This is the equation of a progressive wave
having frequency n and amplitude A. The
frequency n is the mean of the frequencies n1
and n2 of arriving waves while the amplitude A
varies periodically with time.
The intensity of sound is proportional
to the square of the amplitude. Hence the
resultant intensity will be maximum when the
amplitude is maximum.
For maximum amplitude (waxing),
A 2a
Fig. 6.13: Superposition of two harmonic waves
2 ( n1 n2 )
∴ 2a cos t 2a
of nearly equal frequencies resulting in the
2 formation of beats.
2 ( n1 n2 ) By comparing the instances of successive
or, cos
2 t 1 waxing and waning, we come to know that
waxing and waning occur alternately with
n n
i.e., 2 1 2 t 0, , 2 , 3 ,…… equal frequency.
2 The variation in the loudness of sound
1 2 3
∴ t 0, , , , . that goes up and down is the phenomenon
n1 n2 n1 n2 n1 n2 , of formation of beats. It can be considered
Thus, the time interval between two as superposition of waves and formation of
1
successive maxima of sound is always . standing waves in time at one point in space
n1 − n2
1 where waves of slightly different frequencies
Hence the period of beats is T = .
n1 − n2 are passing. The two waves are in and out
151
of phase giving constructive and destructive If either a source of sound or a listener
interference. The interval between two (or both) is moving with respect to air, the
maximum sound intensities is the time period listener detects a sound whose frequency
of beats. is different from the frequency of the
sound source. This is Doppler effect.
Remember this A microwave signal (pulse) of known
We can hear beats if the frequency difference frequency is sent towards the moving airplane.
between the two superimposed waves is Principle of Doppler effect giving the apparent
frequency when the source and observer are
very small (practically less than 6-7 Hz,
in relative motion applies twice, once for
for normal human ear). At frequencies
the signal sent by the microwave source and
higher than these, individual beats cannot
received by the airplane and second time
be distinguished from the sound that is when the signal is reflected by the airplane
produced. and is received back at the microwave
source. Phenomenon of beats, arising due to
Activity the difference in frequencies produced by
the source and received at the source after
• Take two tuning forks of the same reflection from the air plane, allows us to
frequency. calculate the velocity of the air plane.
• Put some wax on the prongs of one of The same principle is used by traffic
the forks. police to determine the speed of a vehicle to
• Vibrate both the tuning forks and keep check whether speed limit is exceeded. Sonar
them side by side. (Sound navigation and ranging) works on
• Listen to the periodic vibrations of similar principle for determining speed of
loudness of resulting sound. submarines using a sound source and sensitive
• How many beats have you heard in one microphones.
minute? Doppler ultrasonography and echo
• Can you guess whether frequency of cardiogram work on similar principle. Doctors
tuning fork is increased or decreased by use an analogous set up to assess the direction
applying wax on the prong? and speed of blood flow in a human body and
• How you can find the new frequency of identify circulation problems. Measurement of
the fork after applying wax on it. the dimension of the blood vessels can be used
to estimate the volume flow rate. Ultrasound
6.9.2 Applications of beats :
beams also determine phase shifts to diagnose
1] The phenomenon of beats is used for
vascular problems in arteries and veins.
matching the frequencies of different 3] Unknown frequency of a sound note can
musical instruments by artists. They go be determined by using the phenomenon
on tuning until no beats are heard by of beats. Initially the sound notes of
their sensitive ears. When beat frequency known and unknown frequency are heard
becomes equal to zero, the musical simultaneously. The known frequency
instruments are in unison with each other from a source of adjustable frequency
i.e., their frequencies are identical and the is adjusted in such a way that the beat
effect of playing such instruments gives a frequency reduces to zero. At this stage
pleasant music. frequencies of both the sound notes
2] The speed of an airplane can be determined become equal. Hence unknown frequency
by using Doppler RADAR. can be determined.
152
sound wave travels through a medium, there
Example 6.12: Two sound waves having are regions of compressions and rarefactions.
wavelengths 81cm and 82.5 cm produce Thus there are changes in pressure. When
8 beats per second. Calculate the speed of a sound is heard, say by a human, the wave
sound in air.
exerts pressure on the human ear. The pressure
Solution: Given
variation is related to the amplitude and hence
λ1 = 81 cm = 0.81 m
to the intensity. Depending on the sound
λ2 = 82.5 cm = 0.825 m
v v produced, the variation in this pressure is
n1
1 0.81 from 28 Pa for the loudest tolerable sound
v v to 2.0 × 10-5 Pa for the feeblest sound like
n2
2 0.825 a whisper that can be heard by a human.
Here 1 2 ,n
1 n2 . Intensity is a measurable quantity while
As 8 beats are produced per second, the sensation of hearing or loudness is very
n1 n2 8 subjective. It is therefore important to find
v v out how does a sound of intensity I affect a
8
1 2 detectable change ∆I in the intensity for the
1 1 human ear to note. It is known that the value
∴v 8 of such ∆I depends linearly on intensity I and
1 2
this fact allows humans to deal with a large
1 1
v 8 variation in intensity.
0.81 0.825 The response of human ear to sound is
v 356.4 exponential and not linear. It depends upon the
Example 6.13: Two tuning forks having amount of energy crossing unit area around a
frequencies 320 Hz and 340 Hz are sounded point per unit time. Intensity is proportional to
together to produce sound waves. The the square of amplitude. It also depends upon
velocity of sound in air is 326.4 m s-1. Find various other factors like distance of source
the difference in wavelength of these waves.
from the listener, the motion of air, density of
Solution: Given
medium, the surface area of sounding body etc.
n1 = 320 Hz, n2 = 340 Hz, v = 326.4 m s-1.
The presence of other resonant objects around
v n11 n2 2
the sounding body also affects loudness of
Here, n1 < n2, ∴λ1 > λ2
sound.
v v
1 2 Scientifically, sound is specified not by its
n1 n2 intensity but by the sound level β (expressed in
1 1 decibles (dB)), defined as
1 2 v
n1 n2 10 log I , --- (6.39)
10
1 1 I0
1 2 326.4 where I0 is a minimum reference intensity
320 340
∴λ1 - λ2 = 0.06 m (10-12 W/m2) that a normal human ear can hear.
Sound levels are then expressed in decibel
6.10 Characteristics of Sound: (dB). When I = I0, β = 0, thus the standard
Sound has three characteristics: loudness, reference intensity has measure of sound level
pitch and quality. 0 dB. The unit of difference in loudness is bel.
1. Loudness: Loudness is the human perception You have studied about this unit in XIth Std.
to intensity of sound. We know that when a
153
1 A sequence of frequencies which have a
1 decibel = bel specific relationship with each other is called
10
As mentioned above, minimum audible a musical scale. Normally both in Indian
sound is denoted by 0 dB while whispering classical music and western classical music,
and normal speech have levels 10 dB and 60 eight frequencies, in specific ratio, form an
dB respectively at a distance of approximately octave, each frequency denoting a specific
1 m from the source. The intensity level of note. In a given octave frequency increases
maximum tolerable sound for a human ear is along sa re ga ma pa dha ni så (as well as
around 120 dB. along Do Re Mi Fa So La Ti Dò). An example
Loudness is different at different of values of frequencies is 240, 270, 300, 320,
frequencies, even for the same intensity. For 360, 400, 450, 480 Hz respectively.
measuring loudness the unit phon is used. 6.11 Musical instruments:
Phon is a measure of loudness. It is equal to Audible waves originate in vibrating
the loudness in decibel of any equally loud strings, vibrating air columns and vibrating
pure tone of frequency 1000Hz. plates and membranes. Accordingly, musical
2. Pitch: It is a sensation of sound which instruments are classified into three main types.
helps the listener to distinguish between a high (a) Stringed instruments (b) wind instruments
frequency and a low frequency note. Pitch is (c) percussion instruments.
the human perception to frequency- higher a) Stringed instruments: consist of stretched
frequency denotes higher pitch. The pitch of strings. Sound is produced by plucking of
a female voice is higher than that of a male strings. The strings are tuned to certain
voice. frequencies by adjusting tension in them. They
3. Quality or timbre: Normally sound are further of three different types.
generated by a source has a number of frequency 1) Plucked string type: In these instruments
components with different amplitudes. Quality string is plucked by fingers, e.g., tanpura,
of sound is that characteristic which enables sitar, guitar, veena, etc.
us to distinguish between two sounds of same 2) Bowed string type: In these instruments, a
pitch and loudness. We can recognize the string is played by bowing, e.g., violin, sarangi.
voice of a person or an instrument due to its 3) Struck string type: the string is struck by a
quality of sound. Quality depends on number stick , e.g. santoor, piano.
of overtones present in the sound along with a b) Wind instruments: These instruments
given frequency. consist of air column. Sound is produced by
A sound which produces a pleasing setting vibrations of air column. They are
sensation to the ear is a musical sound. It is further of three different types
produced by regular and periodic vibrations 1) Freewind type: In these instruments free
without any sudden change in loudness. brass reeds are vibrated by air. The air is
Musical sound has certain well-defined either blown or compressed. e.g., mouth organ,
frequencies with sizable amplitude; these harmonium etc.
are normally harmonics of a fundamental 2) Edge type: In these instruments air is blown
frequency. A mixture of sounds of different against an edge. e.g., Flute.
frequencies which do not have any relation 3) Reedpipes: They may consists of single
with each other produces what we call a noise. or double reeds and also instruments without
Noise therefore is not pleasant to hear. If in reeds .e.g., saxophone, clarinet (single reed),
addition, it is loud, it may cause headaches. bassoon (double reed), bugle (without reed).
154
c) Percussion instruments: In these
instruments sound is produced by setting Internet my friend
vibrations in a stretched membrane. e.g., tabla,
drum, dhol, mridangam, sambal, daphali,etc. • https://www.acs.psu.edu/drussell/
They also consist of metal type of instruments Demos/superposition/superposition.html
which produce sound when they struck against • https://www.acs.psu.edu/drussell/
each other or with a beater. e.g., cymbals (i.e., demos.html
jhanja), xylophone, etc. • h t t p s : / / w w w . g o o g l e . c o m /
A blow on the membrane or plate or search?client=firefox-b-
plucking of string produces vibrations with d&q=superposition+of+waves
one fundamental and many overtones. A • https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=J_
superposition of several natural modes of Oto3mUIuk
oscillations with different amplitudes and • h t t p s : / / w w w . y o u t u b e . c o m /
hence intensities characterize different watch?v=GsP5LqGtkwE
musical instruments. We can thus distinguish • h t t p s : / / w w w . a c s . p s u . e d u /
the instruments by their sounds. drussell/Demos/StandingWaves/
Production of different notes by musical StandingWaves.html
instrument depends or the creation of • https://www.physicsclassroom.com/
stationary waves. For a stringed instrument class/waves/Lesson-4/Formation-of-
such as guitar or sitar, the two ends of the Standing-Waves
string are fixed. Depending as where the string • https://www.physicsclassroom.com/
is plucked, stationary waves of various modes class/waves/Lesson-4/Formation-of-
midpoint minimum. In wind instruments, air Standing-Waves
column is made to vibrate by blowing. By • https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=-
changing the length of air column rote can be D9UlPcJSRM
charged. In wind instrument like flute, holes
• h t t p s : / / w w w . y o u t u b e . c o m /
can be uncovered to change the vibrations of
watch?v=jHjXNFmm8y4
air column this changes the pattern of nodes
act antinodes. • h t t p s : / / w w w . y o u t u b e . c o m /
In practice, sound produced is made up watch?v=BWqyXHKhaZ8
of several stationary waves having different • https://physics.info/waves-standing/
patterns of nodes and antinodes. Musicians • h t t p s : / / w w w . y o u t u b e . c o m /
skill is stimulating the string or air column to watch?v=nrJrV_Gn_Cw&t=661s
produce direct mixture of frequencies.
Do you know?
155
Exercises
1. Choose the correct option. the string which can be touched so as not
i) When an air column in a pipe closed at to disturb the motion of the string? What
one end vibrates such that three nodes will be the answer to this question if the
are formed in it, the frequency of its string is vibrating in its first and second
overtones?
vibrations is …….times the fundamental
iii) What are harmonics and overtones?
frequency.
iv) For a stationary wave set up in a string
(A) 2 (B) 3 (C) 4 (D) 5
having both ends fixed, what is the ratio
ii) If two open organ pipes of length 50 cm of the fundamental frequency to the
and 51 cm sounded together produce 7 second harmonic?
beats per second, the speed of sound is.
v) The amplitude of a wave is represented by
(A) 307 m/s (B) 327m/s
t x in SI units.
(C) 350m/s (D) 357m/s y 0.2 sin 4
iii) The tension in a piano wire is increased 0.08 0.8
by 25%. Its frequency becomes ….. times Find (a) wavelength, (b) frequency and
the original frequency. (c) amplitude of the wave.
(A) 0.8 (B) 1.12 (C) 1.25 (D) 1.56 3. State the characteristics of progressive
iv) Which of the following equations waves.
represents a wave travelling along the 4. State the characteristics of stationary
y-axis? waves.
(A) x A sin ky t 5. Derive an expression for equation of
stationary wave on a stretched string.
(B) y A sin kx t
6. Find the amplitude of the
(C) y A sin ky cos( t )
resultant wave produced due to
(D) y A cos ky sin ( t ) interference of two waves given as
v) A standing wave is produced on a string y1 A1 sin t y 2 A2 sin t
fixed at one end with the other end free. 7. State the laws of vibrating strings and
The length of the string explain how they can be verified using a
(A) must be an odd integral multiple of sonometer.
λ/4. 8. Show that only odd harmonics are present
(B) must be an odd integral multiple of in the vibrations of air column in a pipe
closed at one end.
λ/2.
9. Prove that all harmonics are present in
(C) must be an odd integral multiple of λ.
the vibrations of the air column in a pipe
(D) must be an even integral multiple of λ.
open at both ends.
2. Answer in brief. 10. A wave of frequency 500 Hz is travelling
i) A wave is represented by an equation y = with a speed of 350 m/s.
A sin (Bx + Ct). Given that the constants (a) What is the phase difference between
A, B and C are positive, can you tell in two displacements at a certain point at
which direction the wave is moving? times 1.0 ms apart? (b) what will be the
ii) A string is fixed at the two ends and is smallest distance between two points
vibrating in its fundamental mode. It is which are 45º out of phase at an instant
known that the two ends will be at rest. of time?
Apart from these, is there any position on [Ans : π, 8.75 cm ]
156
11. A sound wave in a certain fluid medium 18. A pipe open at both the ends has a
is reflected at an obstacle to form a fundamental frequency of 600 Hz. The
standing wave. The distance between first overtone of a pipe closed at one
two successive nodes is 3.75 cm. If the end has the same frequency as the first
velocity of sound is 1500 m/s, find the overtone of the open pipe. How long are
frequency. the two pipes?
[Ans : 20 kHz] [Ans : 27.5 cm, 20.625 cm]
12. Two sources of sound are separated by 19. A string 1m long is fixed at one end. The
a distance 4 m. They both emit sound other end is moved up and down with
with the same amplitude and frequency frequency 15 Hz. Due to this, a stationary
(330 Hz), but they are 180º out of phase. wave with four complete loops, gets
At what points between the two sources, produced on the string. Find the speed of
will the sound intensity be maximum? the progressive wave which produces the
[Ans: ± 0.25, ± 0.75, ± 1.25 and ± stationary wave.[Hint: Remember that
1.75 m from the point at the center] the moving end is an antinode.]
13. Two sound waves travel at a speed of 330 [Ans: 6.67 m s-1]
m/s. If their frequencies are also identical 20. A violin string vibrates with fundamental
and are equal to 540 Hz, what will be frequency of 440Hz. What are the
the phase difference between the waves frequencies of first and second overtones?
at points 3.5 m from one source and 3 m [Ans: 880 Hz, 1320 Hz]
from the other if the sources are in phase? 21. A set of 8 tuning forks is arranged in a
[Ans : 1.64 π] series of increasing order of frequencies.
14. Two wires of the same material and Each fork gives 4 beats per second with
same cross section are stretched on a the next one and the frequency of last
sonometer. One wire is loaded with 1.5 fork is twice that of the first. Calculate
kg and another is loaded with 6 kg. The the frequencies of the first and the last
vibrating length of first wire is 60 cm and fork.
its fundamental frequency of vibration [Ans: 28 Hz, 56 Hz]
is the same as that of the second wire. 22. A sonometer wire is stretched by tension
Calculate vibrating length of the other of 40 N. It vibrates in unison with a
wire. tuning fork of frequency 384 Hz. How
[Ans: 1.2 m] many numbers of beats get produced in
15. A pipe closed at one end can produce
two seconds if the tension in the wire is
overtones at frequencies 640 Hz, 896 Hz
decreased by 1.24 N?
and 1152 Hz. Calculate the fundamental
[Ans: 12 beats]
frequency.
23. A sonometer wire of length 0.5 m is
[Ans: 128 Hz]
stretched by a weight of 5 kg. The
16. A standing wave is produced in a tube
fundamental frequency of vibration is
open at both ends. The fundamental
100 Hz. Calculate linear density of wire.
frequency is 300 Hz. What is the length
[Ans: 4.9×10-3 kg/m]
of tube? (speed of the sound = 340 m s-1).
24. The string of a guitar is 80 cm long and
[Ans: 0.57 m]
has a fundamental frequency of 112 Hz. If
17. Find the fundamental, first overtone and
a guitarist wishes to produce a frequency
second overtone frequencies of a pipe,
of 160 Hz, where should the person press
open at both the ends, of length 25 cm if
the string? [Ans : 56 cm]
the speed of sound in air is 330 m/s.
[Ans: 660 Hz, 1320 Hz, 1980 Hz]
157
7. Wave Optics
158
7.2.2 Wave Nature: causing objects that one encounters in
To circumvent the difficulties in laboratory or in day-to-day life.
corpuscular theory, it was proposed by the In XIth Std we have learnt Maxwell's
Dutch physicist C. Huygens (1629-1695) in equations which suggested that light is an
the year 1668, that light is a wave. Huygens electromagnetic wave. As all waves known
assumed light to be a wave caused by till Maxwell’s time needed a medium to
vibrations of the particles of the medium. As propagate, Maxwell invoked the all-pervading
light could also travel in vacuum, he assumed hypothetical medium ether. The existence of
that a hypothetical medium, called ether is radio waves and their speed being same as that
present everywhere including in vacuum. Note of visible light, were experimentally verified
that this ether is not the substance (ether gas) by H. Hertz later in the nineteenth century.
that we come across in chemistry. There was Michelson and Morley performed several
however, no evidence to prove its existence experiments to detect ether but obtained
and thus, it was difficult to accept the concept. negative result. The hypothesized ether was
In the nineteenth century, certain new never detected, and its existence and necessity
phenomena of light namely, interference, was ruled out by Albert Einstein (1879-
diffraction and polarization were discovered. 1955) when he proposed the special theory
These could not be explained based on of relativity in the year 1905, based on a
corpuscular theory and needed wave theory for revolutionary concept of constancy of velocity
their explanation. Huygens’ theory could not of light.
only explain the new phenomena but could also 7.2.3 Dual Nature of Light:
explain the laws of reflection and refraction, In the early twentieth century, it was
as well as the formation of images by mirrors accepted that light has a dual nature. It can
and lenses. It was then accepted as the correct exhibit particle nature as well as wave nature
theory of light. Wave theory showed that if under different situations. Particles of light are
the speed of light waves in denser medium is called photons. We will learn more about it in
smaller than that in rarer medium then light Chapter 14.
bends towards normal. Thus, wave nature 7.3 Light as a Wave:
of light could explain all the visual effects Light is an electromagnetic wave. These
exhibited by light. The branch of optics which waves are transverse in nature and consist of
uses wave nature of light to explain the optical tiny oscillating electric and magnetic fields
phenomena is called wave optics. which are perpendicular to each other and to
In this chapter we are going to study wave the direction of propagation of the wave. These
optics and learn how the laws of reflection waves do not require any material medium
for propagation and can even travel through
and refraction can be explained assuming the
vacuum. The speed of light in a material
wave nature of light. We will also learn about
medium (v) depends on the refractive index
the phenomena of interference, diffraction
of the medium (n) which, in turn, depends on
and polarization and their explanation based
permeability and permittivity of the medium.
on wave optics. The reason why geometrical
The refractive index is equal to the ratio of
optics works in case of formation of shadows,
the speed of light in vacuum (c) to the speed
reflection and refraction is that the wavelength
of light in the medium (v). The refractive
of light is much smaller than the reflecting/
index of vacuum is 1 and that of air can be
refracting surfaces as well as the shadow
approximated to be 1.
159
reactions (examples: firecrackers, nuclear
Do you know? energy generators). Light originates in these
It was shown by Einstein in his special sources.
theory of relativity that the speed of light Secondary sources are those sources
(c) does not depend on the velocity of the which do not produce light of their own but
source of light or the observer. He showed receive light from some other source and either
that no object or information can travel reflect or scatter it around. Examples include
faster than the speed of light in vacuum the moon, the planets, objects like humans,
which is 300,000 km/s. animals, plants, etc., which we see due to
Electromagnetic waves can have reflected light. Majority of the sources that
wavelengths ranging from very small, we see in our daily life are secondary sources.
smaller than a femtometre (10-15 m), to very Most secondary sources are extended sources
large, larger than a kilometre. In the order as can be seen from the examples above.
of increasing wavelength, the waves are 7.4.2 Wavefront:
classified as γ-rays, X-rays, ultraviolet, We have seen that when we drop a stone
visible, infrared, microwave and radio waves. in water, surface waves, commonly known as
Visible light comprises of wavelengths in ripples, are generated which travel outwards
the 400-700 nm range. Waves of different from the point, say O, where the stone touches
wavelengths in the visible range are perceived water. Water particles along the path of the
by our eyes as different colours, with violet wave move up and down, perpendicular to
having the shortest and red having the longest the water surface. The phase of the wave at a
wavelength. White light is a mixture of waves point is defined by the state of motion of the
of different wavelengths. The refractive index particle at that point as well as the distance
of a medium depends on the wavelength used. of the point from the source (see Chapter 8 in
Because of this, for the same angle of incidence, XIth Std book). Two particles are in phase, i.e.,
the angle of refraction is different for different have the same phase if their state of motion is
colours (except for normal incidence) and the same, i.e., if they have the same velocity
therefore the colours present in the white light and displacement perpendicular to the water
get separated on passing through a transparent surface and if they are at the same distance
medium. This is the reason for formation of a from the source. As the waves are travelling
spectrum and of a rainbow. symmetrically in all directions along the water
7.4 Huygens’ Theory:
surface, all particles along the circumference
7.4.1 Primary and Secondary Sources of
of a circle with centre at O will have the same
Light:
phase. The locus of all points having the same
We see several sources of light around us,
phase at a given instant of time is called a
e.g., the Sun, moon, stars, light bulb, etc. These
wavefront. Thus, a wavefront is the locus of all
can be classified into primary and secondary
points where waves starting simultaneously
sources of light. Primary sources are sources
from O reach at a given instant of time. In
that emit light of their own, because of (i)
their high temperature (examples: the Sun, case of water waves the wavefronts are circles
the stars, objects heated to high temperatures, centred at O. The direction of propagation of
flame of any kind, etc), (ii) the effect of current the wave is perpendicular to the wavefronts,
being passed through them (examples: tube i.e., along the radii of the circle. The speed
light, TV, etc.), and (iii) chemical or nuclear with which the wavefronts move is the speed
160
of the wave. Water waves are two dimensional Let us now consider a spherical wavefront
(along a surface) waves. which has travelled a large distance away
Three dimensional waves like the sound from the source. If we take a small portion this
waves produced by a source of sound, or light wavefront, it will appear to be a plane surface
waves produced by a light source, travel in all (just like the surface of the earth around us
directions away from the source and propagate appears to be flat to us) with the direction of
in three dimensions. Such a wave is called a propagation perpendicular to it. In such a case
spherical wave. In these cases, the wavefronts the wave is called a plane wave. Wavefronts
are surfaces passing through all points having for a plane wave are shown in Fig.7.1 (b)
the same distance from the source and having where the arrows (rays) which are now parallel
the same phase. Thus, in these cases, they corresponding to a parallel beam of light, show
are spheres centred on the source say at O, the direction of propagation of the wave. If the
the cross sections of which are as shown in source of light is linear (along a line) the wave
Fig.7.1 (a). The spheres, the crosssections of fronts will be cylindrical.
which are seen as circles in the figure are 7.4.3 Huygens’ Principle:
wavefronts with the source at their centre. Huygens had assumed light to be a wave,
The arrows are perpendicular to the spherical similar to the mechanical wave like the water
surfaces and show the direction of propagation wave or sound wave, propagating in ether.
of the waves. These arrows are the rays of Accordingly the particles of ether oscillate
light that we have considered in earlier study due to the propagation of a light wave. He
of optics. The wavefronts shown in the figure put forth a principle which makes it possible
correspond to a diverging beam of light. We to determine the shape of a wavefront at any
can similarly have wavefronts corresponding time t, given its shape at an earlier time. This
to a converging beam of light. Such wavefronts principle can be stated as “Each point on a
can be produced after passing through a lens. wavefront acts as a secondary source of light
emitting secondary light waves called wavelets
in all directions which travel with the speed of
light in the medium. The new wavefront can
be obtained by taking the envelope of these
secondary wavelets travelling in the forward
direction and is thus, the envelope of the
secondary wavelets in forward direction. The
wavelets travelling in the backward direction
Fig.7.1 (a): Spherical wavefronts corresponding
to diverging beam of light. These are spherical are ineffective”.
waves. The source is at O. Given a wavefront at time t = 0 say, we
can determine the shape and position of a
wavefront at a later time t =T using Huygens’
principle. Let us first consider a plane
wavefront AB (corresponding to parallel
rays), at time t = 0 crosssection of which is
shown in Fig.7.2 (a). According to Huygens’
principle, each point on this wavefront will act
as a secondary source of light and will emit
Fig.7.1(b): Plane wavefronts corresponding to
spherical wavelets as shown in the figure. We
parallel beam of light. These are plane waves.
161
have shown only the wavelets travelling in the plane reflecting surface (mirror) MN which
forward direction (direction of propagation is also perpendicular to the plane of the paper
of light) as the backward travelling wavelets as shown in Fig.7.3. The figure shows a
are supposed to be ineffective. The wavelets cross section of the setup. RA and QB show
will be in the form of hemispheres and at a the direction of incidence. Let us assume
later time t = T, the radius of the hemispheres that the incident wavefront AB touches the
will be vT where v is the speed of light. The reflecting surface at A at time t = 0. The
wavefront at time T will be the envelope of point B will touch the reflecting surface at C
all these hemispherical wavelets and will be a after a time t = T. Between time t = 0 and T,
plane A′ B′ as shown in the figure. Similarly, different points along the incident wavefront
the position of a spherical wavefront at time t reach the reflecting surface successively and
= 0 is shown as AB in Fig.7.2 (b). The wavelets secondary wavelets will start propagating in
emitted in the forward direction by points on the form of hemispheres from those points in
AB will be hemispheres as shown in the figure. succession. For reflection, the hemispheres
At time T the radius of these spheres will be vT to be considered are on the same side of the
and their envelope will be a spherical surface mirror. The wavelet emitted by point A will
A′ B′ as shown. have a radius vT at time T. The radius of the
wavelet emitted by C will be zero at that time.
The radii of the wavelets emitted by points
between A and C will gradually decrease
from vT to 0. The envelope of these wavelets
forms the reflected wavefront. This is shown
by EC which is the common tangent to the
reflected wavelet originating from A and other
secondary wavelets emitted by points between
A and C.
Fig.7.2 (a): Progress of a plane wavefront.
Remember this
Remember this
166
and hence are partially polarized. It was
light coming out of P3?
experimentally discovered by D. Brewster in
Solution: The first polarizer, P1 will polarize
1812 that for a particular angle of incidence
the incident unpolarized light. The intensity
after passing through this polarizer will be θ B (shown in the figure), the reflected wave
I1 = I 0 /2 as discussed above. Let us assume is completely plane polarized with its electric
field perpendicular to the plane of the paper
that the amplitude of the electric field after
while the refracted wave is partially polarized.
passing through P1 is E10. While passing
This particular angle of incidence is called
through P2, a component of the electric field,
the Brewster’s angle. For this angle of
E20 = E10 cos θ1 will be able to pass through.
incidence, the refracted and reflected rays are
Thus, the intensity of light coming out of P2
perpendicular to each other. From the figure,
will be I2= (I1 cos2 θ1 ) = ( I 0 cos 2 θ1 ) /2.
for angle of refraction θ r we have,
While passing through P3, a component
B r = 90o --- (7.14)
E30 = E20 cos θ 2 will pass through. Thus, the
From law of refraction we have,
intensity of light coming out of P3 will be
n1 sin B n2 sin r . This with Eq.(7.14) gives
I3 = ( I 0 cos θ1 cos θ 2 ) /2
2 2
172
2. The two sources of light must be
water, the bright colours of butterflies and monochromatic. As can be seen from
peacocks etc. Most of these colours are the condition for bright and dark fringes,
not due to pigments which absorb specific the position of these fringes as well as the
colours but are due to interference of light
width of the fringes (Eq. (7.17), (7.18)
and (7.19)) depend on the wavelength of
light and the fringes of different colours
are not coincident. The resultant pattern
contains coloured, overlapping bands.
(In fact, original Young’s experiment was
with pin holes (not slits) and for sunlight,
producing coloured interference pattern
waves that are reflected by different
with central point as white).
layers.
Interference due to thin films: 3. The two interfering waves must have the
The brilliant colours of soap bubbles same amplitude. Only if the amplitudes
and thin oil films on the surface of water are equal, the intensity of dark fringes
are due to the interference of light waves (destructive interference) is zero and the
reflected from the upper and lower contrast between bright and dark fringes
surfaces of the film. The two rays have will be maximum.
a path difference which depends on the
4. The separation between the two slits
point on the film that is being viewed.
must be small in comparison to the
This is shown in the figure.
The incident wave gets partially distance between the plane containing
reflected from upper surface as shown by the slits and the observing screen. This
ray AE. The rest of the light gets refracted is necessary as only in this case, the width
and travels along AB. At B it again gets of the fringes will be sufficiently large
partially reflected and travels along BC. to be measurable (see Eq.(7.19)) and the
At C it refracts into air and travels along fringes are well separated and can be
CF. The parallel rays AE and CF have clearly seen.
a phase difference due to their different 5. The two slits should be narrow. If the
path lengths in different media. As can be slits are broad, the distances from different
seen from the figure, the phase difference points along the slit to a given point on
depends on the angle of incidence θ1 , i.e.,
the screen are significantly different and
the angle of incidence at the top surface,
therefore, the waves coming through the
which is the angle of viewing, and also on
the wavelength of the light as the refractive same slit will interfere among themselves,
index of the material of the thin film causing blurring of the interference
depends on it. The two rays AE and CF pattern.
interfere, producing maxima and minima 6. The two waves should be in the same
for different colours at different angles of state of polarization. This is necessary
viewing. One sees different colours when only if polarized light is used for the
the film is viewed at different angles. experiment. The explanation of this
As the reflection is from the denser condition is beyond the scope of this book.
boundary, there is an additional phase 7.8.4 Methods for Obtaining Coherent
difference of π radians (or an additional Sources:
path difference λ ). This should be taken In Young’s double slit experiment, we
into account for mathematical analysis.
obtained two coherent sources by making the
173
light from a single source pass through two having obtained from a single secondary
narrow slits. There are other ways to get two source S. The two waves coming from S1 and
coherent sources. We will discuss some of S2 interfere and form interference fringes like
those here. that in Young’s double slit experiment in the
i) Lloyd’s mirror: This is an extensively used shaded region shown in the figure.
device. The light from a source is made to fall Example 7.5: An isosceles prism of
at a grazing angle on a plane mirror as shown refracting angle 1790 and refractive index
in Fig.7.12. Some of the light falls directly on 1.5 is used as a biprism by keeping it
the screen as shown by the blue lines in the 10 cm away from a slit, the edge of the
figure and some light falls after reflection, as biprism being parallel to the slit. The slit
shown by red lines. The reflected light appears is illuminated by a light of wavelength 500
to come from a virtual source and so we get nm and the screen is 90 cm away from the
two sources. They are derived from a single biprism. Calculate the location of the centre
source and hence are coherent. They interfere of 20th dark band and the path difference at
and an interference pattern is obtained as this location.
shown in the figure. Note that even though we Solution: From the figure,
have shown the direct and reflected rays by
blue and red lines, the light is monochromatic
having a single wavelength.
d
c4
tan
Fig.7.12: Lloyd’s mirror.
ii) Fresnel biprism: A biprism is a prism 2 2 x1
with vertex angle of nearly 180o. It can be and for a thin prism, A 1
considered to be made up of two prisms with d 2 x1 2 A 1 x1
very small refracting angle ranging from 30′
2 0.5 1.5 1 10
180
to 1o, joined at their bases. In experimental
arrangement, the refracting edge of the
biprism is kept parallel to the length of the slit. cm
36
Monochromatic light from a source is made
500 nm 5 10 7 m ,
to pass through a narrow slit S as shown in
L 10 cm 90 cm 1m
Fig.7.13 and fall on the biprism.
Distance of 20th dark band from the
1
20 D 20
central bright band, X W
2
X 19.5 L
20 D
d
19.5 5 10 7 1
10 2
36
19.5 180 10 5
Fig. 7.13: Fresnel Biprism.
The two halves of the biprism form virtual
images S1 and S2. These are coherent sources 0.1103m
174
7.8.5 Optical Path: refractive index n introduces a path difference
The phase of a light wave having angular = nd – d = d(n – 1) over a ray travelling equal
frequency ω and wave vector k, travelling distance through vacuum.
in vacuum along the x direction is given by Two waves interfere constructively when
(kx -ωt) (Eq.(7.11)). Remember that wave vector their optical path lengths are equal or differ by
k and the angular frequency ω are related as integral multiples of the wavelength.
k = ω/v, v being the speed of the wave, which If we introduce a transparent plate of
is c in vacuum. If the light wave travels a thickness t and refractive index n in front of slit
distance Δx, its phase changes by Δ φ = kΔx S1 (Fig. 7.11), then the optical path travelled
= ωΔx/v. If the wave is travelling in vacuum by the wave along S1P is higher than that
k = ω/c and Δ φ = ωΔx/c. In case the wave travelled by the wave along S1P in absence
is travelling in a medium having a refractive of the plate by (n-1)t. Thus, the optical path
index n, then its wave vector k ′ and angular lengths and therefore, the phases of the rays
frequency are related by k ′ = ω/v = ω/(c/n), reaching the midpoint O′ from S1 and S2 will
v being the speed of the wave in this medium. not be equal. The path lengths will be equal
Thus, if the wave travels a distance Δx in this at a point different than O′ and so the bright
medium, the phase difference generated will fringe will not occur at O′ but at a different
be point where the two optical path lengths are
Δ φ ′ = k′Δx = ωn Δx /c = ω Δx′ /c, --- (7.24) equal. The dark and bright fringes will be
where, Δx′= n Δx. --- (7.25) situated symmetrically on both sides of this
Thus, when a wave travels a distance Δx central fringe. Thus, the whole interference
through a medium having refractive index of pattern will shift in one direction.
n, its phase changes by the same amount as
Example 7.6: What must be the thickness
it would if the wave had travelled a distance
of a thin film which, when kept near one
n Δx in vacuum. We can say that a path length
of the slits shifts the central fringe by 5
of Δx in a medium of refractive index n is
mm for incident light of wavelength 5400
equivalent to a path length of n Δx in vacuum.
Å in Young’s double slit interference
n Δx is called the optical path travelled by a
experiment? The refractive index of the
wave. Thus, optical path through a medium is
material of the film is 1.1 and the distance
the effective path travelled by light in vacuum
between the slits is 0.5 mm.
to generate the same phase difference. In
Solution: Given λ = 5400 Å, the refractive
vacuum, the optical path is equal to the actual
index of the material of the film = 1.1 and
path travelled as n = 1.
the shift of the central bright fringe = 5 mm.
Optical path in a medium can also be
Let t be the thickness of the film and P
defined as the corresponding path in vacuum
be the point on the screen where the central
that the light travels in the same time as it
fringe has shifted. Due to the film kept in
takes in the given medium.
distance d d front of slit S1 say, the optical path travelled
Now, time
t medium vacuum by the light passing through it increases
speed v medium v vacuum
v by t (1.1-1)= 0.1t. Thus, the optical paths
Opticalpath dvacuum vacuum dmedium between the two beams passing through the
v medium
two slits are not equal at the midpoint of
n dmedium
the screen but are equal at the point P, 5
Thus, a distance d travelled in a medium of
mm away from the centre. At this point the
175
light. As diffraction is a wave phenomenon,
distance travelled by light from the other slit
it is applicable to sound waves as well. As
S2 to the screen is larger than that from S1 by
wavelengths of sound waves are larger,
0.1t.
diffraction of sound is easier to observe.
The difference in distances S2P – S1P = y
7.9.1 Fresnel and Fraunhofer Diffraction:
λ /d, where y is the distance along the screen
Diffraction can be classified into two
= 5 mm = 0.005 m and d is given to be 0.5
types depending on the distances involved in
mm = 0.0005 m.
the experimental setup.
This has to be equal to the difference in
1. Fraunhofer diffraction: If the distances
optical paths introduced by the film.
between the primary source of light, the
Thus, 0.1t = 0.005 x 5400 x 10-10/0.0005.
obstacle/slit causing diffraction and the
t = 5.4 x 10 -5m = 0.054 mm
screen for viewing the diffraction pattern
are very large, the diffraction is called
7.9 Diffraction of Light:
Fraunhofer diffraction. In this case, the
We know that shadows are formed when
wavefront incident on the obstacle can be
path of light is blocked by an opaque obstacle.
considered to be a plane wavefront. For
Entire geometrical optics is based on the
this, we generally place the source of light
rectilinear propagation of light. However, as
at the focus of a convex lens so that a plane
discussed earlier, the phenomenon exhibited
wavefront is incident on the obstacle and
by light such as interference can only be
another convex lens is used on the other
explained by considering the wave nature of
side of the obstacle to make the pattern
light. Diffraction is another such phenomenon.
visible on the screen. Figure 7.14 shows
In certain experiments, light is seen to bend
this arrangement schematically.
around edges of obstacles in its path and enter
2. Fresnel diffraction: In this case, the
into regions where shadows are expected on
distances are much smaller and the
the basis of geometrical optics. This, so called
incident wavefront is either cylindrical or
bending of light around objects, is called the
spherical depending on the source. A lens
phenomenon of diffraction and is common to
is not required to observe the diffraction
all waves. We are very familiar with the fact
pattern on the screen.
that sound waves travel around obstacles as
7.9.2 Experimental set up for Fraunhofer
we can hear someone talking even though
diffraction:
there are obstacles, e.g. a wall, placed between
us and the person who is talking. As we will
see below, light actually does not bend around
edges in diffraction, but is able to reach the
shadow region due to the emission by the
secondary sources of light on the edge of the
obstacle. The phenomenon of diffraction
is intimately related to that of interference. Fig. 7.14: Set up for fraunhofer diffraction .
Diffraction is essentially the interference of
Figure 7.14 shows a monochromatic
many waves rather than two which we have
source of light S at the focus of a converging
encountered in interference. Also, diffraction
lens. Ignoring aberrations, the emerging beam
is noticeable only when the size of the obstacle
will consist of plane parallel rays resulting in
or slits is of the order of the wavelength of
176
plane wavefronts. These are incident on the Location of minima and maxima: Figure
diffracting element such as a slit, a circular 7.15 is a part of figure 7.14. It shows two sets
aperture, a double slit, a grating, etc. Emerging of parallel rays originating at the slit elements.
beam is incident on another converging lens The central and symmetric beam focuses at
that focuses the beam on a screen. the central point (line) P0, directly in front of
In the case of a circular aperture, S is a O, the center of the slit.
point source and the lenses are bi-convex. Rays parallel to the axis from all points
For linear elements like slits, grating, etc., the from A to B are focused at the central point
source is linear and the lenses are cylindrical P0. Thus, all these rays must be having equal
in shape so that the focussed image is also optical paths. Hence all these arrive at P0
linear. In either case, a plane wavefront (as with the same phase, and thereby produced
if the source is at infinity) approaches and constructive interference at P0.
leaves the diffracting element. This is as per In the case of point P at angular position
the requirements of Fraunhofer diffraction. θ the optical paths of the rays from A to C till
7.9.3 Fraunhofer Diffraction at a Single Slit: point P are equal as AC is normal to AM. From
Figure 7.14 shows the cross section of a this points onwards, there is no path difference
plane wavefront YY′ incident on a single slit or phase difference between these rays. Hence,
of width AB. The centre of the slit is at point the paths of rays between AB and AC are
O. As the width of the slit is in the plane of the responsible for the net path difference or phase
paper, its length is perpendicular to the paper. difference at point P. The path difference
The slit can be imagined to be divided into a between extreme rays is BC a sin . Let this
number of extremely thin slits (or slit elements). be equal to λ .
The moment the plane wavefront reaches the 1
Let K be the midpoint of AC. OK BC
slit, each slit element becomes the secondary 2 2
source of cylindrical wavefronts responsible Thus, the path difference between AP and OP
for diffraction in all possible directions. A is λ / 2. As a result, these two rays (waves)
cylindrical lens (with its axis parallel to the produce destructive interference at P. Now
slit) kept next to the slit converges the emergent consider any pair of points equidistant
beams on to the screen kept at the focus. The respectively from A and O, such as G and H,
distance D between the slit and the screen is separated by distance a /2 along the slit. Rays
practically the focal length F of the lens. For (waves) from any such pair will have a path
all practical set ups, the width a of the slit is of difference of λ /2 at P. Thus, all such pairs
the order of 10-4 to 10-3 m and distance D is of of points between AO and OB will produce
the order of 10 m, i.e., D >> a. destructive interference at P. This makes point
P to be the first minimum.
This discussion can be extended to points
on the screen having path differences 2 λ , 3
λ , … n λ between the extreme rays reaching
them and it can be seen that these points will
be dark and hence will be positions of dark
fringes.
Again, the same logic is applicable for
points on the other side of P0.
Fig. 7.15: Fraunhofer diffraction .
177
Hence, at the location of nth minima, the
Let y nd and y nb be the distances of nth dark
path difference between the extreme rays
point and nth bright point from the central
a sin n --- (7.26)
bright point.
If we assume the maxima to be in between
Thus, at the nth dark point on either side of
the respective minima, we can write the path
the central bright point, using Eq. (7.26)
difference between the extreme rays at the nth y
maxima as nd nd n , y nd n D nW --- (7.28)
D a a
1
a sin n
th
Also, at the n bright point on either side of the
2 --- (7.27) central bright point, using Eq. (7.27)
y 1
Do you know? nb nb n --- (7.29)
D 2a
• Why did we use λ as the path difference
1 D 1
between the waves originating from y nb n n W ,
2 a 2
extreme points for the first minima?
D
• On receiving energy from two waves, at where, W a is similar to the fringe width
the position of the first dark fringe, the in the interference pattern. In this case also
path difference between the two waves it is the distance between consecutive bright
must be λ /2. In the case of a single slit, fringes or consecutive dark fringes, except the
a point on the screen receives waves central (zeroth) bright fringe.
from all the points on the slit. For the Width of the central bright fringe:
point on the screen to be dark, there must The central bright fringe is spread
be a path difference of λ /2 for all pairs between the first dark fringes on either side.
of waves. One wave from this pair is Thus, width of the central bright fringe is the
from upper half part of the slit and the
distance between the centres of first dark fringe
other is from the lower half e.g., points
on either side.
A and O, G and H, O and B, etc. Thus,
∴ Width of the central bright fringe,
the minimum path difference between
D
the waves originating from the extreme Wc 2 y1d 2W 2
points A and B must be . a
2 2 7.9.4 Comparison of Young’s Double
In reality, these are nearly midway and Slit Interference Pattern and Single Slit
not exactly midway between the dark fringes. Diffraction Pattern:
Distances of minima and maxima from the For a common laboratory set up, the
central bright point,(i.e., the distances on the slits in the Young’s double slit experiment
screen): are much thinner than their separation. They
Equations (7.26) and (7.27) relate the are usually obtained by using a biprism or a
path difference at the locations of nth dark Lloyd’s mirror. The separation between the
slits is a few mm only. With best possible set
and nth bright point respectively. As described
up, we can usually see about 30 to 40 equally
earlier, the distance D >>a. Hence the angle θ
spaced bright and dark fringes of nearly same
is very small. Thus, if it is expressed in radian,
y brightness.
we can write, sin tan where y The single slit used to obtain the
D
is the distance of point P, on the screen from diffraction pattern is usually of width less
the central bright point, the screen being at a than 1 mm. Taken on either side, we can see
distance D from the diffracting element (single around 20 to 30 fringes with central fringe
slit). being the brightest. Also, width of the central
178
bright fringe is twice that of all the other bright between interference and diffraction patterns
fringes (in the single slit diffraction pattern). and Fig. (7.16) shows corresponding
Table 7.1 gives mathematical comparison (I - θ) graphs.
Remember the following while using the table:
Central bright fringe is the ZEROTH bright fringe (n = 0), and not the first.
d: slit separation, a: slit width, D: Slit/s to screen separation
W: Separation between consecutive bright or dark fringes.
Table 7.1: Comparison between interference and diffraction patterns
Young’s double slit
Single slit
Physical quantity interference
diffraction pattern
Pattern
D D Except for the central
Fringe width W W W
d a bright fringe
Phase difference, δ 1
n 2 n 2 2
between extreme rays
1
For nth Angular position, θ n n 2 d
d
bright
fringe Path difference, ∆x 1
between extreme rays
nλ n 2
Phase difference, δ 1 n 2
n 2 2
between extreme rays
1
Angular position, θ n 2 d n
For nth d
dark fringe Path difference, ∆x 1 nλ
between extreme rays n 2
Distance from the 1 D D
central bright spot, y n 2 d nW n nW
a
I (a)
I (c)
θ in degrees
θ in degrees
I
Fig.7.16: Intensity I distribution in (a) Young’s
double slit interference (b) single slit diffraction
(b) and (c) double slit diffraction.
θ in degrees
179
Double slit diffraction pattern: be resolved (which are assumed to be point
What pattern will be observed due to objects). It is the minimum visual angle
diffraction from two slits rather than one? In between two objects that can be resolved by
this case the pattern will be decided by the that instrument. This minimum angle is called
diffraction pattern of the individual slits, as limit of resolution. Reciprocal of the limit of
well as by the interference between them. The resolution is called the resolving power.
pattern is shown in Fig.7.16 (c). There are 7.10.1 Rayleigh’s Criterion for Limit of
narrow interference fringes similar to those in Resolution (or for Resolving Power):
Young’s double slit experiment, but of varying According to Lord Rayleigh, the ability
brightness and the shape of their envelope is of an optical instrument to distinguish between
that of the single slit diffraction pattern. two closely spaced objects depends upon the
7.10 Resolving Power: diffraction patterns of the two objects (slits,
Diffraction effect is most significant while point objects, stars, etc.), produced at the
discussing the resolving power of an optical screen (retina, eyepiece, etc.). According to this
instrument. We use an optical instrument to criterion, two objects are just resolved when the
see minor details of all the parts of an object first minimum of the diffraction pattern of one
or to see distinct images of different nearby source coincides with the central maximum of
objects and not only for magnification. the diffraction pattern of the other source, and
Consider your friend showing two of her vice versa.
fingers (as we do while showing a victory sign)
from a distance less than 10 m. You can easily
point out that she is showing two fingers, i.e.,
you can easily distinguish the two fingers.
However, if she shows the same two fingers
from a distance over 50 m, most of you will
NOT be able to distinguish the two fingers,
i.e., you can’t definitely say whether those are Fig. 7.17 Rayleigh’s criterion for resolution
two fingers or it is a single finger. of objects.
This ability to distinguish two physically In Fig. 7.17(b), first minimum of the
separated objects as two distinct objects is diffraction pattern of second object is
known as the resolving power of an optical coinciding with the central maximum of the
instrument. In the example given, it was your first and vice versa. In such case we find the
eye. In other words, from a distance less than objects to be just resolved as the depression in
10 m, your eye is able to resolve the two the resultant envelopee is noticeable. For Fig
fingers. From beyond 50 m, it may not possible 7.17(a), the depression is not noticeable and in
for you to resolve the two fingers. Fig 7.17(c), it can be clearly noticed.
Resolving power of an optical instrument (i) Two linear objects: Consider two self
(an eye, a microscope, a telescope, etc.) luminous objects (slits) separated by some
generally depends upon the aperture (usually distance. As per Rayleigh’s criterion, the first
the diameter of the lens or mirror) and the minimum of the diffraction pattern of one of
wavelength of the light used. In general, the the sources should coincide with the central
resolving ability of an instrument is stated in maximum of the other. Graphical pattern of
terms of the visual angle, which is the angle the diffraction by two slits at the just resolved
subtended at the eye by the two objects to condition is as shown in the lower half of the
180
Fig 7.17(b). Angular separation (position) of According to Lord Rayleigh, for such
the first principal minimum is objects to be just resolved, the first dark ring of
the diffraction pattern of the first object should
d --- (7.28)
a be formed at the centre of the diffraction
As this minimum coincides with the
pattern of the second, and vice versa. In other
central maximum of the other, this must be the
words, the minimum separation between the
minimum angular separation between the two
images on the screen is radius of the first dark
objects, and hence the limit of resolution of
ring (Fig. 7.17 (b) and Fig. 7.19 (a))
that instrument.
The discussion till here is applicable to
Limitofresolution, d
a any instrument such as an eye, a microscope,
Minimum separation between the two a telescope, etc.
linear objects that are just resolved, at distance 7.10.2 Resolving Power of a Microscope:
D from the instrument, is Fig 7.19 shows two point objects O
D
y D d --- (7.29) and O′ separated by a distance a in front of
a an objective AB of a microscope. Medium
It is obviously the distance of the first
between the objects and the objective is of
minimum from the centre.
refractive index n. Wavelength of the light
(ii) Pair of Point objects: In the case of a
emitted by the sources in the medium is λn .
microscope, quite often, the objects to be
Angular separation between the objects, at the
viewed are similar to point objects. The
objective is 2 α .
diffraction pattern of such objects consists of
a central bright disc surrounded by concentric
rings, called Airy disc and rings as shown
in Fig. 7.18 (a). Abbe was the first to study
this thoroughly, and apply it to Fraunhofer
diffraction. Fig 7.19 (a) : Resolution of objects by a
microscope.
1. Choose the correct option. iv) In Young's double slit experiment what
i) Which of the following phenomenon will we observe on the screen when
proves that light is a transverse wave? white light is incident on the slits but one
(A) reflection (B) interference slit is covered with a red filter and the
(C) diffraction (D) polarization other with a violet filter? Give reasons
ii) Which property of light does not change for your answer.
when it travels from one medium to v) Explain what is optical path length. How
another? is it different from actual path length?
(A) velocity (B) wavelength 3. Derive the laws of reflection of light
(C) amplitude (D) frequency using Huygens’ principle.
iii) When unpolarized light is passed through 4. Derive the laws of refraction of light
a polarizer, its intensity using Huygens’ principle.
(A) increases (B) decreases 5. Explain what is meant by polarization
(C) remains unchanged and derive Malus’ law.
(D) depends on the orientation of the 6. What is Brewster’s law? Derive the
polarizer formula for Brewster angle.
iv) In Young’s double slit experiment, the 7. Describe Young’s double slit interference
two coherent sources have different experiment and derive conditions for
intensities. If the ratio of maximum occurrence of dark and bright fringes
on the screen. Define fringe width and
intensity to the minimum intensity in the
derive a formula for it.
interference pattern produced is 25:1.
8. What are the conditions for obtaining
What was the ratio of intensities of the
good interference pattern? Give reasons.
two sources?
9. What is meant by coherent sources?
(A) 5:1 (B) 25:1 (C) 3:2 (D) 9:4
What are the two methods for obtaining
v) In Young’s double slit experiment, a thin
coherent sources in the laboratory?
uniform sheet of glass is kept in front of
10. What is diffraction of light? How does
the two slits, parallel to the screen having
it differ from interference? What are
the slits. The resulting interference Fraunhoffer and Fresnel diffractions?
pattern will satisfy 11. Derive the conditions for bright and dark
(A) The interference pattern will remain fringes produced due to diffraction by a
unchanged single slit.
(B) The fringe width will decrease 12. Describe what is Rayleigh’s criterion for
(C) The fringe width will increase resolution. Explain it for a telescope and
(D) The fringes will shift. a microscope.
2. Answer in brief. 13. White light consists of wavelengths from
i) What are primary and secondary sources 400 nm to 700 nm. What will be the
of light? wavelength range seen when white light
ii) What is a wavefront? How is it related is passed through glass of refractive
to rays of light? What is the shape of the index 1.55?
wavefront at a point far away from the [Ans: 258.06 - 451.61 nm]
source of light? 14. The optical path of a ray of light of a
iii) Why are multiple colours observed over given wavelength travelling a distance
a thin film of oil floating on water? of 3 cm in flint glass having refractive
Explain with the help of a diagram.
184
index 1.6 is same as that on travelling a the first minimum is 5 mm on either
distance x cm through a medium having side of the central maximum, find the
refractive index 1.25. Determine the wavelength of light.
value of x. [Ans: 5000 Å]
[Ans: 3.84 cm] 20. The intensity of the light coming from
15. A double-slit arrangement produces one of the slits in Young’s experiment
interference fringes for sodium light is twice the intensity of the light coming
( 589 nm) that are 0.20° apart. What from the other slit. What will be the
is the angular fringe separation if the approximate ratio of the intensities of the
entire arrangement is immersed in water bright and dark fringes in the resulting
(n = 1.33)? interference pattern? [Ans: 34]
[Ans: 0.15°] 21. A parallel beam of green light of
16. In a double-slit arrangement the slits wavelength 546 nm passes through a slit
are separated by a distance equal to 100 of width 0.4 mm. The intensity pattern
times the wavelength of the light passing of the transmitted light is seen on a
through the slits. (a) What is the angular screen which is 40 cm away. What is
the distance between the two first order
separation in radians between the central
minima?
maximum and an adjacent maximum?
[Ans: 1.1 mm]
(b) What is the distance between these
22. What must be the ratio of the slit width
maxima on a screen 50.0 cm from the
to the wavelength for a single slit to have
slits?
the first diffraction minimum at 45.0°?
[Ans: 0.01 rad, 0.5 cm]
[Ans: 1.27]
17. Unpolarized light with intensity I0 is
23. Monochromatic electromagnetic
incident on two polaroids. The axis of
radiation from a distant source passes
the first polaroid makes an angle of
through a slit. The diffraction pattern is
50o with the vertical, and the axis of observed on a screen 2.50 m from the
the second polaroid is horizontal. What slit. If the width of the central maximum
is the intensity of the light after it has is 6.00 mm, what is the slit width if the
passed through the second polaroid? wavelength is (a) 500 nm (visible light);
[Ans: I0/2 × (cos 400)2] (b) 50 μm (infrared radiation); (c) 0.500
18. In a biprism experiment, the fringes nm (X-rays)?
are observed in the focal plane of the [Ans: 0.416 mm, 41.6 mm, 4.16x10-4
eyepiece at a distance of 1.2 m from the mm]
slits. The distance between the central 24. A star is emitting light at the wavelength
bright band and the 20th bright band is of 5000 Å. Determine the limit of
0.4 cm. When a convex lens is placed resolution of a telescope having an
between the biprism and the eyepiece, objective of diameter of 200 inch.
90 cm from the eyepiece, the distance [Ans: 1.2×10-7 rad]
between the two virtual magnified 25. The distance between two consecutive
images is found to be 0.9 cm. Determine bright fringes in a biprism experiment
the wavelength of light used. using light of wavelength 6000 Å is
[Ans: 5000 Å] 0.32 mm by how much will the distance
19. In Fraunhoffer diffraction by a narrow change if light of wavelength 4800 Å is
slit, a screen is placed at a distance of 2 used?
m from the lens to obtain the diffraction [Ans: 0.064 mm]
pattern. If the slit width is 0.2 mm and
185
8. Electrostatics
charge configurations with the help of some
Can you recall?
examples.
1. What are conservative forces? 8.2.1 Electric Field Intensity due to Uniformly
2. What is potential energy ? Charged Spherical Shell or Hollow Sphere:
3. What is Gauss’ law and what is a Consider a sphere of radius R with its
Gaussian surface? centre at O, charged to a uniform charge
density σ (C/m2 ) placed in a dielectric medium
8.1 Introduction:
of permittivity ε (ε = ε 0 k ) . The total charge
In XIth Std we have studied the Gauss’ on the sphere, q = σ × 4πR2
Law which gives the relationship between By Gauss’ theorem, the net flux through a
the electric charge and its electric field. It closed surface
also provides equivalent methods for finding φ = q/ε0 (for air/vaccum k=1)
electric field intensity by relating values of the where q is the total charge inside the closed
field at a closed surface and the total charges surface.
enclosed by that surface. It is a powerful tool
which can be applied for the calculation of the
electric field when it originates from charge
distribution of sufficient symmetry. The law
can be written as
q
0
E ds --- (8.1)
where φ is the total flux coming out of a
closed surface and q is the total charge inside Fig. 8.1: Uniformly charged spherical shell or
the closed surface. hollow sphere.
To find the electric field intensity at
Common steps involved in calculating
electric field intensity by using Gauss’ a point P, at a distance r from the centre of
theorem: the charged sphere, imagine a concentric
1. Describe the charge distribution Gaussian sphere of radius r passing through
(linear/surface/volume) P. Let ds be a small area around the point P
2. Obtain the flux by Gauss’ theorem (Let on the Gaussian surface. Due to symmetry and
this be Eq. (A)) spheres being concentric, the electric field at
3. Visualize a Gaussian surface and justify each point on the Gaussian surface has the
it. same magnitude E and it is directed radially
4. With the electric field intensity E
outward. Also, the angle between the direction
as unknown, obtain electric flux by
calculation, using geometry of the of E and the normal to the surface of the sphere
structure and symmetry of the Gaussian (ds) is zero i.e., cos θ = 1
surface (Let this be Eq. (B)) ∴ E . ds = E ds cos θ = E ds
5. Equate RHS of Eq. (A) and Eq. (B) and ∴ flux d φ through the area ds = E ds
calculate E. Total electric flux
through the Gaussian
8.2 Application of Gauss' Law: surface E ds Eds E ds
In this section we shall see how to obtain ∴ φ = E 4π r 2 --- (8.2)
the electric field intensity for some symmetric From equations (8.1) and (8.2),
186
q/ε0 = E 4π r2
∴ E = q/ 4 0 r 2 --- (8.3)
Since q = σ × 4πR 2
∴E = σR2 / ε 0 r
2
--- (8.4)
From Eqn. (8.3) it can be seen that, the
electric field at a point outside the shell is the
same as that due to a point charge. Thus it can
be concluded that a uniformly charged sphere
is equivalent to a point charge at its center. Fig. 8.2: Infinitely long straight charged wire
Case (i) If point P lies on the surface of the (cylinder).
charged sphere: r = R To find the electric field intensity at P ,at
∴ E= q/ 4 0 R 2 =σ/ ε 0 a distance r from the charged wire, imagine
Case (ii) If point P lies inside the sphere: Since a coaxial Gaussian cylinder of length l and
radius r (closed at each end by plane caps
there are no charges inside σ = 0,
normal to the axis) passing through the point
∴ E = 0.
P. Consider a very small area ds at the point P
Example : 8.1
on the Gaussian surface.
A sphere of radius 10 cm carries a charge of By symmetry, the magnitude of the
1µC. Calculate the electric field electric field will be the same at all the points
(i) at a distance of 30 cm from the center on the curved surface of the cylinder and
of the sphere will be directed radially outward. The angle
(ii) at the surface of the sphere and between the direction of E and the normal to
(iii) at a distance of 5 cm from the center of the surface of the cylinder (ds) is zero i.e.,
the sphere. cos θ =1
Solution: Given: q = 1µC = 1 × 10-6 C ∴ E.ds = Eds cos θ = Eds
(i) Electric intensity at a distance r is Flux d φ through the area ds = E ds.
E = q/ 4 0 r
2
Total electric flux through the Gaussian
For r = 30 cm = 0.3 m surface E ds Eds E ds
9 109 1 10 6 ∴ φ = E. 2πrl --- (8.5)
E = = 105 N/C From equations (8.1) and (8.5)
0.3
2
1
r
1
r2 r 1 2 cos
2
r
1
1 1 2 2
1 cos and
r1 r r
1
Fig. 8.8: Electric potential due to an electric 1 1 2 2
1 cos
dipole. r2 r r
Let C be any point near the electric dipole
q 1 1
2 cos 2
VC V1 V2 1
4 0 r
at a distance r from the centre O inclined at an
r
angle θ with axis of the dipole. r1 and r2 are
the distances of point C from charges +q and 1 2 cos
1
2
-q, respectively. 1
r r
Potential at C due to charge +q at A is,
V = + q Using binomial expansion, ( 1 + x)n = 1 +
4 0 r1
1
nx, x << l and retaining terms up to the first
Potential at C due to charge -q at B is,
order of only, we get
r
192
q 1 Solution: Given
VC
1 cos 1 cos p = 1×10-9 Cm
4 0 r r r
r = 0.3 m
q
1 cos 1 cos a) Potential at a point on the axial line
4 o r r r 1 p 9 109 1 10 9
q 2 V = = =100 volt
cos 4π 0 r 2 0.3
2
= 50 volt
1 p .r r
VC , r c) Electrostatics potential due to a system of
4 0 r 2 r charges:
where r is a unit vector along the position
We now extend the analysis to a system of
vector, OC = r
charges.
i) Potential at an axial point, θ = 0 0 (towards
+q) or 1800 (towards – q)
1 p
Vaxial
4 o r 2
i.e. This is the maximum value of the potential.
ii) Potential at an equatorial point, θ = 90° and
V=0
Hence, the potential at any point on the
equatorial line of a dipole is zero. This is Fig. 8.9: System of charges.
the minimum value of the magnitude of the Consider a system of charges q1, q2 .........
potential of a dipole. qn at distances r1, r2 ...... rn respectively from
Thus the plane perpendicular to the line point P. The potential V1 at P due to the charge
q1 is
between the charges at the midpoint is an 1 q1
equipotential plane with potential zero. The V1 =
4 0 r1
work done to move a charge anywhere in this Similarly the potentials V2, V3 ........Vn at
plane (potential difference being zero) will be P due to the individual charges q2, q3 ...........qn
zero. are given by
1 q2 1 q3 1 qn
V2 , V3 , Vn
Example 8.7: A short electric dipole has 4 0 r2 4 0 r3 4 0 rn
dipole moment of 1 × 10-9 C m. Determine By the superposition principle, the
the electric potential due to the dipole at a potential V at P due to the system of charges is
point distance 0.3 m from the centre of the the algebraic sum of the potentials due to the
dipole situated individual charges.
a) on the axial line b) on the equatorial line ∴ V = V + V + ... + V
1 2 n
c) on a line making an angle of 60° with the
1 q1 q2 q
dipole axis. = + + ----- + n
4 0 r1 r2 rn
193
1 n qi
Or, V
4 0 i 1 ri
As V1 + V2 = 0
1 q1 q2
0
For a continuous charge distribution, 4π 0 x x 0.16
summation should be replaced by integration.
5 10 8 310 8
9 × 10
9 0
Use your brain power x x 0.16
∴x = 0.40 m, x = 40 cm
Is electrostatic potential necessarily zero at
8.5 Equipotential Surfaces:
a point where electric field strength is zero?
Justify. An equipotential surface is that surface,
at every point of which the electric potential is
Example 8.8: Two charges 5 × 10-8 C and the same. We know that,
-3 × 10-8 C are located 16 cm apart. At what The potential (V) for a single charge q is
point (s) on the line joining the two charges given by V = 1 q
is the electric potential zero ? Take the
4 0 r
potential at infinity to be zero. If r is constant then V will be constant.
Solution : As shown below, suppose the two Hence, equipotential surfaces of single point
point charges are placed on x- axis with the charge are concentric spherical surfaces
positive charge located at the origin O.
centered at the charge. For a line charge, the
q1= 5 × 10-8 C q2= -3 × 10-8 C
shape of equipotential surface is cylindrical.
Fig. 8.11: Equipotential surface ⊥ to E
b) If the field is not normal, it would have a Fig. 8.14: Equipotential surfaces for two
identical positive charges.
nonzero component along the surface. So to
move a test charge against this component
work would have to be done. But by the
definition of equipotential surfaces, there
is no potential difference between any two
points on an equipotential surface and hence
Fig. 8.15: (a) Between
no work is required to displace the charge on
2 plane metallic
the surface. Therefore, we can conclude that sheets.
the electrostatic field must be normal to the
equipotential surface at every point, and vice
versa.
Do you know?
195
To calculate the electric potential energy
difference of 4000 V across them. Find the
of the two charge system, we assume that the
mass of the particle.
two charges q1 and q2 are initially at infinity.
Solution: Given :
We then determine the work done in bringing
q = 1.6 × 10-19 C
the charges to the given location by an external
dx = 10 cm = 10 × 10-2 m = 10-1 m
agency.
dV = 4000 V
−dV − 4000 In bringing the first charge q1 to position
E =
dx
=
10 −1
A r1 , no work is done because there is no
= - 4 × 104 Vm-1 external field against which work needs to be
As the charged particle remain suspended done as charge q2 is still at infinity i.e., W1 =
in equilibrium, 0. This charge produces a potential in space
given by
F = mg = qE 1 q1
V1 = --- (8.14)
∴m =
qE
=
1.6 10 19 4 10 4 4 0 r1
g 9.8 Where r1 is the distance of point A from
= 0.653 × 10 kg-15
the origin.
m = 6.53 × 10-16 kg When we bring charge q2 from infinity to
8.6 Electrical Energy of Two Point Charges
r
B 2 at a distance r12, from q1, work done is
and of a Dipole in an Electrostatic Field: W2 = (potential at B due to charge q1) × q2
When two like charges lie infinite distance q1
= × q2 , (where AB = r12) --- (8.15)
apart, their potential energy is zero because 4 0 r12
no work has to done in moving one charge at This work done in bringing the two
infinite distance from the other. But when they charges to their respective locations is stored
are brought closer to one another, work has as the potential energy of the configuration of
to be done against the force of repulsion. As two charges.
electrostatic force is conservative, this work 1 q1q2
U = --- (8.16)
gets stored as the potential energy of the two 4 0 r12
charges. Electrostatic potential energy of Equation (8.16) can be generalised for a
a system of point charges is defined as the system of any number of point charges.
total amount of work done to assemble the Example 8.10: Two charges of magnitude
system of charges by bringing them from 5 nC and −2 nC are placed at points
infinity to their present locations. (2 cm, 0, 0) and (20 cm, 0, 0) in a region of
a) Potential energy of a system of 2 point space, where there is no other external field.
charges: Find the electrostatic potential energy of
the system.
Solution : Given
q1= 5 nC = 5 × 10-9 C
q2 = -2 nC = -2 × 10-9 C
r = (20 – 2) cm = 18 cm = 18 × 10-2 m
O 1 q1q2
U =
4π 0 r
Fig. 8.16: System of two point charges. 9 109 5 10 9
2 10 9
Let us consider 2 charges q1 and q2 with =
2
18 10
position vectors r1 and r2 relative to some
origin (O). = -5 × 10-7 J = -0.5 × 10-6 J = -0.5 µJ
196
b) Potential energy for a system of N point (c) Potential energy of a single charge in an
charges: external field:
Equation (8.16) gives an expression for Above, we have obtained an expression
potential energy for a system of two charges. for potential energy of a system of charges
We now analyse the situation for a system of when the source of the electric field, i.e.,
N point charges. charges and their locations, were specified.
In bringing a charge q3 from ∞ to C In this section, we determine the potential
( r3 ) work has to be done against electrostatic energyof a charge (or charges) in an external
forces of both q1and q2 field E which is not produced by the given
∴ W3 = (potential at C due to q1 and q2 )× q3
charge (or charges) whose potential energy we
1 q1 q2
= + × q3 wish to calculate. The external sources could
4 0
r13 r23 be known, unknown or unspecified, but what is
1 q1q3 q2 q3 known is the electric field E or the `electrostatic
= +
4 0 r13 r23 potential V due to the external sources.
Similarly Here we assume that the external field
in bringing a charge q4 from
∞ to D r4 work has to be done against is not affected by the charge q, if q is very
electrostatic forces of q1, q2, and q3 small. The external electric field E and the
corresponding external potential V may vary
1 q q q q q q
W4 =
1 4
+ 2 4 + 3 4 from point to point.
4 0 r14 r24 r34
If V ( r ) is the external potential at any
Proceeding in the same way, we can
point P having position vector r , then by
write the electrostatic potential
energy of a
definition, work done in bringing a unit positive
system of N point charges at r1 , r2 ....rN as charge from ∞ to the point P is equal to V.
1 q j qk ∴ Work done in bringing a charge q, from ∞
U
4 0 all pairs rjk to the given
point in the external field
Example 8.11: Calculate the is qV ( r ).
electrostatic potential energy This work is stored in the form of potential
of the system of charges energy of a system of charge q.
shown in the figure. ∴PE of a system of a single charge q at r in
Solution : Taking zero of potential energy at an external field is given by
∞, we get potential energy (PE) of the system PE qV r --- (8.17)
of charges (d) Potential energy of a system of two
1 q j qk
PE = ∑ charges in an external field:
4π 0 rjk
In order to find the potential energy of
1 q q q q q q a system of two charges q1 and q2 located at
4 0 r r r r1 and r2 respectively in an external field, we
q q q q q q calculate the work done in bringing the charge
q1 from ∞ to r1.
r r 2 r 2
From (8.17),in the said process work done
1 q2 q2 q2 q2 q2 q2 = q1V ( r ) --- (8.18)
1
197
∴Work done on q2 against the external field
r = 16 cm = 0.16 m
= q2 V ( r2 ) and Work done on q2 against the a) Electrostatic potential energy of the
q1 q2
field due to q1 = , system of two charges is
4 0 r12 1 q1q2
where r12 = distance between q1and q2. V =
4π 0 r
By the Principle of superposition for 9 109 2 10 6 4 10 6
fields, we add up the work done on q2 against =
0.16
the two fields. = 0.45 J
∴ Work done in bringing q2 to r2 b) In the electric field, total potential energy
qq
q q (PE) = 1 2 + q1 V ( r1 ) + q2 V ( r2 )
q2 V r2 1 2 --- (8.19)
4π 0 r
4 0 r12
−dV A A
Thus from (8.18) and (8.19) potential E= ∴ V = Edr = 2 dr ,V =
energy of the system dr r r
q1q2
= Total work done in assembling the Aq1 Aq2
∴ Total PE = + +
configuration 4π 0 r r1 r2
q q
= q1 V r1 + q2 V r2 + 1 2
4 0 r12 = -0.45+
8 10 6
5 2 10 +
0.08
Example 8.12: Two charged particles
8 10 6
5 4 10
having equal charge of 3 ×10-5 C each are
brought from infinity to a separation of 0.08
30 cm. Find the increase in electrostatic = -0.45 -20 + 40
potential energy during the process. = 19.55 J
Solution : Taking the potential energy (PE) (e) Potential energy of a dipole in an external
at ∞ to be zero, field:
Increase in PE = present PE
q1q2 9 109 ( 310 5 ) 2
V= =
4π 0 r 0.3
10
9 9 10 10
9
81
= 1 = = 27 J
310 3
Example 8.13: Fig. 8.17 : Couple acting on a dipole.
a) Determine the electrostatic potential Consider a dipole with charges -q and
energy of a system consisting of two +q separated by a finite distance 2 , placed
charges -2 µC and +4 µC (with no external in a uniform electric field E . It experiences a
field) placed at (-8 cm, 0, 0) and (+8 cm, 0, torque τ which tends to rotate it.
0) respectively. τ = p × E or pE sin
b) Suppose the same system of charges is torque, let us
In order to neutralize this
now placed in an external electric field assume an external torque τ ext is applied,
E = A (1/r2), where A = 8 × 105 cm-2, what which rotates it in the plane of the paper
would be the electrostatic potential energy from angle θ 0 to angle θ , without angular
of the configuration acceleration and at an infinitesimal angular
Solution: Given : speed. Work done by the external torque
q1 = -2 µC = -2 × 10-6 C, r1= 0.08 cm
W ext d pE sin d
q2= +4 µC = +4 × 10-6 C, r2 = 0.08 cm
0 0
198
8.7 Conductors and Insulators, Free Charges
pE - cos and Bound Charges Inside a Conductor:
pE - cos - - cos 0 a) Conductors and Insulators:
When you come in contact with wires in
pE - cos cos 0 wet condition or while opening the window of
pE cos 0 - cos your car, you might have experienced a feeling
of electric shock. Why don’t you get similar
This work done is stored as the potential
experiences with wooden materials?
energy of the system in the position when the
The reason you get a shock is that
dipole makes an angle θ with the electric
there occurs a flow of electrons from one body
field. The zero potential energy can be chosen
to another when they come in contact via
as per convenience. We can choose U ( θ 0 )
rubbing or moving against each other. Shock
= 0, giving
is basically a wild feeling of current passing
U U 0 pE cos 0 - cos
through your body.
a) If initially the dipole is perpendicular to the Conductors are materials or substances
field E i.e., 0 then which allow electricity to flow through them.
2
U pE cos - cos
2 This is because they contain a large number
of free charge carriers (free electrons). In a
- pE cos metal the outer (valence) electrons are loosely
U - p. E bound to the nucleus and are thus free for
conductivity, when an external electric field is
b) If initially the dipole is parallel to the field
applied.
E then 0 0
U pE cos 0 - cos Metals, humans, earth and animal bodies
U pE 1 - cos are all conductors. The main reason we get
electric shocks is that being a good conductor
Example 8.14: An electric dipole consists our human body allows a resistance free path
of two opposite charges each of magnitude for the current to flow from the wire to our
1µC separated by 2 cm. The dipole is placed body.
in an external electric field of 105 N C-1. Under electrostatic conditions the conductors
Find: have following properties.
(i) The maximum torque exerted by the 1. In the interior of a conductor, net
field on the dipole electrostatic field is zero.
(ii) The work the external agent will have 2. Potential is constant within and on the
to do in turning the dipole through 180° surface of a conductor.
starting from the position θ = 0° 3. In static situation, the interior of a
Solution: Given : conductor can have no charge.
p = q × 2ℓ = 10-6 × 2 × 10-2 = 2 × 10-8 cm 4. Electric field just outside a charged
E = 105 NC-1 conductor is perpendicular to the surface
(i) τmax = p E sin 90°= 2 × 10-8 × 105 × 1 of the conductor at every point.
= 2 × 10-3 Nm 5. Surface charge density of a conductor
(ii) W = pE ( cos θ1 − cos θ 2 ) could be different at different points.
= 2 × 10-8 × 105 × (cos 0- cos 180°)
= 2 × 10-3 ( 1 + 1 ) = 4 × 10-3 J
199
Electrostatic shielding : In insulators, the electrons are tightly
• To protect a delicate instrument from bound to the nucleus and are thus not available
the disturbing effects of other charged for conductivity and hence are poor conductors
bodies near it, place the instrument of electricity. There are no free charges since
inside a hollow conductor where E = 0. all the charges are bound to the nucleus. An
This is called electrostatic shielding. insulating material can be considered as a
• Thin metal foils are used in making the collection of molecules that are not easily
shields. ionized. An insulator can carry any distribution
• During lightning and thunder storm it is of external electric charges on its surface or in
always advisable to stay inside the car its interior and the electric field in the interior
than near a tree in open ground, since can have non zero values unlike conductors.
the car acts as a shield. 8.8 Dielectrics and Electric Polarisation:
Dielectrics are insulates which can be
Faraday Cages:
used to store electrical energy. This is because
• It is an enclosure which is used to block
when such substances are placed in an external
the external electric fields in conductive
field, their positive and negative charges
materials. get displaced in opposite directions and the
• Electro-magnetic shielding: MRI molecules develop a net dipole moment. This
scanning rooms are built in such a is called polarization of the material and such
manner that they prevent the mixing materials are called dielectrics.
of the external radio frequency signals In every atom there is a positively
with the MRI machine. charged nucleus and there are negatively
charged electrons surrounding it. The negative
b) Free charges and Bound charges inside
charges form an electron cloud around the
materials:
positive charge. These two oppositely charged
The electrical behaviour of conductors
regions have their own centres of charge
and insulators can be understood on the basis (where the effective charge is located). The
of free and bound charges. centre of negative charge is the centre of
In metallic conductors, the electrons in mass of negatively charged electrons and that
the outermost shells of the atoms are loosely of positive charge is the centre of mass of
bound to the nucleus and hence can easily get positively charged protons in the nucleus.
detached and move freely inside the metal. Thus, dielectrics are insulating materials
When an external electric field is applied, they or non- conducting substances which can be
drift in a direction opposite to the direction of polarised through small localised displacement
the applied electric field. These charges are of charges. e.g. glass, wax, water, wood , mica,
called free charges. rubber, stone, plastic etc.
The nucleus, which consist of the positive Dielectrics can be classified as polar
ions and the electrons of the inner shells, dielectrics and non polar dielectrics as
described below.
remain held in their fixed positions. These
Polar dielectrics:
immobile charges are called bound charges.
A molecule in which the centre of mass
In electrolytic conductors, positive and
of positive charges (protons) does not coincide
negative ions act as charge carriers but their with the centre of mass of negative charges
movements are restricted by the electrostatic (electrons), because of the asymmetric shape
force between them and the external electric of the molecules is called polar molecule as
field. shown in Fig. 8.18 (a). They have permanent
200
dipole moments of the order of 10-30 Cm. They Polarization of a non-polar dielectric in an
act as tiny electric dipoles, as the charges are external electric field:
separated by a small distance. The dielectrics In the presence of an external electric
like HCℓ, water, alcohol, NH3 etc are made of field Eo, the centres of the positive charge
polar molecules and are called polar dielectrics. in each molecule of a non-polar dielectric is
Water molecule has a bent shape with its two pulled in the direction of Eo, while the centres
O - H bonds which are inclined at an angle of of the negative charges are displaced in the
about 105°. It has a very high dipole moment opposite direction. Therefore, the two centres
of 6.1 × 10-30 Cm. Fig. 8.18 (b) and (c) show are separated and the molecule gets distorted.
the structure of HCl and H2O, respectively. The displacement of the charges stops when
the force exerted on them by the external field
is balanced by the restoring force between the
(a)
charges in the molecule.
Each molecule becomes a tiny dipole
Fig. 8.18. (a) A polar molecule. having a dipole moment. The induced dipole
moments of different molecules add up giving
a net dipole moment to the dielectric in the
presence of the external field.
(b) (c)
Fig. 8.18. Examples of Polar molecules
(b) HCI (c) H2O.
Non Polar dielectrics:
A molecule in which the centre of mass of
the positive charges coincides with the centre
of mass of the negative charges is called a non Fig. 8.20 (a) Shows the non polar dielectric in
absence of electric field while.
polar molecule as shown in Fig. 8.19 (a). These
have symmetrical shapes and have zero dipole
moment in the normal state. The dielectrics
like hydrogen, nitrogen, oxygen, CO2, benzene,
methane are made up of nonpolar molecules
and are called non polar dielectrics. Structures
of H2 and CO2 are shown in Fig. 8.19 (b) and
(c), respectively.
210
Construction: filled with nitrogen at high pressure. A small
Fig. 8.33 shows the schematic diagram of quantity of Freon gas is mixed with nitrogen to
Van de Graaff generator. ensure better insulation between the vessel S
and its contents. A metal plate M held opposite
to the brush A on the other side of the belt is
connected to the vessel S, which is earthed.
Working: The electric motor connected to the
pulley P1 is switched on, which begins to rotate
setting the conveyor belt into motion. The DC
supply is then switched on. From the pointed
ends of the spray brush A, positive charge is
continuously sprayed on the belt B. The belt
carries this charge in the upward direction,
which is collected by the collector brush C and
sent to the dome shaped conductor.
As the dome is hollow, the charge is
Fig. 8.33: Schematic diagram of van de Graff distributed over the outer surface of the dome.
generator. Its potential rises to a very high value due to
P1 P2 = Pulleys the continuous accumulation of charges on it.
BB = Conveyer belt The potential of the electrode I also rises to
A = Spray brush this high value.
C = Collector brush The positive ions such as protons or
D = Dome shaped hollow conductor deuterons from a small vessel (not shown in
E = Evacuated accelerating tube the figure) containing ionised hydrogen or
I = Ion source deuterium are then introduced in the upper part
P = DC power supply
of the evacuated accelerator tube. These ions,
S = Steel vessel filled with nitrogen
repelled by the electrode I, are accelerated in
M = Earthed metal plate
the downward direction due to the very high
An endless conveyor belt BB made of an fall of potential along the tube, these ions
insulating material such as reinforced rubber acquire very high energy. These high energy
or silk, can move over two pulleys P1 and charged particles are then directed so as to
P2. The belt is kept continuously moving by strike a desired target.
a motor (not shown in the figure) driving the Uses: The main use of Van de Graff generator
lower pulley (P1). is to produce very high energy charged particles
The spray brush A, consisting of a large having energies of the order of 10 MeV. Such
number of pointed wires, is connected to the high energy particles are used
positive terminal of a high voltage DC power 1. to carry out the disintegration of nuclei of
supply. From this brush positive charge can different elements,
be sprayed on the belt which can be collected 2. to produce radioactive isotopes,
by another similar brush C. This brush is 3. to study the nuclear structure,
connected to a large, dome-shaped, hollow 4. to study different types of nuclear reactions,
metallic conductor D, which is mounted on 5. accelerating electrons to sterilize food and
insulating pillars (not shown in the figure). E to process materials.
is an evacuated accelerating tube having an
electrode I at its upper end, connected to the Internet my friend
dome-shaped conductor.
To prevent the leakage of charge from 1. https://en.m.wikipedia.org
the dome, the pulley and belt arrangement, 2. hyperphyrics.phy-astr.gsu.edu
the dome and a part of the evacuated tube 3. https://www.britannica.com/science
are enclosed inside a large steel vessel S, 4. https://www.khanacademy.org>in-i
211
Exercises
A
(B) C 0 2 k
d k 3
A 0 k 3
(C) C
d 2 k
A 4 k
(D) C 0
d k 3
iii) Energy stored in a capacitor and ii) If the difference between the radii of the
dissipated during charging a capacitor two spheres of a spherical capacitor is
bear a ratio. increased, state whether the capacitance
(A) 1:1 (B) 1:2 will increase or decrease.
(C) 2:1 (D) 1:3 iii) A metal plate is introduced between
iv) Charge +q and -q are placed at points the plates of a charged parallel plate
A and B respectively which are distance capacitor. What is its effect on the
2L apart. C is the mid point of A and B. capacitance of the capacitor?
The work done in moving a charge +Q iv) The safest way to protect yourself from
along the semicircle CRD as shown in lightening is to be inside a car. Justify.
the figure below is v) A spherical shell of radius b with charge
Q is expanded to a radius a. Find the
work done by the electrical forces in the
process.
3. A dipole with its charges, -q and +q
located at the points (0, -b, 0) and (0 +b,
0) is present in a uniform electric field E.
qQ qQ The equipotential surfaces of this field
(A) (B) are planes parallel to the YZ planes.
6 0 L 2 0 L
212
(a) What is the direction of the electric in which all the dipoles are perpendicular
field E? (b) How much torque would the to the field, θ2 = 90°.[Ans: 1.575 × 10-3 J]
dipole experience in this field? 11. A charge 6 µC is placed at the origin
4. Three charges -q, +Q and -q are placed and another charge –5 µC is placed on
at equal distance on straight line. If the the y axis at a position A (0, 6.0) m.
potential energy of the system of the
three charges is zero, then what is the
ratio of Q:q?
5. A capacitor has some dielectric between
its plates and the capacitor is connected
to a DC source. The battery is now
disconnected and then the dielectric is
removed. State whether the capacitance,
the energy stored in it, the electric field, a) Calculate the total electric potential
charge stored and voltage will increase, at the point P whose coordinates are
decrease or remain constant. (8.0, 0) m
6. Find the ratio of the potential differences b) Calculate the work done to bring
that must be applied across the parallel a proton from infinity to the point
and series combination of two capacitors P ? What is the significance of the
C1 and C2 with their capacitances in the negative sign ?
ratio 1:2, so that the energy stored in [Ans: (a) Vp = 2.25 × 103 V
these two cases becomes the same. (b) W = -5.4 × 10-16 J]
7. Two charges of magnitudes -4Q and 12. In a parallel plate capacitor with air
+2Q are located at points (2a, 0) and (5a, between the plates, each plate has an
0) respectively. What is the electric flux area of 6 × 10–3 m2 and the separation
due to these charges through a sphere of between the plates is 2 mm. a) Calculate
radius 4a with its centre at the origin? the capacitance of the capacitor, b) If this
8. A 6 µF capacitor is charged by a 300
capacitor is connected to 100 V supply,
V supply. It is then disconnected
what would be the charge on each plate?
from the supply and is connected to
c) How would charge on the plates be
another uncharged 3µF capacitor. How
affected if a 2 mm thick mica sheet of
much electrostatic energy of the first
capacitor is lost in the form of heat and k = 6 is inserted between the plates while
electromagnetic radiation ? the voltage supply remains connected ?
[Ans: 9 × 10-2 J] [Ans: (a) 2.655 × 10-11 F,
9. One hundred twenty five small liquid (b) 2.655 × 10-9 C, (c) 15.93 × 10-9 C]
drops, each carrying a charge of 13. Find the equivalent capacitance between
0.5 µC and each of diameter 0.1 m form P and Q. Given, area of each plate = A
a bigger drop. Calculate the potential at and separation between plates = d.
the surface of the bigger drop. 2 Aε 0 4 Aε 0
[Ans: (a) (b) ]
[Ans: 2.25 × 106 V] d d
10. The dipole moment of a water molecule
is 6.3 × 10–30 Cm. A sample of water
contains 1021 molecules, whose dipole
moments are all oriented in an electric
field of strength 2.5 × 105 N /C. Calculate
the work to be done to rotate the dipoles
from their initial orientation θ1 = 0 to one
213
9. Current Electricity
215
Example 9.2: Two batteries of 7 volt and
13 volt and internal resistances 1 ohm and 2
ohm respectively are connected in parallel
with a resistance of 12 ohm. Find the
current through each branch of the circuit
and the potential difference across 12-ohm
resistance.
Solutions: Let the currents passing through
the two batteries be I1 and I2. Applying Kirchhoff second law,
Applying Kirchhoff second law to the (i) loop EFCDE,
loop AEFBA, 3 I 2 4 I1 10 0
4 I1 3 I 2 10 --- (2)
(ii) loop FABCF
4 I 3 3 I 2 5 0
4 I 3 3 I 2 5 --- (3)
From Eq. (1) and Eq. (2)
4 I 3 I 2 3 I 2 = 10
3 I 4 I 4 I 10
2 3 2
4 I 3 7 I 2 10 --- (4)
12 I1 I 2 1I1 7 0 From Eq. (3) and Eq. (4)
10 I 2 5
12 I1 I 2 1I1 7 --- (1) I 2 0.5 A
For the loop CEFDC
Negative sign indicates that I 2 current
12 I1 I 2 2 I 2 13 0
flows from F to C
12 I1 I 2 2 I 2 13 --- (2)
From Eq. (2) 4 I1 3 0.5 10
From (1) and (2) 2 I 2 I1 13 7 6 I1 = 2.12 A
I1 2 I 2 6
Substituting I1 value in (2) ∴ I 3 I1 I 2 2.12 0.5 1.62 A
85 9.3 Wheatstone Bridge:
I=
2 = 2.237 A
38 Resistance of a material changes due to
I1 2 I 2 6 several factors such as temperature, strain,
85 humidity, displacement, liquid level, etc.
I1 2 6 1.526 A
38 Therefore, measurement of these properties
I I1 I 2 1.526 A 2.237 A 0.711A is possible by measuring the resistance.
Potential difference across 12 Ω resistance Measurable values of resistance vary from
V IR 0.711 12 8.53V
a few milliohms to hundreds of mega ohms.
Example 9.3: For the given network, find Depending upon the resistance range (milliohm
the current through 4 ohm and 3 ohm. to tens of ohm, tens of ohm to hundreds of ohms,
Assume that the cells have negligible hundreds of ohm to mega ohm, etc.), various
internal resistance. methods are used for resistance measurement.
Solution: Applying Kirchhoff first law Wheatstone’s bridge is generally used to
At junction F, measure resistances in the range from tens of
I1 = I 3 – I 2 I1 I 2 I 3 --- (1) ohm to hundreds of ohms.
216
The Wheatstone Bridge was originally A special case occurs when the current
developed by Charles Wheatstone (1802- 1875) passing through the galvanometer is zero. In
to measure the values of unknown resistances. this case, the bridge is said to be balanced.
It is also used for calibrating measuring Condition for the balance is Ig = 0. This
instruments, voltmeters, ammeters, etc. condition can be obtained by adjusting the
Four resistances P, Q, R and S are values of P, Q, R and S. Substituting Ig = 0 in
connected to form a quadrilateral ABCD as Eq. (9.4) and Eq. (9.5) we get,
shown in the Fig. 9.4. A battery of emf ε along – I1P + I2S = 0 ∴ I1P = I2S --- (9.6)
with a key is connected between the points A – I1Q + I2R = 0 ∴ I1Q = I2R --- (9.7)
and C such that point A is at higher potential Dividing Eq. (9.6) by Eq. (9.7), we get
P S
with respect to the point C. A galvanometer = --- (9.8)
of internal resistance G is connected between Q R
points B and D. This is the condition for balancing the
When the key is closed, current I flows Wheatstone bridge.
through the circuit. It divides into I1 and I2 at If any three resistances in the bridge are
point A. I1 is the current through P and I2 is the known, the fourth resistance can be determined
current through S. The current I1 gets divided at by using Eq. (9.8).
point B. Let Ig be the current flowing through Example 9.4: At what value should the
the galvanometer. The currents flowing variable resistor be set such that the bridge
through Q and R are respectively (I1 – Ig) and is balanced? If the source voltage is 30 V
(I1 + Ig), find the value of the output voltage across
From the Fig. 9.4, XY, when the bridge is balanced.
I = I1 + I2 --- (9.3)
Consider the loop ABDA. Applying
Kirchhoff’s voltage law in the clockwise sense
shown in the loop we get,
– I1P – IgG + I2S = 0 --- (9.4)
X Y
Now consider loop BCDB, applying
Kirchhoff’s voltage law in the clockwise sense
shown in the loop we get,
– (I1 – Ig) Q + (I2 + Ig) R + Ig G = 0 --- (9.5) When the bridge is balanced
P/Q=R/S
Q = PS / R
1.36 103 4.4 103
19.94 103
300
Total resistance of the arm
ADC = 19940 + 4400 = 24340 Ω
To find output voltage across XY:
Potential difference across
AC = I1 24340 30
Fig. 9.4 : Wheatstone bridge.
30
From these three equations (Eq. (9.3), I1 = A
24340
(9.4), (9.5) we can find the current flowing
Potential difference across
through any branch of the circuit.
217
Temporary contact with the wire AB can be
AD = I1 × 19940 established with the help of the jockey. A cell
30 19940 / 24340 24.58 V of emf ε along with a key and a rheostat are
30 30 connected between the points A and B.
I2 A
1360 300 1660 A suitable resistance R is selected from
So, Potential difference across resistance box. The jockey is brought in contact
30
AB= I 2 1360 1360 24.58 V with AB at various points on the wire AB and
1660
the balance point (null point), D, is obtained.
Vout VB VD
The galvanometer shows no deflection when
VA VB VA VD the jockey is at the balance point.
VAB VAD Let the respective lengths of the wire
= 24.58-24.58 = 0V between A and D, and that between D and C
be x and R . Then using the conditions for
Application of Wheatstone bridge:
the balance, we get
Figure 9.4 is a basic circuit diagram of X RAD
Wheatstone bridge, however, in practice =
R RDB
the circuit is used in different manner. In all
where RAD and RDB are resistance of the parts
cases it is used to determine some unknown
AD and DB of the wire resistance of the wire. If
resistance. Few applications of Wheatstone
l is length of the wire, ρ its specific resistance,
bridge circuits are discussed in the following
and A its area of cross section then
article.
9.3.1 Metre Bridge:
RAD AD RDB DB
A A
X RAD x / A
=
R RDC R / A
X x
∴ =
R R
Therefore, X = x R --- (9.9)
R
Knowing R, x and R , the value of the
unknown resistance can be determined.
Fig. 9.5: Metre bridge. Example 9.5: Two resistances 2 ohm and 3
Metre bridge (Fig. 9.5) consists of a ohm are connected across the two gaps of the
wire of uniform cross section and one metre metre bridge as shown in figure. Calculate
in length, stretched on a metre scale which is the current through the cell when the bridge
fixed on a wooden table. The ends of the wire is balanced and the specific resistance of the
are fixed below two L shaped metallic strips.
material of the metre bridge wire. Given the
A single metallic strip separates the two L
resistance of the bridge wire is 1.49 ohm and
shaped strips leaving two gaps, left gap and
its diameter is 0.12 cm.
right gap. Usually, an unknown resistance X is
Solution: When the bridge is balanced, the
connected in the left gap and a resistance box
resistances 2 and 3 ohm are in series and the
is connected in the other gap. One terminal of
total resistance is 5 ohm.
a galvanometer is connected to the terminal C
Let R1 be the resistance of the wire =1.49
on the central strip, while the other terminal
Ω, and R2 be the total resistance (2+3)=5 Ω
of the galvanometer carries the jockey (J).
218
detect whether there is a current
through the central branch. This is
possible only by tapping the jokey.
Applications:
• The Wheatstone bridge is used for
measuring the values of very low resistance
precisely.
• We can also measure the quantities such
R1 R2 1.49 5 as galvanometer resistance, capacitance,
R p 1.15
R1 R2 1.49 5 inductance and impedance using a
The current through the cell Wheatstone bridge.
2 Do you know?
= 1.74 A
R p 1.15
R r 2 Wheatstone bridge along with operational
Specific resistance of the wire
l amplifier is used to measure the physical
l 1m, r 0.12 0.06 cm , R 1.49
2 parameters like temperature, strain, etc.
2
2
R r 2 1.49 3.14 0.06 10
Observe and discuss
l 1
6
1.68 10 m 1. Kelvin’s method to determine the
resistance of galvanometer (G) by using
Remember this meter bridge.
Source of errors.
1. The cross section of the wire may not
be uniform.
2. The ends of the wire are soldered to the
metallic strip where contact resistance The galvanometer whose resistance (G) is
is developed, which is not taken into to be determined is connected in one gap
account. and a known resistance (R) in the other gap.
3. The measurements of x and R may Working :
not be accurate. 1. A suitable resistance is taken in the
To minimize the errors resistance box. The current is sent
(i) The value of R is so adjusted that the round the circuit by closing the key.
null point is obtained to middle one Without touching the jockey at any
third of the wire (between 34 cm and point of the wire, the deflection in the
66 cm) so that percentage error in galvanometer is observed.
the measurement of x and R are 2. The rheostat is adjusted to get a suitable
minimum and nearly the same. deflection Around (2/3)rd of range.
(ii) The experiment is repeated by 3. Now, the jockey is tapped at different
interchanging the positions of unknown points of the wire and a point of contact
resistance X and known resistance box D for which, the galvanometer shows
R. no change in the deflection, is found.
(iii) The jockey should be tapped on the 4. As the galvanometer shows the same
wire and not slided. We use jockey to deflection with or without contact
219
between the point B and D, these two The resistances in the arms P and Q
points must be equipotential points. are fixed to desired ratio. The resistance
5. The length of the bridge wire between in the arm R is adjusted so that the
the point D and the left end of the galvanometer shows no deflection. Now the
wire is measured. Let lg be the length bridge is balanced. The unknown resistance
of the segment of wire opposite to the X = RQ / P , where P and Q are the fixed
galvanometer and lr be the length of resistances in the ratio arms and R is an
the segment opposite to the resistance adjustable known resistance.
box. If L is the length of the wire and r is
Calculation : its radius then the specific resistance of the
Let RAD and RDC be the resistance of material of the wire is given by
the two parts of the wire AD and DC
X r2
respectively. Since bridge is balanced
L
G R AD
=
R R DC
Do you know?
R lg G l
AD g
R DC lr R lr Wheatstone Bridge for Strain
G lg Measurement:
Strain gauges are commonly used
R 100 - lg {lg + lr = 100 cm}
for measuring the strain. Their electrical
lg resistance is proportional to the strain in
G R
100 - l the device. In practice, the range of strain
g
gauge resistance is from 30 ohms to 3000
Using this formula, the unknown resistance ohms. For a given strain, the resistance
of the galvanometer can be calculated. change may be only a fraction of full range.
2. Post Office Box
Therefore, to measure small resistance
A post office box (PO Box) is a
changes with high accuracy, Wheatstone
practical form of Wheatstone bridge as
bridge configuration is used. The figure
shown in the figure.
below shows the Wheatstone bridge where
the unknown resistor is replaced with a
strain gauge as shown in the figure.
220
Therefore, the potential difference per unit
finally positioned such that the voltmeter
length of the wire is,
will indicate zero deflection, i.e., the bridge VAB R
is balanced. The strain at this condition =
L L( R r )
represents the zero of the gauge. V
As long as ε remains constant, AB will
If the strain gauge is either stretched V L
or compressed, then the resistance changes. remain constant. AB is known as potential
L
This causes unbalancing of the bridge. This gradient along AB and is denoted by K.
produces a voltage indication on voltmeter Potential gradient can be defined as potential
which corresponds to the strain change. If difference per unit length of wire.
the strain applied on a strain gauge is more,
then the voltage difference across the meter
terminals is more. If the strain is zero, then
the bridge balances and meter shows zero
reading.
This is the application of precise
resistance measurement using a Wheatstone
Fig. 9.6: Potentiometer.
bridge. Consider a point C on the wire at distance
9.4 Potentiometer: from the point A, as shown in the figure.
A voltmeter is a device which is used for The potential difference between A and C is
measuring potential difference between two VAC. Therefore,
points in a circuit. An ideal voltmeter which VAC = K i.e. VAC ∝
does not change the potential difference to be Thus, the potential difference between two
measured, should have infinite resistance so points on the wire is directly proportional to
that it does not draw any current. Practically, the length of the wire between them provided
a voltmeter cannot be designed to have an the wire is of uniform cross section, the current
infinite resistance. Potentiometer is one such through the wire is the same and temperature
device which does not draw any current from of the wire remains constant. Uses of
the circuit. It acts as an ideal voltmeter. It is potentiometer are discussed below.
used for accurate measurement of potential 9.4.2 Use of Potentiometer:
difference. A) To Compare emf. of Cells
9.4.1 Potentiometer Principle:
A potentiometer consists of a long wire AB
of length L and resistance R having uniform
cross sectional area A. (Fig. 9.6) A cell of emf
ε having internal resistance r is connected
across AB as shown in the Fig. 9.6. When the
circuit is switched on, current I passes through
the wire.
Fig. 9.7: Emf comparison by
Current through AB, I =
Rr individual method.
Potential difference across AB is
Method I : A potentiometer circuit is set up
VAB = I R
R by connecting a battery of emf ε , with a key
VAB = K and a rheostat such that point A is at higher
(R r)
221
potential than point B. The cells whose emfs When two cells are connected so that
are to be compared are connected with their their negative terminals are together or their
positive terminals at point A and negative positive terminals are connected together as
terminals to the extreme terminals of a two- shown in Fig. 9.8 (b).
way key K1K2. The central terminal of the two In this case their emf oppose each other
ways key is connected to a galvanometer. The and effective emf of the combination of two
other end of the galvanometer is connected to cells is ε 1 – ε 2 ( ε 1 > ε 2 assumed). This method
a jockey (J). (Fig. 9.7) Key K is closed and of connecting two cells is called the difference
then, key K1 is closed and key K2 is kept open. method. Remember that this combination of
Therefore, the cell of emf ε1 comes into circuit. cells is not a parallel combination of cells.
The null point is obtained by touching the
jockey at various points on the potentiometer
wire AB. Let 1 be the length of the wire
between the null point and the point A. 1 Fig. 9.8 (a):Sum method.
corresponds to emf ε 1 of the cell. Therefore,
ε1 = K 1
where K is the potential gradient along the
potentiometer wire.
Now key K1 is kept open and key K2 is
Fig. 9.8 (b): Difference method.
closed. The cell of emf ε 2 now comes in the
Circuit is connected as shown in Fig.9.9.
circuit. Again, the null point is obtained with
When keys K1 and K3 are closed the cells ε 1
the help of the Jockey. Let 2 be the length of
and ε 2 are in the sum mode. The null point
the wire between the null point and the point
is obtained using the jockey. Let 1 be the
A. This length corresponds to the emf ε 2 of
length of the wire between the null point
the cell.
and the point A. This corresponds to the emf
∴ ε2 = K 2
( ε 1 + ε 2 ).
From the above two equations we get
∴ ε1 + ε 2 = k 1
1 1
--- (9.10) Now the key K1 and K3 are kept open and
2 2 keys K2 and K4 are closed. In this case the two
Thus, we can compare the emfs of the two
cells are in the difference mode. Again the null
cells. If any one of the emfs is known, the
point is obtained. Let 2 be the length of the
other can be determined.
wire between the null point and the point A.
Method II: The emfs of cells can be compared
This corresponds to ε 1 - ε 2
also by another method called sum and
∴ ε1 - ε 2 = 2
difference method.
When two cells are connected so that the
positive terminal of the first cell is connected
to the negative terminal of the second cell
as shown in Fig 9.8 (a). The emf of the two
cells are added up and the effective emf of
the combination of two cells is ε 1 + ε 2 . This
method of connecting two cells is called the
sum method. Fig. 9.9: Emf comparison, sum and difference
method.
222
From the above two equations, The length of the wire 2 between the
1 2 1 null point and point A is measured. This
1 2 2 corresponds to the voltage between the null
By componendo and dividendo method, we point and point A.
get, k
1 1 2 ∴ V = k 2 ∴ 1 1 1
--- (9.11) V k 2 2
2 1 2 Consider the loop PQSTP.
ε 1 = IR + Ir and
Thus, emf of two cells can be compared.
B) To Find Internal Resistance (r) of a Cell: V = IR
The experimental set up for this method ∴ 1 IR Ir R r 1
V IR R 2
consists of a potentiometer wire AB connected
in series with a cell of emf ε , the key K1, and ∴ r R 1 1 --- (9.12)
rheostat as shown in Fig. 9.10. The terminal A 2
is at higher potential than terminal B. A cell This equation gives the internal resistance of
of emf ε1 whose internal resistance r1 is to be the cell.
determined is connected to the potentiometer C) Application of potentiometer:
wire through a galvanometer G and the jockey The applications of potentiometer
J. A resistance box R is connected across the discussed above are used in laboratory. Some
cell ε 1 through the key K2. practical applications of potentiometer are
given below.
1) Voltage Divider: The potentiometer can
be used as a voltage divider to continuously
change the output voltage of a voltage supply
(Fig. 9.11). As shown in the Fig. 9.11,
potential V is set up between points A and B
of a potentiometer wire. One end of a device is
connected to positive point A and the other end
is connected to a slider that can move along
wire AB. The voltage V divides in proportion
Fig. 9.10 : Internal resistance of a cell. of lengths l1 and l2 as shown in the figure 9.11.
The key K1 is closed and K2 is open. The
circuit now consists of the cell ε , cell ε 1 , and
the potentiometer wire. The null point is then
obtained. Let 1 be length of the potentiometer
wire between the null point and the point A.
This length corresponds to emf ε 1 .
∴ ε 1 = k 1 where k is potential gradient of the
potentiometer wire which is constant. Fig. 9.11 :
Now both the keys K1 and K2 are closed so Potentiometer as
that the circuit consists of the cell ε , the cell a voltage divider.
ε 1 , the resistance box, the galvanometer and 2) Audio Control: Sliding potentiometers, are
the jockey. Some resistance R is selected from commonly used in modern low-power audio
the resistance box and null point is obtained. systems as audio control devices. Both sliding
223
(faders) and rotary potentiometers (knobs) difference of the order 10–6 volt can
are regularly used for frequency attenuation, be measured with it. Least count of a
loudness control and for controlling different potentiometer is much better compared to
characteristics of audio signals. that of a voltmeter.
3) Potentiometer as a senor: If the slider of Demerits:
a potentiometer is connected to the moving Potentiometer is not portable and direct
part of a machine, it can work as a motion measurement of potential difference or emf is
not possible.
sensor. A small displacement of the moving
9.5 Galvanometer:
part causes changes in potential which is
A galvanometer is a device used to detect
further amplified using an amplifier circuit.
weak electric currents in a circuit. It has a
The potential difference is calibrated in terms coil pivoted (or suspended) between concave
of the displacement of the moving part. pole faces of a strong laminated horse shoe
Example 9.7: In an experiment to magnet. When an electric current passes
determine the internal resistance of a cell through the coil, it deflects. The deflection is
of emf 1.5 V, the balance point in the open proportional to the current passing through the
cell condition at is 76.3 cm. When a resistor coil. The deflection of the coil can be read with
of 9.5 ohm is used in the external circuit of the help of a pointer attached to it. Position
of the pointer on the scale provided indicates
the cell the balance point shifts to 64.8 cm
the current passing through the galvanometer
of the potentiometer wire. Determine the
or the potential difference across it. Thus, a
internal resistance of the cell.
galvanometer can be used as an ammeter or
Solution: Open cell balancing length voltmeter with suitable modification. The
l1= 76.3 cm galvanometer coil has a moderate resistance
Closed circuit balancing length (about 100 ohms) and the galvanometer itself
l2 = 64.8 cm External resistance R = 9.5 Ω has a small current carrying capacity (about
l l 1 mA).
Internal resistance r 1 2 R
l2
76.3 64.8
9.5
64.8
1.686
9.4.3 Advantages of a Potentiometer Over
a Voltmeter:
Merits:
i) Potentiometer is more sensitive than a
voltmeter.
Fig. 9.12 Internal structure of galvanometer.
ii) A potentiometer can be used to measure
a potential difference as well as an emf 9.5.1 Galvanometer as an Ammeter:
of a cell. A voltmeter always measures Let the full scale deflection current and
terminal potential difference, and as it the resistance of the coil G of moving coil
draws some current, it cannot be used to galvanometer (MCG ) be Is and G. It can be
measure an emf of a cell. converted into an ammeter, which is a current
iii) Measurement of potential difference or measuring instrument. It is always connected
emf is very accurate in the case of a in series with a resistance R through which the
potentiometer. A very small potential current is to be measured.
224
To convert a moving coil galvanometer ∴ GIg = S (I – Ig)
(MCG ) into an ammeter Ig
S
I I
To convert an MCG into an ammeter, the G --- (9.13)
modifications necessary are g
Equation 9.13 is useful to calculate the
1. Its effective current capacity must be range of current that the galvanometer can
increased to the desired higher value. measure.
2. Its effective resistance must be decreased. (i) If the current I is n times current Ig, then
The finite resistance G of the galvanometer I = n Ig. Using this in the above expression we
when connected in series, decreases the get GI g G
current through the resistance R which is S OR S
actually to be measured. In ideal case, an nI I
g g
n 1
ammeter should have zero resistance. This is the required shunt to increase the range
3. It must be protected from the possible n times.
damages, which are likely due to the (ii) Also if Is is the current through the shunt
passage of an excess electric current to be resistance, then the remaining current (I – Is)
passed. will flow through galvanometer. Hence
In practice this is achieved by connecting G (I – Is) = S Is
a low resistance in parallel with the i.e. G I – G Is = S Is
galvanometer, which effectively reduces i.e. S Is + G Is = GI
the resistance of the galvanometer. This low I s G
resistance connected in parallel is called shunt I S G
(S). This arrangement is shown in Fig. 9.13. This equation gives the fraction of the
Uses of the shunt: total current through the shunt resistance.
a. It is used to divert a large part of total Example 9.8: A galvanometer has a
current by providing an alternate path resistance of 100 Ω and its full scale
and thus it protects the instrument from deflection current is 100 µ A. What shunt
damage. resistance should be added so that the
b. It increases the range of an ammeter. ammeter can have a range of 0 to 10 mA ?
c. It decreases the resistance between the Solution: Given IG = 100 µ A = 0.1 mA
points to which it is connected. The upper limit gives the maximum current
The shunt resistance is calculated as to be measured, which is I = 10 mA .
follows. In the arrangement shown in the figure, The galvanometer resistance is G = 100 Ω.
Ig is the current through the galvanometer. Now
Therefore, the current through S is 10 G 100 10 0
n 100 s
(I – Ig) = Is 0.1 n 1 100 1 99
Example 9.9: What is the value of the shunt
resistance that allows 20% of the main
current through a galvanometer of 99 Ω?
Solution: Given
G = 99 Ω and IG =(20/100)I = 0.2 I
Now
Fig. 9.13 Ammeter. I G 0.2 I 99 0.2 99
S G 24.75
Since S and G are parallel, I I G I 0.2 I 0.8
∴ GIg = S Is
225
9.5.2 Galvanometer as a Voltmeter: where Ig is the current flowing through the
A voltmeter is an instrument used to galvanometer.
measure potential difference between two Eq. (9.14) gives the value of resistance X.
points in an electrical circuit. It is always V V
If nV is the factor by which
connected in parallel with the component Vg ( I g G )
across which voltage drop is to be measured. the voltage range is increased, it can be shown
A galvanometer can be used for this purpose. that X = G (nv-1)
To Convert a Moving Coil Galvanometer
into a Voltmeter. Example 9.10: A Galvanometer has a
To convert an MCG into a Voltmeter the
resistance of 25 Ω and its full scale deflection
modifications necessary are:
current is 25 µA. What resistance should be
1. Its voltage measuring capacity must be
added to it to have a range of 0 -10 V?
increased to the desired higher value.
Solution: Given G = 25 µA.
2. Its effective resistance must be increased,
and Maximum voltage to be measured is
3. It must be protected from the possible V =10 V.
damages, which are likely due to excess The Galvanometer resistance G = 25 Ω.
applied potential difference. The resistance to be added in series,
V 10
All these requirements can be fulfilled, if X G 25
we connect a resistance of suitable high value IG 25 10 6
(X) in series with the given MCG. 399.975 103
A voltmeter is connected across the points Example 9.11: A Galvanometer has a
where potential difference is to be measured. If resistance of 40 Ω and a current of 4 mA is
a galvanometer is used to measure voltage, it needed for a full scale deflection . What is
draws some current (due to its low resistance), the resistance and how is it to be connected
therefore, actual potential difference to be to convert the galvanometer (a) into an
measured decreases. To avoid this, a voltmeter
ammeter of 0.4 A range and (b) into a
should have very high resistance. Ideally, it
voltmeter of 0.5 V range?
should have infinite resistance.
Solution: Given G = 40 Ω and IG = 4 mA
(a) To convert the galvanometer into an
ammeter of range 0.4 A,
I IG S IGG
0.4 0.004 S 0.004 40
0.004 40 0.16
S 0.4040
Fig. 9.14 : Voltmeter. 0.396 0.396
A very high resistance X is connected in
series with the galvanometer for this purpose as (b)To convert the galvanometer into a
shown in Fig. 9.14. The value of the resistance voltmeter of range of 0.5 V
V I G G X
X can be calculated as follows.
0.5 0.004 40 X
If V is the voltage to be measured, then
0.5
V = Ig X + Ig G. X 40 85
∴ Ig X = V – Ig G 0.004
V
X G , --- (9.14)
Ig
226
Comparison of an ammeter and a voltmeter:
227
Exercises
229
10. Magnetic Fields due to Electric Current
230
I
is stationary, v =0, the
(ii) If the charge
force = 0, even if B ≠ 0.
From Eq. (10.4) it may be observed that
the force on the charge due to electric field
depends on the strength of the electric field
and the magnitude of the charge. However, the
magnetic force depends on the velocity of the
Fig. 10.2: Right Fig. 10.3: Force on wire charge and the cross product of the velocity
hand thumb rule. 2 due to current in wire 1. vector v the magnetic field vector B , and the
How can one account for the force on charge q.
the neighbouring current carrying wire? The Consider the vectors v and
Bwith certain
magnetic field due to current in the wire 1 at angle between them. Then v × B will be a
any point on wire 2 is directed into the plane
vector perpendicular
to the plane containing
the vectors v and B (Fig. 10.4).
of the paper. The electrons flow in a direction
opposite to the conventional current. Then the
wire 2 experiences a force F towards wire 1.
10.2 Magnetic Force:
From the above discussion and Fig. 10.3,
you
must have realized that the directions of
v , B and F follow a vector cross product
relationship. Actually the magnetic force Fm Fig. 10.4: The cross product is in the direction
of
on an electron with a charge -e, moving with the unit vector perpendicular to both v and B .
velocity
v in a
magnetic
field B is Thus the vectors v and F are always
F m = -e( v × B ) --- (10.1) perpendicular to each other. Hence. F . v =0,
In general for a charge q, the magnetic for any magnetic field B . Magnetic force F m
forcewill be is thus perpendicular to the displacement and
F m = q( v × B ) --- (10.2) hence the magnetic force never does any work
Ifboth electric field E and the magnetic on moving charges.
field B are present, the net The magnetic forces may change the
force on charge q
direction of motion of a charged particle but
v in
moving withthe velocity
they can never affect the speed.
F = q[ E +( v × B )] --- (10.3)
Interestingly, Eq. (10.2) leads to the
= q E +q( v × B ) = F e + F m --- (10.4) definition
of B . From Eq. (10.2),
units of
Justification for this law can be found in F = q | v × B | = qvB sin θ , --- (10.5)
experiments such as the one described in Fig. where θ is the angle between v and B
10.1 (a) and (b). The force described in Fig. and is unit vector in the direction of force .
(10.4) is known as Lorentz force. Here F e is If the force F is 1 N acting on the
the force due to electric field and F m is the charge of 1 C moving with a speed of 1m s
-1
233
1 qB F m = v/ / × B =v.B sin (0°) = 0 --- (10.11)
fc --- (10.9)
T 2 m Thus, v / / will not be affected and the
The frequency of the applied voltage (fa) particle will move along the direction of B .
between the two Ds is adjusted so that polarity At the same time the perpendicular component
of the two Ds is reversed as the ion arrives at of the velocity ( v ⊥) leads to circular motion
the gap after completing one semi circle. This as stated above. As aresult, the particle moves
condition fa = fc is the resonance condition. parallel to the field B while moving along a
The ions do not experience any electric
circular path perpendicular to B . Thus the
field while they travel within the D. Their
path becomes a helix (Fig. 10.7).
kinetic energy increases by eV every time they
cross over from one D to the other. Here V is
Do you know?
the voltage difference across the gap. The ions
move in circular path with successively larger Particle accelerators are important
and larger radius to a maximum radius at for a variety of research purposes. Large
which they are deflected by a magnetic field so accelerators are used in particle research.
that they can be extracted through an exit slit. There have been several accelerators
From Eq. (10.7), in India since 1953. The Department of
qBRexit , Atomic Energy (DAE), Govt. of India, had
v=
m taken initiative in setting up accelerators
where Rexit is the radius of the path at the for research. Apart from ion accelerators,
exit. the DAE has developed and commissioned
The kinetic energy of the ions/ protons a 2 GeV electron accelerator which is a
will be radiation source for research in science. This
accelerator, 'Synchrotron', is fully functional
1 q 2 B 2 Rexit
2
K.E. = mv2 = --- (10.10) at Raja Ramanna Centre for Advanced
2 2m Technology, Indore. An electron accelerator,
Thus the final energy is proportional to the
Microtron with electron energy 8-10 MeV
square of the radius of the outermost circular
is functioning at Physics Department,
path (Rexit).
Savitribai Phule Pune University, Pune.
10.4 Helical Motion:
So far it has been assumed that the charged Internet my friend
particle moves in a plane perpendicular to
magnetic field B . If such a particle has
(i) Existing and upcoming particle
some component of velocity parallel to B, accelerators in India http://www.
( v / / ) then itleads to helical motion. Since a researchgate.net
component v / / is parallel to B , the magnetic
(ii)
Search the internet for particle
accelerators and get more information.
force F m will be:
z 10.5 Magnetic Force on a Wire Carrying a
y
Current:
We have seen earlier the Lorentz force
law (Eq. (10.4)). From this equation, we can
B obtain the force on a current carrying wire.
x (i) Straight wire:
Consider a straight wire of length L as
Fig. 10.7: Helical Motion of a charged
particle shown
in Fig. 10.8. An external magnetic field
in a magnetic field B . B is applied perpendicular to the wire, coming
234
out of the plane of the paper. Let a current extended to a wire of arbitrary shape as shown
I flow through the wire under an applied in Fig. 10.9.
I
potential difference. If v d is the drift velocity
of conduction electrons in the part of length
L of the wire, the charge q flowing across the
plane pp in time t will be
q=It
IL Fm
q= --- (10.12)
vd Fig. 10.9: Wire with arbitrary shape.
Consider a segment of infinitesimal length
L dl along the wire. If I in the current flowing,
using Eq. (10.14), the magnetic force due to
perpendicular magnetic field B (coming out
I Fm of the plane
of the
paper)
is given by
e Vd d F m = I d l × B --- (10.15)
The force on the total length of wire is
thus
F m d F m I dl B
Fig. 10.8 Electrons in the wire having drift --- (10.16)
If B is uniform over the whole wire,
velocity v d experience a magnetic force F m
upwards as the applied magnetic field lines F m I dl B
come out of the plane of the paper. --- (10.17)
Example 10.2: A particle of charge q
The magnetic force F m on this charge,
follows a trajectory as shown in the figure.
according to Eq. (10.2), due to the applied Obtain the type of the charge (positive or
magnetic field B is given by
negatively charged). Obtain the momentum
Fm q ( v d B )
p of the particle in terms of B, L, s, q, s being
IL
B v d sin n the distance travelled by the particle.
vd Particle trajectory: A uniform magnetic
IL. B.sin 90n , field B is applied in the region pp,
where is perpendicular to the plane of the paper,
a unit vector perpendicular
to
both B and v d , in the direction of F m coming out of the plane of the paper.
F m = ILB --- (10.13)
This is, therefore, the magnetic force
acting on the portion of the straight wire
having length L.
If B is not perpendicular to the wire, then
the above Eq. (10.13)
takes the form
F m = I L× B , --- (10.14)
where L is the length vector directed
along the portion of the wire of length L.
Solution: B is coming out of the paper.
(ii) Arbitrarily shaped wire:
Since the particle moves upwards, there
In the previous section we considered
must be a force in that direction. The
a straight wire. Equation (10.14) can be
velocity is in the positive x direction.
235
∴ v × B is in -ve y direction. As the force in upward direction. Calculate the current
is in +y direction, i.e., opposite, the charge I in the loop for which the magnetic force
must be negative. According to Eq (10.5), would be exactly balanced by the force on
Force = Bqv in the y direction. mass m due to gravity.
Bqv Solution: The current I in the loop with
∴ acceleration = ,
m its part in the magnetic field B causes an
where m is the mass of the particle. upward force Fm in the horizontal part of
Using Newton’s equation of motion, the the loop, given by
distance travelled in the y direction is given Fm = IBa,
by where a is the length of one arm of the
1
s = ut + a t2 loop.
2
1 Bqv This force is balanced by the force due
= 0 + 2 m t2 as the initial to gravity.
velocity in the y direction is zero. But in the ∴ Fm = I Ba = mg
same time t, the particle travels the distance mg
∴ I=
L along the x direction, with uniform Ba
For this current, the wire loop will
velocity v .
hang in air.
∴ L = v.t
1 BqL2
∴s=
2 mv 1 Bq 2
∴ momentum p = mv = L
2 s a
10.6 Force on a Closed Circuit in a Magnetic
Field B :
Equation (10.17) can be extended to a closed
wire circuit
C
F m I dl B --- (10.18)
C 10.7 Torque on a Current Loop:
Here, the integral It will be very interesting to apply the
is over the closed circuit C.
For uniform B , results of the above sections to a current
carrying loop of a wire. You have learnt about
F m I dl B an electric motor in Xth Std. An electric motor
--- (10.19)
C works on the principle you have studied in the
The term in the bracket in Eq. (10.19) is the preceding sections, i.e., the magnetic force on
sum of vectors along a closed circuit. Hence it a current carrying wire due to a magnetic field.
must be zero.
Figure 10.10 shows a current carrying loop
∴ F m = 0 ( B uniform) --- (10.20) (abcd) in a uniform magnetic field.There will,
Example 10.3: Consider a square loop of therefore, be the magnetic forces F m acting in
wire loaded with a glass bulb of mass m opposite directions on the segments of the loop
hanging vertically, suspended in air with ab and cd. This results into rotation of the loop
its one part in a uniform magnetic field B about its central axis.
with its direction coming out of the plane of Without going into the details of contact
the paper (). Due to the current I flowing carbon brushes and external circuit, we can
through the loop, there is a magnetic force visualize the rotating action of a motor.
236
Fm Fm
Fm (90- )
l2 B
238
θ being an angle between
µ (i.e., ) and B. Example 10.4: A circular coil of conducting
∴ τ = µ ×B --- (10.26) wire has 500 turns and an area 1.26×10-4 m2
You have learnt in XI Std. about the torque on
th
is enclosed by the coil. A current 100 µA
an electric dipole exerted by an electric field, is passed through the coil. Calculate the
E. magnetic moment of the coil.
∴ τ = P × E --- (10.27) Solution:
Here P is the electric dipole moment. µ = NIA
The two expression Eq. (10.26) and Eq. (10.27) = 500 × 100 × 10-6 × 1.26 × 10-4 Am2
are analogous to each other. = 630 × 10-8 = 6.3 × 10-6 Am2 or J/T.
10.10 Magnetic Field due to a Current :
Biot-Savart Law:
In sections 10.1 and 10.2, we have seen
µ B µ B that magnetic field is produced by a current
Case (i) Case (ii) carrying wire. Can we calculate this magnetic
Fig. 10.14: Minimum and maximum magnetic
field?
of a magnetic dipole µ in a
potential energy
magnetic field B .
I
10.9 Magnetic Potential Energy of a Dipole: dl
A magnetic dipole freely suspended in a I r dB
magnetic field possesses magnetic potential
energy because of its orientation in the field.
You have learnt about an electric dipole
in Chapter 8. Electrical Potential energy is Figure 10.15: A current carrying wire of
associated with an electric dipole on account arbitrary shape, carrying a current I. The current
in the differential length element
dl produces
of its orientation in an electric field. It has been
shown that magnetic field d B at a point P at a
differential
the potential energy U of an electric
dipole P in an
electric field
E is given by r from the element dl. The indicates
distance
U = - P . E --- (10.28) that d B is directed into the plane of the paper.
Analogously, the magnetic potential Figure 10.15 shows an arbitrarily shaped
energy of a magnetic dipole µ in a magnetic wire carrying a current I. dl is a length element
field B is given along the wire. The current in this element is
by
U = - µ . B --- (10.29) in the direction of the length vector dl . Let
= - µB.cos θ , us calculate the differential field d B at the
--- (10.30)
where θ is the angle between µ and B . point P, produced by the current I through the
Case (i) : If θ = 0, U = - µ B.cos(0°) = - µB length element dl. Net magnetic field at the
This is the minimum potential energy of a point P can be obtained
by superimposition
magnetic dipole in a magnetic field i.e., when of magnetic fields d B at that point due to
 and  are parallel to each other. different length elements along the wire. This
Case (ii) : If  = 180°, U = - µ.B.cos (180°) can be done by integrating
i.e., summing up
= µB. of magnetic fields d B from these length
This is the maximum potential energy elements.
Experimentally, the magnetic fields
of a magnetic dipole in a magnetic field, i.e., d B produced by current I in the length element
when  and  are antiparallel to each other. d l is
239
Idl sin
dB 0 --- (10.31) Here, the direction
of d B is given by the
4 r2 cross product d l × r (see Eq. (10.34)), hence
Here, θ is the angle between the directions
into the plane of the paper.
of dl and r . µ0 is called permeability constant (a) We now calculate the magnitude of
given by the magnetic field produced at P by all
µ0 = 4π × 10-7 T. m/A --- (10.32) current length elements in the upper half
≈ 1.26 × 10 T. m/A
-6
--- (10.33) of the infinitely long wire. This we do by
of d B is dictated by the
The direction
integrating Eq. (10.35) from o to ∞.
cross product dl × r. Vectorially, (b) Let us now calculate the magnitude of the
Idl r
dB 0 --- (10.24) magnetic field produced at P by a current
4 r 3 length element in the lower half of the
Equation (10.31) and Eq. (10.34) are wire. By symmetry, this magnitude is the
known as the Biot and Savart law. This inverse same as that from the upper half of the
square law is experimentally deduced. It may
wire. The direction of this field is also the
be noted
that this is still inverse square law
same as from the upper half of the wire,
as r appears in the numerator and r3 in the
going into the plane of the paper.
denominator. Using the Biot-Savart law, we
Adding both the contributions (a) and (b),
can calculate the magnetic field produced by
the total magnetic field B at point P is
various distributions of currents as discussed
below: Idl sin
(i) Current in a straight, long wire: B 2 dB 2 0 --- (10.36)
0
4 0
r2
You are aware of the right hand thumb
rule which gives the direction of the magnetic But r l R 2 2
0 dl --- (10.52)
I 2
4 (z R )2
R
I I The direction of d B is perpendicular to
the plane formed by d l and r . Its z component
is dBz and the component perpendicular to
10.13: Axial Magnetic Field Produced by the z-axis is dB⊥. The components dB⊥ when
Current in a Circular Loop: summed over, yield zero as they cancel out
Here we shall obtain the magnetic field, due to symmetry. This can be easily seen from
due to current in a circular loop, at different the diametrically opposite element d l giving
points along its axis. We assume that the dB⊥ opposite to that due to d l . Hence, only z
current is steady. component remains.
z
dB ∴ The net contribution along the z axis is
dB
dB obtained by integrating dBz = dB cos θ over
the entire loop.
From Fig. 10.19,
r R R
z cos
r z2 R2
0 dl
dl Bz dBz I 2 cos
4 (z R 2 )
R
0 Rdl
I 2
i dl y 4 (z R 2 )3/ 2
x
IR
Fig. 10.19: Magnetic field on the axis of a 0 2 R
circular current loop of radius R. 4 (z R 2 )3/ 2
2
245
consider a longstraight wire carrying a current Example 10.7: A coaxial cable consists of
I (Fig. 10.23). B and d l are tangential to the
a central conducting core wire of radius a
Amperian loop
which is a circle here. and a coaxial cylindrical outer conductor
∴ B .d l = B dl = B.rd θ
of radius b (see figure). The two conductors
The field B at a distance r from the wire
carry an equal current I in opposite directions
is given by
I in and out of the plane of the paper. What
B 0 --- (10.61)
2
r will be the magnitude of the magnetic field
2
I
B dl 0 rd 0 I --- (10.62) B for (i) a < r <b and (ii) b<r ? What will be
c 0
2 r
its direction?
This is in agreement with the Ampere's Solution: By symmetry,
b
law. Equation (10.61) shows that the magnetic r B will be tangent to
field B of an infinitely long wire is proportional r a any circle centred on
to the current I but inversely proportional to the central conductor.
the distance from the wire, as seen earlier. In order to apply the
1. Choose the correct option. in the figure. Then it will follow the
i) A conductor has 3 segments; two straight following path. [The magnetic field is
and of length L each and a semicircular directed into the paper].
with radius R. It carries a current I. What
is the magnetic field B at point P?
0 I I
(A) (B) 0 2 (A) It will continue to move along positive x
4 R 4 R axis.
µ I I
(C) 0 (C) 0 (B) It will move along a curved path, bending
4 R 4 towards positive x axis.
ii) Figure a, b show two Amperian loops
(C) It will move along a curved path, bending
associated with the conductors carrying
towards negative y axis.
current I in the sense shown. The ∫ B.dl (D) It will move along a sinusoidal path along
in the cases a and b will be, respectively, the positive x axis.
(iv) A conducting thick copper rod of length
(b)
(a) 1 m carries a current of 15 A and is
located on the Earth's equator. There
the magnetic flux lines of the Earth's
(A) - µ0I, 0 (B) µ0I, 0 magnetic field are horizontal, with the
(C) 0, µ0I (D) 0, - µ0I field of 1.3 × 10-4 T, south to north. The
iii) A proton enters a perpendicular uniform magnitude and direction of the force on
magnetic field B at origin along the the rod, when it is oriented so that current
positive x axis with a velocity v as shown flows from west to east, are
248
(A) 14 × 10-4 N, downward. uniform magnetic field of 1.88 T, and
(B) 20 × 10-4 N, downward. traces a circular path of radius 24.6 cm.
(C) 14 × 10-4 N, upward. Obtain the mass of the alpha particle.
(D) 20 × 10-4 N, upward. [l eV = 1.6 × 10-19 J, charge of electron =
1.6 × 10-19 C]
v) A charged particle is in motion having [Ans: 6.62 × 10-27 kg]
initial velocity v when it enter into
6. Two wires shown in the figure are
a region of uniform magnetic field
connected in a series circuit and the
perpendicular to v . Because of the same amount of current of 10 A passes
magnetic force the kinetic energy of the
through both, but in apposite directions.
particle will Separation between the two wires is 8
(A) remain uncharged. mm. The length AB is S = 22 cm. Obtain
(B) get reduced. the direction and magnitude of the
(C) increase. magnetic field due to current in wire 2 on
(D) be reduced to zero. the section AB of wire 1. Also obtain the
2. A piece of straight wire has mass 20 g magnitude and direction of the force on
and length 1m. It is to be levitated using wire 1. [µ0 = 4π × 10-7 T.m/A]
a current of 1 A flowing through it and
a perpendicular magnetic field B in a
horizontal direction. What must be the
magnetic of B?
250
11. Magnetic Materials
254
resultant magnetic moment. Inner orbits are
Do you know? completely filled and hence do not contribute
to the total magnetic moment of the atom.
Effective magneton numbers for iron group
ions (No. of Bohr magnetons) Observe and discuss
Ion Configuration Effective magnetic
moment in terms of Let us see whether the given atom has
Bohr magneton (B.M) paired electron or unpaired electrons in the
(Expreimental values) outermost orbit. We will follow three steps-
3+ 5
Fe 3d 5.9 1) Write electronic configuration
2+
Fe 3d 6
5.4 2) Draw valence orbital
2+
Co 3d 7
4.8 3) Identify if unpaired electron exist
N 2+
3d 8
3.2 Ex. Chlorine Cl ( it has total 17 electrons)
(Courtsey: Introduction to solid state physics 1) electronic configuration 1s2 2s2 2p6 3s2
by Charles Kittel, pg. 306 ) 3p5
These magnetic moments are calculated 2) ignoring inner completely filled orbitals
from the experimental value of magnetic and just considering valence electrons.
susceptibility. In several ions the magnetic
moment is due to both orbital and spin
angular momenta.
As stated earlier, apart from the orbital 3s 3p
motion, electron spin also contributes to the 3) There is one unpaired electron.
resultant magnetic moment of an atom. Vector In a similar manner study Fe, Zn, He, B, Ni
sum of these two moments is the total magnetic and draw your conclusions.
moment of the atom. 11.4 Magnetization and Magnetic Intensity:
In the earlier section you have seen that
Do you know? atoms with unpaired electrons have a net
Two possible orientations of spin magnetic dipole moment. The bulk material
is made up of a large number of such atoms
angular momentum ( s ) of an electron in
each having an inherent magnetic moment.
an external magnetic field. Note that the
The magnetic dipole moments are randomly
spin magnetic dipole oriented and hence the net dipole moment of
many of the bulk materials is zero. For some
moment is in a direction
materials (such as Fe3O4), the vector addition
opposite to that of the
of all these magnetic dipole moments may not
angular momentum.
be zero. Such materials have a net magnetic
moment. The ratio of magnetic moment to the
You have studied Pauli's exclusion volume of the material is called magnetization .
principle. According to it, no two electrons can M = mnet / volume --- (11.12)
have the same set of quantum numbers viz. n, M is vector quantity having dimension
l, m1 and ms defining a state. Therefore, the [L-1 A and SI units A m-1].
resultant magnetic dipole moment for these Consider a rod of such a material with
atoms with a pair of electrons in the same some net magnetization, placed in a solenoid
state, defined by n, l and ml, will be zero as with n turns per unit length, and carrying
discussed in the box below. current I. Magnetic field inside the solenoid is
The atoms with odd number of electrons given by
in their outermost orbit will possess nonzero
255
B0 0 n I Here µ is magnetic permeability of the
material analogous to ε in electrostatics and
Let us denote the magnetic field due to the
µr is the relative magnetic permeability of the
material kept inside the solenoid by Bm .
substance.
Thus, the net magnetic field inside the rod
Permeability and Permittivity:
can be expressed as
B B0 Bm --- (11.13) Magnetic Permeability is a term analogous
It has been observed that Bm is proportional to to permittivity in electrostatics. It basically
magnetisation M of the material tells us about the number of magnetic
lines of force that are passing through
Bm 0 M ,
a given substance when it is kept in an
where µ0 is permeability of free space.
external magnetic field. The number is the
∴ B 0 n I 0 M --- (11.14) indicator of the behaviour of the material
Here we will introduce one more quantity in magnetic field. For superconductors
called magnetic field intensity H, where χ = - 1. If you substitute in the Eq. (11.18),
H = nI. The noticeable difference between it is observed that permeability of material
the expression for B and H is that H does not µ = 0. This means no magnetic lines will
depend on the material rod which is placed pass through the superconductor.
inside the solenoid. Magnetic Susceptibility (χ) is the
B 0 H 0 M indicator of measure of the response of
B 0 H M --- (11.15) a given material to the external applied
B magnetic field. In other words it indicates
∴ H M --- (11.16) as to how much magnetization will be
0
From the above expression we conclude produced in a given substance when kept
that H and M have the same unit i.e., ampere in an external magnetic field. Again it is
per metre. and also have the same dimensions. analogous to electrical susceptibility. This
Thus the magnetic field induced in the material means when the substance is kept in a
(B) depends on H and M. Further it is observed magnetic field, the atomic dipole moments
that if H is not too strong the magnetization M either align or oppose the external
induced in the material is proportional to the magnetic field. If the atomic dipole
magnetic intensity. moments of the substance are opposing
M H , --- (11.17) the field, χ is observed to be negative,
where χ is called Magnetic Susceptibility. It and if the atomic dipole moments align
is a measure of the magnetic behaviour of the themselves in the direction of field,
material in external applied magnetic field. χ χ is observed to be positive. The number of
is the ratio of two quantities with the same units atomic dipole moments of getting aligned in
(Am-1). Hence it is a dimensionless constant. the direction of the applied magnetic field
From Eq. (11.15) and Eq. (11.17) we get is proportional to χ. It is large for soft iron
B 0 H H
(χ >1000).
B 0 1 H
B 0 r H Example 11.2: The region inside a current
--- (11.18)
r 1 carrying toroid winding is filled with
Aluminium having susceptibility χ = 2.3
B H
× 10-5. What is the percentage increase
0 r
in the magnetic field in the presence of
0 1 --- (11.19)
256
Aluminium over that without it? Types of material χ
Solution: The magnetic field inside the Diamagnetic -10 -3
-10-5
solenoid without Aluminium B0 = µ0 H Paramagnetic 0 10-3
The magnetic field inside the solenoid Ferromagnetic 102 103
with Aluminium B = µ H 11.5.1 Diamagnetism:
B B0 0 In the earlier section it is discussed that
B0 0 atoms/molecules with completely filled
0 1 electron orbit possess no net magnetic
dipole moment. Such materials behave as
1 diamagnetic materials. When these materials
0
0 are placed in external magnetic field they
move from the stronger part of magnetic field
0
B B0 0 to the weaker part of magnetic field. Unlike
therefore
B0 0 magnets attracting magnetic material, these
Percentage increase in the magnetic field materials are repelled by a magnet.
after inserting Aluminium is The simplest explanation for
B B0 diamagnetism could be given using paired
100 2.310 5 100 0.0023% electron orbit. As discussed earlier, the net
B0
magnetic moment of such atoms is zero. When
Table 11.1: Magnetic susceptibility of some the orbiting electron or current loop is brought
materials
in external magnetic field, the field induces a
Diamagnetic χ Paramagnetic χ current as per Lenz’s law (refer to Chapter 12)
Substance Substance as shown in Fig. 11.5. The direction of induced
Silicon -4.2×10-6 Aluminium 2.3×10-5 current Ii, is such that the direction of magnetic
Bismuth -1.66×10-5 Calcium 1.9×10-5 field created by the current is opposite to the
Copper -9.8×10-6 Choromium 2.7×10-4 direction of applied external magnetic field.
Diamond -2.2×10-5 Lithium 2.1×10-5 Out of the pair of orbits, for one loop where the
Gold -3.6×10-5 Magnesium 1.2×10-5 direction of induced current is the same as that
Lead -1.7×10-5 Niobium 2.6×10-5 of loop current will find increase in current I,
Mercury -2.9×10-5 Oxygen 2.1×10-6 (Fig. 11.5 (b)) resulting in increase in magnetic
(STP) dipole moment. For the current loop where
Nitrogen -5.0×10-9 Platinum 2.9×10-4 the direction of induced current is opposite to
11.5 Magnetic Properties of Materials: direction of loop current, (Fig. 11.5 (a)) the
The behaviour of a material in presence net current is reduced, effectively reducing
the magnetic dipole moment. This results in
of external magnetic field classifies materials
net magnetic dipole moment opposite to the
broadly into diamagnetic, paramagnetic
direction of applied external magnetic field.
and ferromagnetic materials. Magnetic
susceptibility for diamagnetic material is
negative and for paramagnetic positive
but small. For ferromagnetic materials it is
positive and large.
Table 11.2: Range of magnetic susceptibility of (a) (b)
diamagnetic, paramagnetic and ferromagnetic Fig. 11.5 The clockwise and anticlockwise
materials motion of electron brought in a magnetic field.
257
Examples of diamagnetic materials are
copper, gold metal, bismuth and many metals, Try this
lead, silicon, glass, water, wood, plastics etc.
Diamagnetic property is present in all materials. Take a bar magnet (available in your
In some, it is weaker than other properties such laboratory), a small glass test tube with a
as paramagnetism or ferromagnetism which cork partially filled with water and fixed on
the piece of such a material say wood (float)
mask the diamagnetism.
that this system can float on water, . Let the
test tube and the float be kept floating in a
water bath or some plastic tray contining
water available in the laboratory. Bring the
pole of the bar magnet near the water filled
glass tube. Note your observation. Repeat
Fig. 11.6: Diamagnetic substance in uniform
the experiment without water filled in the
magnetic field.
test tube. Record your observation and draw
When diamagnetic material is placed conclusions.
in an external magnetic field, the induced
magnetic field inside the material repels the Do you know?
magnetic lines of forces resulting in reduction
When superconductors (χ = - 1) are placed
in magnetic field inside the material (See Fig. in an external magnetic field, the field lines
11.6). Similarly when diamagnetic material are completely expelled. The phenomenon
is placed in non uniform magnetic field, it of perfect diamagnetism in superconductor
moves from stronger to weaker part of the is called Meissner effect. If a good electrical
field. If a diamagnetic liquid is filled in a conductor is kept in a magnetic field, the
field lines do penetrate the surface region
U tube and one arm of the U tube is placed to a certain extent.
in an external magnetic field, the liquid is
pushed in the arm which is outside the field. 11.5.2 Paramagnetism:
In general, these materials try to move to a In the earlier section you have studied that
atoms/molecules having unpaired electrons
place of weaker magnetic field. If a rod of
possess a net magnetic dipole moment. As
diamagnetic material is suspended freely in the
these dipole moments are randomly oriented,
magnetic field it aligns itself in the direction
the resultant magnetic dipole moment of the
perpendicular to the direction of external
material is, however, zero.
magnetic field. This is because there is a torque
acting on induced dipole. As studied earlier,
when the dipole is in a direction opposite to
the direction of magnetic field it has a large
(a) (b) (c)
magnetic potential energy and so is unstable.
Fig. 11.7 : Paramagnetic substance (a) No external
It will try to go into a position where the Magnetic Field (b) Weak external magnetic
magnetic potential energy is least and that is Field (c) Strong external Magnetic Field.
when the rod is perpendicular to the direction As seen from Fig. 11.7 (a) and (b), each
of magnetic field. The magnetic susceptibility atom/molecule of a paramagnetic material
of diamagnetic material is negative. possesses net magnetic dipole moment, but
because of thermal agitation these are randomly
258
ariented. Due to this the net magnetic dipole H
moment of the material is zero in absence of M C 0
T
an external magnetic field. M
When such materials are placed in C 0
H T
sufficiently strong external magnetic field at
low temperature (to reduce thermal excitation) r 1 C 0 --- (11.21)
T
(Fig. 11.7 (c)), most of the magnetic dipoles 1
align themselves in the direction of the applied
T
field (to align in the direction corresponding to
Thus when we increase the applied
less potential energy). The field lines get closer
magnetic field and reduce the temperature,
inside such a material (see Fig. 11.8).
more number of magnetic moments align
themselves in the direction of magnetic field
resulting in increase in Magnetization.
What does the area inside the curve B - H 11.8 Magnetic Shielding:
(hysteresis curve) indicate? When a soft ferromagnetic material is
11.7 Permanent Magnet and Electromagnet: kept in a uniform magnetic field, large number
Soft iron having large permeability of magnetic lines crowd up inside the material
(>1000) and small amount of retaining leaving a few outside. If we have a closed
magnetization, is used to make electromagnets. structure of this material, say a spherical shell
For this purpose, a soft iron rod (or that of of iron kept in magnetic field, very few lines
a soft ferromagnetic material) is placed in a of force pass through the enclosed space. Most
solenoid core. On passing current through the of the lines will be crowded into the iron shell
solenoid, the magnetic field associated with (Fig. 11.12). This effect is known as magnetic
solenoid increases thousand folds. When the shielding. The instrument which need to be
current through the solenoid is switched off, the protected from magnetic field is completely
associated magnetic field effectively becomes surrounded by a soft ferromagnetic substance.
zero. These electromagnets are used in electric This technique is being used in space ships.
bells, loud speakers, circuit breakers, and also Some scientific experiments require the
in research laboratories. Giant electromagnets experiment to be protected from magnetic field
are used in cranes to lift heavy loads made in the laboratory. There, high magnetic fields
of iron. Superconducting magnets are used to of magnets need to be shielded by providing a
prepare very high magnetic fields of the order case made up of soft ferromagnetic material.
of a few tesla. Such magnets are used in NMR
262
Do you know?
Exercises
263
4. A rod of magnetic material of cross 9. A short bar magnet is placed in an external
section 0.25 cm2 is located in 4000 Am-1 magnetic field of 700 guass. When its axis
magnetising field. Magnetic flux passing makes an angle of 30° with the external
through the rod is 25 × 10-6 Wb. Find out magnetic field, it experiences a torque of
(a) relative permeability (b) magnetic 0.014 Nm. Find the magnetic moment of
susceptibility and (c) magnetisation of the the magnet, and the work done in moving
rod it from its most stable to most unstable
[Ans: 199, 198 and 7.92 × 105 Am-1] position.
5. The work done for rotating a magnet with [Ans: 0.4 A m2 , 0.048 J]
magnetic dipole moment m, through 90° from 10. A magnetic needle is suspended freely so
its magnetic meridian is n times the work that it can rotate freely in the magnetic
done to rotate it through 60°. Find the meridian. In order to keep it in the
value of n. horizontal position, a weight of 0.2 g is
[Ans: 2] kept on one end of the needle. If the pole
6. An electron in an atom is revolving round the strength of this needle is 20 Am , find the
nucleus in a circular orbit of radius 5.3 × 10-11 value of the vertical component of the
m, with a speed of 2 × 106 ms -1. Find the earth's magnetic field. (g = 9.8 m s-2)
resultant orbital magnetic moment and [Ans: 4.9 × 10-5 T]
angular momentum of electron. (charge 11. The susceptibility of a paramagnetic
on electron e = 1.6 × 10-19 C, mass of material is χ at 27° C. At what temperature
electron m = 9.1 × 10-31 kg.) its susceptibility be χ/3 ?
[Ans: 8.48 × 10-24 Am2, 9.65 × 10-35 N m s] [Ans: 627° C]
7. A paramagnetic gas has 2.0 × 1026 atoms/m
with atomic magnetic dipole moment
of 1.5 × 10-23 A m2 each. The gas is at 27°
C. (a) Find the maximum magnetization
intensity of this sample. (b) If the gas in
this problem is kept in a uniform magnetic
field of 3 T, is it possible to achieve
saturation magnetization? Why?
[Ans: 3.0 × 103 A m-1, No]
(Hint: Find the ratio of Thermal energy of
atom of a gas ( 3/2 kBT) and maximum
potential energy of the atom (mB) and
draw your conclusion)
8. A magnetic needle placed in uniform
magnetic field has magnetic moment of
2 × 10-2 A m2, and moment of inertia of
7.2 × 10-7 kg m2. It performs 10 complete
oscillations in 6 s. What is the magnitude
of the magnetic field ?
[Ans: 39.48 × 10-4 Wb/m2]
264
12. Electromagnetic Induction
266
12.3 Lenz's Law: clockwise direction as shown in Fig. 12.3.
H.F.E. Lenz (1804-1864) without If the magnet is pulled away from the
knowledge of the work of Michael Faraday loop, a current will again be induced in the
and Joseph Henry duplicated many of their loop in such a way that the loop will have a
discoveries independently almost at the same south pole facing the retreating north pole and
time. will oppose the retreat by attracting it. The
For determining the direction of an induced current in the loop will now flow in
induced current in a loop, Lenz devised a clockwise direction.
rule, which goes by his name as Lenz's Law.
Jumping Ring Experiment: A coil is
According to this rule, the direction of induced
wound around an iron core which is held
current in a circuit is such that the magnetic vertically upright. A metallic ring is placed
field produced by the induced current opposes on top of the iron core. A current is then
the change in the magnetic flux that induces switched on to pass through the coil. This
the current. The direction of induced emf is will make the ring jump several meters in
same as that of induced current. In short, the air.
induced emf tends to set up a current the action Explanation: Before the current in the coil
of which opposes the change that causes it. is turned on, the magnetic flux through the
Applications of Lenz's law: ring is zero. Afterwards, the flux appears in
12.3.1 Motion of a Magnet Toward a Loop: the coil in upward direction. This change
In order to get a feel for Lenz's law, let in flux causes an induced emf and induced
us consider a north pole of a magnet moving current as well in the ring. The direction of
toward a conducting loop as shown in the Fig. induced current in the ring will be opposite
to the direction of current in the coil, as
12.3.
dictated by Lenz’s law. As the opposite
currents repel, the ring flies off in air.
12.3.2 Energy Conservation in Lenz's Law:
We have learnt that the cause of the
induced current may be either (i) the motion
of a conductor (wire) in a magnetic field or
(ii) the change of magnetic flux through a
stationary circuit.
Fig. 12.3: Magnet's motion creates a magnetic In the first case, the direction of induced
dipole in the coil. current in the moving conductor (wire) is
As the magnet is moved toward the loop, such that the direction of the thrust exerted on
a current is induced in the loop. The induced the conductor (wire) by the magnetic field is
current in the loop produces a magnetic dipole. opposite to the direction of its motion and thus
The dipole is oriented in such a way that it opposes the motion of the conductor.
opposes the motion of the magnet. Thus the In the second case, the current sets up a
loop's north pole must face the approaching magnetic field of its own which within the area
north pole of the magnet so as to repel it. bounded by the circuit is
The curled right-hand (RH) rule for magnetic (a) opposite to the original magnetic field if
dipole or magnetic field will provide the this field is increasing; but
direction of induced current in the loop. The (b) in the same direction as the original field,
induced current in the loop will be in counter if the field is decreasing.
267
Thus it is the 'change in flux' through the The screw driver rule fixes the positive
circuit (not the flux itself), which is opposed by sense of circulation around the loop as the
the induced current. clockwise direction.
Lenz's law follows directly from the As the sense of the induced current in the
conservation of energy. If an induced current loop is counter clockwise (negative), the sense
flows in a circuit in such a direction that it of induced emf also is negative (-ve). That
helps the cause that produces it, then we will is, the LHS of Eq. (12.5) is indeed a negative
soon find that the induced current and the (-ve) quantity in order to be equal to the RHS.
magnetic flux penetrating the loop would lead Thus the negative (-ve) sign in the
to an infinite growth. The induced current d
once started flowing in the loop would keep equation e incorporates Lenz's law
dt
increasing indefinitely producing joule heating into Faraday's law.
at no extra cost and thus be self-sustaining 12.4 Flux of the Field:
(perpetual motion machine). This will violate The concept of flux of the magnetic field
the law of conservation of energy. We thus see is vital to our understanding of Faraday's law.
that Lenz's law is a necessary consequence of As shown in Fig. 12.4
the law of conservation of energy. (a), consider a
small element of area da . A direction is
The opposing sense of the induced current
assigned to this element of area such that if
is one manifestation of a general statement of
the curve bounding the area is traversed in the
Lenz's law: "Every effect of induction acts in
direction of the arrow then the normal comes
opposition to the cause that produces it"
In order to have an induced current, we out of the plane of paper towards the reader.
must have a closed circuit. If a conductor is not In other words it is the direction in which right
forming a closed circuit we mentally construct handed screw will move if rotated in the sense
a circuit between the two ends of the conductor/ of the arrow on the curve.
wire and use Lenz's law to determine the
direction of induced current. Then the polarity
of the ends of the open-circuited conductor can
be found easily.
12.3.3 Lenz's Law and Faraday's Law:
Consider Faraday's law with special (a) (b)
attention to the negative (-ve) sign.
d . Fig. 12.4: (a) Small element of area da bounded
e
dt by a curve considered in anticlockwise direction.
Consider that area vector A of the loop (Right-handed screw Rule), (b) Finite surface
perpendicular to the plane of the loop is fixed area S .
oriented parallel ( θ= 0) to magnetic field
and Suppose the element
of area da is situated
B . The magnetic field B increases with time. in a magnetic field
B.Then the scalar quantity
Using the definition of flux, the Faraday' d φ = B . da = | B |. | da
| cos θ --- (12.6)
law can be written as is called the flux of B through the area da
d B where θ is the angle between the direction of
d --- (12.5)
e ( B A) | A | magneticfield
B and the direction assigned to
dt dt
∴ RHS = -ve quantity as | A | is positive the area da .
dB This can be generalised
to define the flux
and is positive (+ve) as B is increasing over a finite area S . It should
dt be remembered
with time. that the magnetic field B will not be the
268
same at different points within the finite resistance in the wire so that the induced
area. Therefore the area is divided into small currents are very small producing negligible
sections of area da so as to calculate the flux magnetic field.
over each section and then to integrate over the As the flux φ through the frame ABCD
entire area (Fig. 12.3 (b)) is Blx, magnitude of the induced emf can be
Thus, theflux
passing through S is written as
B da --- (12.7)
S
We can not take B out of the integral in
(12.6) unless B is the same everywhere in
Eq.
S.
If the magnetic field at every point
changes with time as well, then the flux φ will
also change withtime.
( t ) B ( t ) da --- (12.8)
S Fig. 12.5:
A frame of wire ABCD in magnetic
Faraday's discovery was that the rate of field B . Wire BC is moving with velocity v
269
In general, it can be proved that for any By imagining all such segments as a
circuit whose parts move in a fixed magnetic source of emf, we can find that all these
field, the induced emf is the time derivative of segments are in series and, therefore, the emfs
flux ( φ ) regardless of the shape of the circuit. of individual segments will be added.
The flux rule is also applicable in case Now we know that the induced emf de in
of a wire loop that is kept stationary and the small segment dr of the rotating conductor.
the magnetic field is changed. The Lorentz de = B v dr
force
onthe electrical
charges is given by Total induced emf in rotating rod
F = q ( E v B ) . There are no new special e de Bvdr
forces due to changing magnetic fields.
l
Any force on charges at rest in a stationary
e B rdr B rdr
wire comes from the E -term. Faraday's 0
observations led to the discovery that electric 2
l
and magnetic fields are related by a new law: B
2
In a region where magnetic field is changing
1
with time, electric fields are generated. It is e B l 2 --- (12.13)
2
this electric field which drives the electrons Compare the above result with the induced
around the conductor circuit and as such is emf in sliding bar, e = Blv.
responsible for the induced emf in a stationary
12.6 Induced emf in a Stationary Coil in a
circuit whenever there is a changing magnetic
Changing Magnetic Field:
flux.
As shown in Fig. 12.7 (a) in a magnet-coil
The flux rule holds good so long as the
change in the magnetic flux is due to the system, a permanent bar magnet is mounted
changes in magnetic field or due to the motion on an arc of a semicircle of radius 50 cm. The
of the circuit or both. arc is a part of a rigid frame of aluminium and
b) Motional emf in a rotating bar: is suspended at the centre of arc so that whole
A rotating bar is different in nature from system can oscillate freely in its plane. A coil
the sliding bar. As shown in Fig. 12.6, consider of about 10,000 turns of copper wire loop the
a small segment dr of the bar at a distance r arc so that the bar magnet can pass through the
from the pivot. It is a short length dr of the coil freely.
conductor which is moving with velocity v When the magnet moves through the coil,
in magnetic field B and has an induced emf the magnetic flux through the coil changes.
generated in it like a sliding bar. In order to measure the induced emf, a
capacitor (C) and diode (D) are connected
across the coil (Fig. 12.7 (b)) The induced
emf produced in the coil is used for charging
a capacitor through a diode. Then the voltage
developed across the capacitor is measured.
The capacitor may not get charged upto the
peak value in a single swing as the time-
constant (RC) may be larger than the time
during which the emf in the coil is generated.
Fig. 12.6: A conducting bar rotating around This may take about a few oscillations to
a pivot at one end in a uniform magnetic field
charge the capacitor to the peak value and is
that is perpendicular to the plane of rotation. A
rotational emf is induced between the ends of indicated by the ammeter (mA) which will tell
the bar. us when the charging current ceases to flow.
270
As the magnet, kept in the middle of the The centre of the hump 'bcde' refers to the
arc (Fig. 12.7 (a)), starts far away from the coil time when the magnet is inside the coil. The
moves through it and recedes, the magnetic flat portion (cd) at the top corresponds to the
field /flux through the coil changes from a finite length of the magnet. The magnetic flux
small value, increases to its maximum and ( φ ) is related to magnetic field (B) through a
becomes small again thus inducing an emf. constant (effective area = No. of turns × area
Actually, there is substantial magnetic field at of coil).
the coil only when it is very near the magnet. Now, the induced emf is proportional to
The speed of the magnet is largest when d φ /dt, that is to the slope of the curve in Fig.
it approaches the coil (placed at the mean 12.7 (c). As the slope of the curve is largest at
position of the oscillation). Thus the magnetic times t1 and t2, the magnitude of induced emf
field changes quite slowly with time when will be largest at these times. But Lenz's law
the magnet is far away and changes rapidly gives minus sign (-) in Eq. 12.3
when it approaches
the coil. The variation of d
magnetic field B (at the coil in mean position) e dt , which means that emf (e)
with time is shown in Fig. 12.7 (c). is 'negative' when φ is increasing at t1 and
'positive' when φ is decreasing at time t2. This
is shown in Fig. 12.7 (d) relating induced emf
(e) with time (t).
Remember the sequence of two pulses;
one 'negative' and one 'positive' occurs during
just half a cycle of motion of the magnet. On
the return swing of the magnet, they will be
Fig. 12.7 (a): Magnet-coil system. repeated (which one will be repeated first, the
'negative' or 'positive' pulse?).
Now we consider the effect of these pulses
on the charging circuit (Fig. 12.7 (b)) The diode
will conduct only during the 'positive' pulse. At
the first half swing, the capacitor will charge
up to a potential, say e1. During the next half
swing, the diode will be cut off until 'positive'
pulse is produced and then the capacitor will
Fig. 12.7 (b): Measurement of induced emf.
charge upto a slightly higher potential, say e2.
(c) This will continue for a few oscillations till the
capacitor charges upto its peak value eo by the
voltage/ emf pulse. At this stage ammeter will
show no kick (further increase) in the current
of the circuit.
(d) In order to have an estimate of eo, the
equation for induced emf can be written as
d d d
e --- (12.14)
dt d dt
The first term depends on the geometry of
the magnet and the coil. At θ = 0, the mean
Fig. 12.7: (c) Variation of B with time t, (d) position, we have maximum φ . But we are
variation of e with time t.
271
d =N⋅A⋅(dB/dt) (as A is constant and B is
interested in d ,
which is actually zero at
θ = 0. The second term dθ can be deduced changing with time)
dt =N⋅A⋅(∆B / ∆t) = N⋅A⋅ (Bfinal−Binitial / ∆t)
from the oscillation equation.
Inserting the given values of N=400, A =
θ = θ 0 sin 2πvt, θ 0 being the amplitude of
(20 cm)2 = (0.2 m)2, Bfinal = 0.5 T, Binitial = 0,
oscillating magnet.
∆t = 0.8 s
1
frequency v we find the induced emf
time period ( T )
e= 400⋅(0.20 m)2 (0.5 T)/0.8 s
θ = θ 0 sin 2π t = 10 Volt
T Example 12.2 : A long solenoid s, as shown
d 2 2
0 cos t in the figure has 200 turns/cm and carries
dt T T a current i of 1.4 A. The diameter D of the
d 2 0 2 t solenoid is 3 cm. A coil C, having 100 turns
cos --- (12.15)
dt T T and a diameter d of 2 cm is kept at the centre
The peak voltage (emf) e0 in the induced of the solenoid. The current in the solenoid
d is decreased steadily to zero in 20 ms.
emf pulse corresponds to .
dt max Calculate the magnitude of emf induced in
We can see from Fig. 12.7 (c) that the coil C when the current in the solenoid is
d changing.
d occurs at positions near the mean
max
position. In Eq. 12.15, the cosine term does not
differ much from unity for very small angles
(close to zero).
Hence we conclude that
d d 2 0
e0
dt max d max T --- (12.16)
For given magnet-coil system, the peak induced Solution: Given, diameter D = 3 cm = 0.03m
emf e0 is directly proportional to angular Cross section Area of solenoid =
amplitude ( θ 0 ) and inversely proportional to D2
A
time period (T). 4
Example 12.1: A coil consists of 400 3.14 3 3 2
cm
turns of wire. Each turn is a square of side 4
d = 20 cm. A uniform magnetic field directed 28.26 2
cm
perpendicular to the plane of the coil is 4
turned on. If the field changes linearly from A 7.065 cm 2
0 to 0.50 T in 0.8 s, what is the magnitude A 7.065 10 4 m 2
of induced emf in the coil while the field is Number of turns in unit length,
changing? 200 100
Solution: The magnitude of induced emf in n = 200/cm
m
the coil is written as = 2 ×104 turns/m
e= d(N φ )/ dt = N (d φ /dt) The magnetic flux of the solenoid due
∵ φ = B⋅ A to current i can be written as
∴e= N⋅ d(BA)/dt φBi = B.A = ( µ0 ni).A
272
Fig.12.8 (a). As the conductor wires cut across
7
4 10 T .m / A 2 10 turns/ m
4
the magnetic lines of force, an induced emf
1.4 A 7.065 104 m 2 (e = Blv) is produced across the terminals of
the commutator. The induced e.m.f is found to
Bi 4 2 1.40 7.065 10 7 T .m 2 be proportional to the speed of rotation (ω) of
2.485 10 5 Wb the armature.
Now,
dB B B , f B ,i
dt t ( 20 10 3 ) s
0 2.485 10 5 Wb
20 10 3 s
1.243 10 3Wb / sec
1.243 10 3V
dB
1.243 10 3V
dt
Now the induced emf in the coil C
with N = 100 turns can be written as
dB
eN 100 1.243 10 3V Fig. 12.8 (b): Wave form generation.
dt Let us focus our attention on one conductor
1
1.243 10 V of the armature as shown in Fig. 12.8 (b). In
124.3 10 3V position (i), the conductor is moving upward
across the lines of force inducing maximum
e 124.3mV
emf. When the armature reaches in position
12.7 Generators: (ii) the conductor is moving parallel to the field
In Chapter 10 you have learnt the principle and there is no induced emf (e = 0). At position
of electric motors. The basic construction of (iii), the same conductor moves down across
an electric generator is the same as that of the lines of force and the induced emf/ current
a motor. In this case the armature is turned is directed opposite to that in case of (i). The
by some external agency/torque as shown in graph, plotted between the current flowing in
the lamp as a function of the time (t) shows a
sinusoidally varying current as is shown in (iv)
of Fig. 12.8 (b).
When a coil is rotating with a constant
angular velocity ω , the angle between
magnetic field B and the area vector A of the
coil at any instant t is θ = ωt (assuming θ = 0 at
t = 0). As the effective area of the coil is
changing due to rotation in the magnetic field
B, the flux φB at any time can be written as
φB = B.A cos θ = B.A cos ωt.
From Faraday's law, the induced emf e,
Fig. 12.8 (a): Schematic of a Generator. generated by a rotating coil of N turns
273
NdB
e Do you know?
dt
d If a wire without any current is kept in a
N BA cos t
dt magnetic field, then it experiences no force
NBA sin t as shown in figure (a). But when the wire is
carrying a current into the plane of the paper
For sin t 1
in the magnetic field, a force will be exerted
e NBA e0 on the wire towards the left as shown in the
e e0 sin t figure (b). The field will be strengthened
e e0 sin 2 ft, --- (12.17) on the right side of the wire where the lines
where f is the frequency of revolution of of force are in the same direction as that of
the coil. the magnetic field and weakened on the left
Since the value of sin ωt varies between side where the field lines are in opposite
direction to that of the applied magnetic
+1 and -1, the polarity of the emf changes
field. For a wire carrying a current out of
with time. The emf has its extremum value at
the plane of the paper, the force will act to
θ = 90° and 270° as the change in flux is
the right as shown in figure (c).
greatest at these points. As the direction of
induced current changes periodically it is called
as alternating current (AC) (Fig. 12.8 (c)).
The frequency of AC is equal to the number
of times per second, the current changes from
positive (+ve) to negative (-ve) and back
(a) (b) (c)
again. The domestic electrical current varies
at a frequency of 50 cycles/second. 12.8 Back emf and back torque:
For the purpose of charging a storage We know that emf can be generated in
a circuit in different ways. In a battery it is
the chemical force, which gives rise to emf.
In piezoelectric crystals mechanical pressure
generates the emf. In a thermocouple it is the
temperature gradient which is responsible
for producing emf in a circuit containing the
junctions of two metallic wires. In a photo
electric cell, the incident light above a certain
Fig. 12.8: (c) Alternating current, frequency is responsible for producing the emf.
(d) Pulsating direct current. In a Van de Graaff Generator the electrons
battery it is necessary to generate a steady are literally loaded into a conveyor belt and
or direct current (DC). The reversing action swept along to create a potential difference.
of commutator can be used to generate A generator utilises the movement of wire
pulsating DC as depicted in Fig. 12.8 (d). The through a magnetic field to produce motional
commutator acts like a rapid switch which emf/current through a circuit. We have
reverses the connections to the armature at just seen that the physical construction of a DC
the right times to match with the reversals in generator and motor is practically the same.
current. Modern AC motors are more compact If a DC generator is connected to a battery,
and rugged than the DC motors. it will run as a motor. If a motor is turned
274
by any external means, it will behave as a
wire AB is cutting the magnetic lines of
generator. So whenever a motor is running,
force perpendicularly, the induced emf is,
its generator action can not be turned off. By
therefore, maximum.
Lenz's law the induced emf will tend to oppose ... e = Blv sinθ with θ = 90°,
the change which causes it. In the present case,
the 'cause' is the current through the armature. Then, e = emax = Blv
Therefore, the induced emf will tend to reduce = (0.5 N/A.m) (10/100)m. (6.28m/s)
the armature current. The induced emf which 0.5
6.28
is unavoidable due to generator action in a 10
motor is called back emf. Initially, when a 0.314 V
motor is just starting up, its armature is not or emax ≈ 314 mV.
turning and hence it is not producing any back The emf induced in the wires BC and DA
emf. As the motor starts speeding up the back is zero because the magnetic Lorentz force
emf increases and armature current decreases. on free electrons in these wire F q( v B )
This explains the reason as to why the current has no component parallel to the wires.
through a motor is larger in the beginning than Also there is no e.m.f. in the lead in wires,
when the motor is running at full speed. which are stationary and are not in motion
( v = 0). Therefore the total emf between the
Example 12.3: A rotating armature of a
terminals P and Q is due the movement of
simple generator consists of a loop ABCD to
segment AB. i.e., e = 314 mV. The direction
which connections are made through sliding
of induced emf is given by Lenz's law.
contacts. The armature is rotated at 1500
rpm in the magnetic Example 12.4: A conducting loop of area
field ( B ) of 0.5 N/ 1 m2 is placed normal to uniform magnetic
A.m. Determine the field 3Wb/m2. If the magnetic field is
induced emf between uniformly reduced to 1 Wb/m2 in a time of
the terminals P and Q 0.5 s, calculate the induced emf produced in
of the generator at the the loop.
Solution: Given,
instant shown in the adjoining figure.
Area of the loop, A = 1 m2
Solution: The wire AB (l = 10 cm) is moving
(B)intial = 3Wb/m2
to the right
with the tangential velocity v. (B)final = 1Wb/m2
v r
duration of time, ∆t = 0.5 s
v = ω r where ω is angular velocity and r is
∴ Induced emf,
the radius.
2 2 d
| e | final initial
v .r
T T dt Time interval
2 r
B final Binitial A
1500 4 r AD t
2 m
60 s 100 ( 4 / 100 ) m (1 3)
1 volt
2 m / s 0.5
6.28 m / s 2
1 volt
The magnetic field is directed vertically 0.5
upward from North to South pole. As the | e | 4 volt
275
12.9 Induction and Energy Transfer: magnetic flux induces current in the loop as
Consider a loop ABCD moving with dictated by Lenz's law. The induced current in
constant velocity v in a constant magnetic the loop gives rise to a force that opposes the
field B as shown in Fig. 12.9 (a). A current i is pulling of the loop away from the magnetic
induced in the loop in clockwise direction and field.
the loop segments, being still in magnetic field, We know that magnitude of magnetic
experience forces, F1, F2 and F3. The dashed flux through the loop is
lines show the limits of magnetic field. To φB = B.A = B.L.x --- (12.19)
pull the loop at a constant velocity v towards As x decreases, the flux decreases.
right, it is required to apply an external force According to Faraday's law, the magnitude of
F on the loop so as to overcome the magnetic induced emf,
force of equal magnitude but acting in opposite d d
e ( BLx )
direction. dt dt
dx
BL BLv --- (12.20)
dt
The induced emf e is represented on the
left and the collective resistance R of the loop
on the right in the Fig. 12.9 (b). The direction
of induced current i is obtained by Right-Hand
(RH) Rule.
The magnitude of induced current i can be
written using Eq. (12.20) as
| e | BLv
Fig. 12.9 (a): A loop is moving out of magnetic = i = --- (12.21)
field with velocity v. R R
The three segments of the current carrying
loop experience the deflectingforces F 1 , F 2
and F 3 in the magnetic
field B in accordance
with Eq. ( F = i L× B ). From the symmetry,
the forces F 2 and F 3 being equal and opposite,
cancel each other. The remaining force F 1 is
directed opposite to the external force F on
Fig. 12.9 (b) : Induced emf e, induced current i the loop. So F = - F 1 .
and collective resistance R of the loop.
∴ The rate of doing work on the loop is The magnitude of | F 1 | can
be written as
Work (W ) Force ( F ) × displacement ( d ) | F 1 | = i LB sin 90 = i LB = | F | --- (12.22)
P= = From Eq. (12.21) and Eq. (12.22)
time ( t ) time ( t )
P = Force (F) × velocity (v) | F | = | F 1 | = iLB
2 2
= F . v --- (12.18) = BLv LB B L v --- (12.23)
We would like to find the expression for P R R
From Eq. (12.18) and (12.23), the rate of
in terms of B and the characteristics of the loop
doing mechanical work, that is power:
i.e., resistance (R), width (L) and Area (A). B 2 L2 v
As the loop is moved to the right, the area B 2 L2 v 2 --- (12.24)
P F .v v
lying within the magnetic field decreases, R R
thus causing a decrease in the magnetic flux If current i is flowing in the closed
linked with the moving loop. The decreasing circuit with collective resistance R, the rate
276
of production of heat energy in the loop as we mechanical energy left with the pendulum and
pull it along at constant speed v, can be written the converted heat energy is dissipated in the
as solid plate making it warm. Eddy current can
Rate of production of heat energy = be reduced by discontinuity in the structure of
P = i2 R --- (12.25) conductor plate as depicted in Fig. 12.10 (c).
From Eq. (12.21) and Eq. (12.25)
2
BLv
P R
R
B 2 L2 v 2
P --- (12.26)
R
Comparing Eq. (12.24) and Eq. (12.26),
we find that the rate of doing mechanical work (a)
is exactly same as the rate of production of
heat energy in the circuit/loop.
Thus the work done in pulling the loop
through the magnetic field appears as heat
energy in the loop.
12.10 Eddy Currents:
Suppose the conducting loop of Fig.
(b) (c)
12.9 (a) is replaced by a solid conducting
plate, the relative motion between conductor
and magnetic field induces a current in the Fig. 12.10: (a) Eddy currents are induced in solid
conductor plate, (b) Conducting plate swings
conductor plate (Fig. 12.10 (a)). In this case like a pendulum, (c) Reduction in eddy currents
again, we encounter an opposing force so we due to discontinuous structure of a plate.
must do work while moving the conductor with 12.11 Self-Inductance:
uniform velocity v. The conduction electrons Consider a circuit (coil) in which the
making up the induced current do not follow current is changing. The changing current will
one path as they do with the loop, but swirl vary the magnitude of magnetic flux linked
about within the plate as if they were caught in with the coil (circuit) itself and consequently
an eddy of water. Such a current is called an an emf will be induced in the circuit.
eddy current. Eddy current can be represented
by a single path as shown in Fig. 12.10 (a). i
The induced current in the conductor plate
is responsible for transfer of the mechanical
energy into heat energy. The dissipation of
energy as heat energy is more apparent in the K
arrangement shown in Fig. 12.10 (a), where a
Fig. 12.11: Changing current in a coil.
conducting plate, free to rotate about a pivot,
The production of induced emf, in the
is allowed to swing down like a pendulum
circuit (coil) itself, on account of a change in
through a magnetic field. In each swing, when
the current in it, is termed as the phenomenon
the plate enters and leaves the field, a portion
of self-inductance.
of its mechanical energy is transformed to heat
Let at any instant, the value of magnetic
energy. After several such swings there is no
flux linked with the circuit itself be φ
277
corresponding to current I in it (Fig. 12.11). It of induced emf (caused by changing current in
is obvious that φ will be proportional to current the circuit) produced around the circuit to the
I. rate of change of current in it.
i.e., φ ∝ I In order words, the induced emf produced
or φ = LI or L = φ /I, --- (12. 27) around the circuit per unit rate of change of
where L is a constant of proportionality and is current in it, is defined as the self-inductance
of the circuit.
termed as the self-inductance (or coefficient of
(iii) When a current increases in the circuit, an
self induction) of the coil.
induced emf acts opposite to it. Consequently,
For a closely wound coil of N turns, the
the work will have to be done in order to
same magnetic flux will be linked with all the
establish the magnetic flux associated with a
turns. When the flux through the coil changes
steady current Io in the circuit.
each turn of the coil contributes towards the
Work done in time dt is dW = e.I dt
induced emf. Therefore a term flux linkage is
used for a closely wound coil. The flux linkage dI dI
L ( I ) dt e L
for a coil with N turns corresponding to current dt dt
I will be written as dI
N φB ∝ I LI dt
dt
N φB = LI LI dI
Io
L = N φB / I --- (12.28) ∴ Total work W dw LIdI
The inductance (L) depends only on the o
2
geometry and material properties of the coil. I
or, W L
0
--- (12.30)
Unit of Inductance: 2
According to Faraday's law, induced emf
1 2
e is given by = LI 0 (magnitude)
d 2
e Now if I0 = 1,
dt
Using Eq. (12.27) 1
Then W L
d dI 2
e ( LI ) L --- (12.29)
dt dt or L = + 2W (numerically) --- (12.31)
|e| volt Hence self-inductance of a circuit is
Unit of L Henry
| dI / dt | A / s numerically equal to twice the work done in
Definition of L: establishing the magnetic flux associated with
Self inductance L may be defined in the unit current in the circuit.
following ways: This work done W, will represent the
(i) From Eq. (12.27), φ = LI or L energy of the circuit.
I 1 2
Hence, the self-inductance of a circuit is ∴ Energy of the circuit = LI 0 --- (12.32)
the ratio of magnetic flux (produced due to 2
We know that the mechanical energy is
current in the circuit) linked with the circuit
expressed in terms of kinetic energy as
to the current flowing in it. The magnetic
1 2
flux produced per unit current in the circuit is KE = mv --- (12.33)
2
defined as its self inductance. Comparing the Eq. (12.33) and Eq. (12.34),
e
(ii) Using Eq. (12.29), L we find that self inductance (L) of an electrical
dI / dt
Hence, self-inductance of a circuit is the ratio circuit plays the same role (electrical inertia)
278
as played by mass (inertia) in mechanical and r is the distance from the toroid axis.
motion. As r <<R, magnetic field (B) in the cavity
Inductance of a solenoid: If a current i is of toroid is uniform and can be written as
established in the windings (turns) of a long Ni
solenoid, the current produces a magnetic flux B 0
2 R
φB through the central region. The inductance The magnetic flux ( φ ) passing through
of the solenoid is given by L = N φB /i, where cavity is
N is the number of turns. N φB is called as r 2 0 Ni 0 Nir
2
I1 ds d dI
es ( MI p ) M p
dt dt dt
es --- (12.47)
or M
Fig. 12.13: Mutual inductance of two coils. ( dI p / dt )
The induced emf in coil 2 will be written as Hence, mutual inductance is defined
d as the value of induced emf produced in the
e21 21
dt secondary circuit per unit rate of change in
dI current in the primary circuit.
e21 M 21 1
dt
Now we allow current I2 to flow through Use your brain power
coil 2. On account of this current, magnetic flux
φ12 liked with coil 1 is obviously proportional It can be shown that the mutual
to I2. potential energy of two circuits is W = MI1I2.
That is Therefore, the mutual inductance (M) may
φ12 ∝ I2 also be defined as the mutual potential
or φ12 = M12 I2 --- (12.42) energy (W) of two circuits corresponding to
unit current flowing in each circuit.
or M 12 12 --- (12.43)
I2 W
M12 is known as mutual inductance of coil 1 M=
I1 I 2
with respect to coil 2. The induced emf in coil M=W [I1 = I2 = 1]
1 will be
282
The unit of mutual inductance is henry (H). of coupling the greater will be the mutual
volt inductance (M).
henry = = ohm ⋅ s Inductance of any circuit is proportional to
As
the induced voltage it can develop. This is equally
1 henry = 1 ohm.s
If corresponding to 1 A/s rate of change true for mutual inductance.
of current in the primary circuit, the induced M ∝e21 , where e21 is induced emf developed
emf produced in the secondary circuit is 1 volt, in coil 2 due to the portion of the flux from coil 1
reaching coil 2 (= K φ1 ).
then the mutual inductance (M) of the two
But induced emf is also proportional to the
circuits is 1 H.
number of turns in the coil,
Example 12.9 : Mutual inductance of the So, e21 N 2 K 1
wireless charging system. But 1 N 1
In a wireless battery charger, the base
unit can be imagined as a solenoid (coil ∴ e21 ∝ N 2 ( KN 1 )
B) of length l with NB turns, carrying a Also L ∝ N 2 or N ∝ L
current iB and having a cross-section area ∴ N N ∝ L L = L1L2
1 2 1 2
A. The handle coil (coil H) has NH turns
and surrounds the base solenoid (coil B) Replacing e21 with M, we now have
completely. The base unit is designed to M = K L1 L2 --- (12.48)
hold the handle of the charging unit. The K is usually less than unity. If K =1,
handle has a cylindrical hole so that it fits the two coils will be perfectly coupled, and
loosely over a matching cylinder on the M = L1 L2 .
base unit. When the handle is placed on the (i) If K > 0.5, the two coils are tightly coupled
base, the current flowing in coil B induces (ii) If K<05, the coils are loosely coupled.
a current in the coil H. Thus, the induced (iii) If L1 = L2, then a coil with self-inductance
current in the coil H is used to charge the L is coupled to itself with mutual inductance
battery housed in the handle. = M = L1 L2 L2 = L
The magnetic field due to a solenoid coil B, It may not be always desirable to have a
N
Bsolenoid µ0 n i µ0 B i large value of mutual inductance (M). A large
l value of M is desirable for a transformer but
Magnetic flux through coil H caused by the higher M is not desirable for home appliances
magnetic field Bsolenoid due to solenoid coil such as a electric clothes dryer. A dangerous
B, emf can be induced on the metallic case of
φ H = Bsolenoid A the dryer if the mutual inductance between its
Flux linkage = NH φ H heating coils and the case is large. In order
The mutual inductance (M) of the wireless to minimise M the heating coils are counter
charging system, wound so that their magnetic fields cancel
N B A N one another and reduces M with the case of
M H solenoid µ0 B A. N H the dryer.
i l
Theoretically, the coupling between two
N N
µ0 B H A
coils is never perfect. If two coils are wound
l on a common iron core, the coefficient of
Coefficient of coupling between two circuits: coupling (K) can be considered as unity. For
The coefficient of coupling (K) is a measure two air-core coils or two coils on separate iron
of the portion of flux that reaches coil 2 which is in cores, the coefficient of coupling depends on
the vicinity of coil 1. The greater is the coefficient the distance between two coils and the angle
283
between the axes of the two coils. When the 12.15 Transformer:
coils are parallel (and in line), the coefficient Mutual inductance, is the basis of all types
K is maximum. If the axes of the coils are at of transformers. A transformer is a device used
right angles (and in line), K is minimum. If we for changing the voltage of alternating current
want to prevent interaction between the coils, from low value to high value or vice versa.
the coils should be oriented at right angle to We can see the transformers by road sides in
each other and be kept as far apart as possible. villages and cities.
K-value for radio coils (Radio frequency,
intermediate frequency transformers) lies
between 0.001 to 0.05.
Prove that the inductance of parallel wires Fig. 12.14: Transformer consisting of primary
of length l in the same circuit is given by and secondary coils wound on a soft iron core.
Whenever the magnetic flux linked
l
L 0 ln ( d / a ) , where a is the radius with a coil changes, an emf is induced in
the neighbouring coil. In a transformer there
of wire and d is separation between wire
are two coils, primary (p) and secondary (s)
axes.
insulated from each other and wound on a soft
iron core as shown in Fig. 12.14. Primary and
Example12.10: Two coils having self
secondary coils are called input and output
inductances L1 = 75 mH and L2 = 55 mH
coils respectively.
are coupled with each other. The coefficient
When an AC voltage is applied to the
of coupling (K) is 0.75 calculate the mutual
primary coil, the current through the coil
inductance (M) of the two coils.
changes sinusoidally causing similar changes
Solution : Given : in the magnetic flux through the core. As the
L1 = 75 mH, L2 = 55 mH, K = 0.75. changing magnetic flux is liked with both
We know that, primary and secondary coils, emf is induced
in each coil. The magnetic flux linked with the
M K LL 1 2
coil depends upon the number of turns in the
0.75 75 55 mH coil.
M 48.2 mH Let φ be the magnetic flux linked per
Example 12.11: The mutual inductance turn with both the coils at an instant t. Np and
(M) of the two coils is given as 1.5 H. The Ns be the number of turns in the primary and
self inductances of the coils are : secondary coil respectively.
Then at the instant t, the magnetic flux
L1 = 5 H, L2 = 4 H. Find the coefficient of
linked with primary coil φ p = Np φ , and with
coupling beween the coils.
secondary coil φ s = Ns φ .
Solution: The induced emf in primary and secondary
Given L1 = 5 H coil will be
L2 = 4 H d d
e p p N p
M = 1.5 H. dt dt
M 1.5 and e N d
K s s
L1 L2 5 4 dt
e N
0.335 33.5% s s
ep N p --- (12.49)
284
The ratio Ns/Np is called turn ratio
(transformer ratio) of the transformer. Equation Do you know?
(12.49) is known as equation for transformer.
1. The flux rule is the terminology that
For an ideal transformer,
Feynman used to refer to the law relating
input power = Output power
magnetic flux to emf. (RP Feynman,
ep ip = es is
Feynman lectures on Physics, Vol II)
es i p 2. The Faraday’s law relating flux to
= --- (12.50)
e p is emf is referred to by Griffiths as the
Combining Eqs. (12.49) and (12.50) ‘Universal flux rule’. Griffiths used
es N s i p the term ‘Faraday’s law to refer to
= = --- (12.51)
e p N p is what he called- Maxwell-Faraday
Case 1: When Ns > Np equation. (DJ Griffiths, Introduction to
then es > ep (step up transformer) electrodynamics 3rd Ed)
and ip > is. Current in the primary coil is more
than that in the secondary coil. Internet my friend
Case 2: When Ns < Np
https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/
then es < ep (step down transformer)
Electromagnetic_induction
and ip < is. Current in primary coil is less than
that in secondary coil
Do you know?
Do you know?
Accelerator in India:
Faraday's laws have found innumerable Microtron Accelerator for electrons at
applications in modern world. Some Savitribai Phule Pune University
common examples are: Electric Guitar
hard drives, Smart cards, Microphones, etc.
Hybrid cars: In modern days, the electric
and hybrid vehicles take advantage of
electromagnetic induction. The limitation
of such vehicles is the life- time of a battery
which is not long enough to get similar drive
from a full tank of fuel/ petrol. In order to
increase the amount of charge in the battery,
the car acts as a generator whenever it is 6 MeV Race - Track Microtron Accelerator
1 Electron Gun
applying the brakes. At the time of braking, 2 Cavity
3 Pole pieces
4 Magnetic shield
285
Exercises
1. Choose the correct option. iv) If a copper disc swings between the poles
i) A circular coil of 100 turns with a cross- of a magnet, the pendulum comes to rest
sectional area (A) of 1 m2 is kept with very quickly. Explain the reason. What
its plane perpendicular to the magnetic happens to the mechanical energy of the
field (B) of 1 T. What is the magnetic pendulum?
flux linkage with the coil? v) Explain why the inductance of two coils
(A) 1 Wb (B) 100 Wb connected in parallel is less than the
inductance of either coil.
(C) 50 Wb (D) 200 Wb
3. In a Faraday disc dynamo, a metal disc of
ii) A conductor rod of length (l) is moving
radius R rotates with an angular velocity
with velocity (v) in a direction normal
ω about an axis perpendicular to the
to a uniform magnetic field (B). What
plane of the disc and passing through its
will be the magnitude of induced emf centre. The disc is placed in a magnetic
produced between the ends of the moving field B acting perpendicular to the plane
conductor? of the disc. Determine the induced emf
(A) BLv (B) BLv2 between the rim and the axis of the disc.
1 2Bl [Ans: 1 ( Bω R 2 ) ]
(C) Blv (D) 2
2 v 4. A horizontal wire 20 m long extending
iii) Two inductor coils with inductance 10 from east to west is falling with a
mH and 20 mH are connected in series. velocity of 10 m/s normal to the Earth’s
What is the resultant inductance of the magnetic field of 0.5×10-4 T. What is the
combination of the two coils? value of induced emf in the wire?
(A) 20 mH (B) 30 mH [Ans: 10 mV]
20
(C) 10 mH (D) mH 5. A metal disc is made to spin at 20
3 revolutions per second about an axis
iv) A current through a coil of self inductance passing through its centre and normal to
10 mH increases from 0 to 1 A in 0.1 s. its plane. The disc has a radius of 30 cm
What is the induced emf in the coil? and spins in a uniform magnetic field of
(A) 0.1 V (B) 1 V 0.20 T, which is parallel to the axis of
(C) 10 V (D) 0.01 V rotation. Calculate
v) What is the energy required to build up a (a) The area swept out per second by the
current of 1 A in an inductor of 20 mH? radius of the disc,
(A) 10 mJ (B) 20 mJ (b) The flux cut per second by a radius of the
(C) 20 J (D) 10 J disc,
2. Answer in brief. (c) The induced emf in the disc.
i) What do you mean by electromagnetic [Ans: (a) 5.65 m2, (b) 1.130 Wb, (c) 1.130V]
induction? State Faraday’s law of 6. A pair of adjacent coils has a mutual
induction. inductance of 1.5 H. If the current in
ii) State and explain Lenz’s law in the light one coil changes from 0 to 10 A in 0.2 s,
of principle of conservation of energy. what is the change of flux linkage with
iii) What are eddy currents? State the other coil?
applications of eddy currents. [Ans: 75 Wb]
286
7. A long solenoid consisting of 1.5×103 the coil changes from 5A to 1A in 0.2 s,
turns/m has an area of cross-section of calculate the value of emf induced in the
25 cm2. A coil C, consisting of 150 turns
other coil. Also calculate the value of
(Nc) is wound tightly around the centre
induced charge passing through the coil
of the solenoid. Calculate for a current
if its resistance is 5 ohm.
of 3.0 A in the solenoid
(a) the magnetic flux density at the centre of [Ans: 8 m C]
the solenoid, 13. An emf of 96.0 mV is induced in the
(b) the flux linkage in the coil C, windings of a coil when the current in
(c) the average emf induced in coil C if the a nearby coil is increasing at the rate of
current in the solenoid is reversed in 1.20 A/s. What is the mutual inductance
direction in a time of 0.5 s. (M) of the two coils?
( µ0 = 4π × 10-7 T.m/A) [Ans: 80 mH]
[Ans: (a) 5.66×10-3 T, (b) 2.12×10-3 Wb, 14. A long solenoid of length l, cross-
(c) 8.48×10-3 V] sectional area A and having N1 turns
8. A search coil having 2000 turns with (primary coil), has a small coil of N2
area 1.5 cm2 is placed in a magnetic turns (secondary coil) wound about its
field of 0.60T. The coil is moved rapidly centre. Determine the Mutual inductance
out of the field in a time of 0.2 second. (M) of the two coils.
Calculate the induced emf across the [Ans: M = µ0 N1 N2A]
search coil. 15. The primary and secondary coil of a
[Ans: 0.9 V] transformer each have an inductance of
9. An aircraft of wing span of 50 m flies 200 ×10-6H. The mutual inductance (M)
horizontally in earth’s magnetic field of between the windings is 4×10-6 H. What
6×10-5 T at a speed of 400 m/s. Calculate percentage of the flux from one coil
the emf generated between the tips of the reaches the other?
wings of the aircraft. [Ans: 2%]
[Ans: 1.2 V] 16. A toroidal ring, made from a bar of
10. A stiff semi-circular wire of radius R is length (l) 1 m and diameter (d) 1 cm, is
rotated in a uniform magnetic field B bent into a circle. It is wound tightly with
about an axis passing through its ends. 100 turns per cm. If the permeability of
If the frequency of rotation of wire be bar is equal to that of free space ( µ0 ),
f, calculate the amplitude of alternating
calculate the magnetic field inside the
emf induced in the wire.
bar (B) when the current (i) circulating
[Ans: e0=π2BR2f ]
through the turns is 100 A. Also
11. Calculate the value of induced emf
determine the self-inductance (L) of the
between the ends of an axle of a railway
coil.
carriage 1.75 m long travelling on level
[Ans: 1.256T, 10mH]
ground with a uniform velocity of 50
17. A uniform magnetic field B(t), pointing
km per hour. The vertical component of
Earth’s magnetic field (Bv) is given to be upward fills a circular region of radius, s
5×10-5T. in horizontal plane. If B is changing with
[Ans: 0.122 mV] time, find the induced electric field.
12. The value of mutual inductance of two [Ans: s 2 dB ]
dt
coils is 10 mH. If the current in one of
287
13. AC Circuits
288
We define some specific values which the same resistance (R) in the same time (t) by
would be convenient for comparing two passing a steady current of constant magnitude
voltage or current waveforms. through it. The value of such steady current is
a) Average or mean value of AC: called the effective value or virtual value or
This is the average of all values of the rms value of the given alternating current and
voltage (or current) over one half cycle. As is denoted by irms. The relation between the rms
can be seen in Fig. 13.1, the average over a full value and peak value of alternating current is
cycle is always zero since the average value of given by
2
sin ω t over a cycle is zero. So the mean value
i d
2
2
of AC over a cycle has no significance and the 1
i sin 2 d
2 0 2
irms 0
mean value of AC is defined as the average 2 2 0
over half cycle. 2 2
i (1 cos 2 )
Average value of sin θ in the range 0° to 0
2 2
d
π c 0
Activity
292
The dimensions of inductive reactance is The current flowing in the circuit transfers
the same as those of resistance and its SI unit charge to the plates of the capacitor which
is ohm (Ω). produces a potential difference between the
In DC circuits f = 0 ∴XL = 0 plates. As the current reverses its direction in
It implies that a pure inductor offers zero each half cycle, the capacitor is alternately
resistance to DC, i.e., it cannot reduce DC. charged and discharged.
Thus, its passes DC and blocks AC of very Suppose q is the charge on the capacitor
high frequency. at any given instant t. The potential difference
In an inductive circuit, the self induced across the plates of the capacitor is
q
emf opposes the growth as well as decay of V = or q = CV --- (13.10)
C
current. The instantaneous value of current (i) in
the circuit is
Example 13.3: An inductor of inductance dq d ..
200 mH is connected to an AC source of peak =i = (Ce ) ( . V = e at every
dt dt instant)
emf 210 V and frequency 50 Hz. Calculate d
(Ce0 sin t ) e e0 sin t
the peak current. What is the instantaneous dt
voltage of the source when the current is at Ce0 cos t
its peak value? e0
Solution: Given cos t
1 / C
L = 200 mH =0.2 H
cos t
e0 = 210 V e0
i sin t
1 / C 2 sin t
f = 50 Hz 2
e0
Peak Current i0 = e0 = --- (13.11)
XL 2π fL
210 The current will be maximum when sin
= ( ω t + π/2) = 1, so that i = i0 where, peak value
2 × 3.142 × 50 × 0.2
∴ i0 = 3.342 A of current is
e0
As in an inductive AC circuit, current lags i0 --- (13.12)
π 1 / C
behind the emf by , so the voltage is zero
2 i i0 sin t --- (13.13)
when the current is at its peak value. 2
294
As eR is in phase with current i0 the
π
= 0.1571 sin (100πt + ) vector eR is drawn in the same direction as
2 that of i, along the
Reading of the AC ammeter is positive direction of X-axis
irms= 0.707 i0 represented by OA . The voltage across L and
= 0.707 × 0.1571 C have a phase different of 180° hence the net
ims = 0.111A reactive voltage is (eL- eC).
Assuming eL > eC represented by OB′ in
(d) AC circuit containing resistance the figure.
inductance and capacitance in series (LCR The resultant of OA and OB ' is the
circuit): diagonal OK of the rectangle OAKB'
Above we have studied the opposition OK OA 2 OB 2
offered by a resistor, pure inductor and capacitor
e0 eR 2 e L eC
2
to the flow of AC current independently.
Now let us consider the total opposition
(i0 R ) 2 i0 X L i0 X C
2
offered by a resistor, pure inductor and capacitor
connected in series with the alternating source e0 i0 R 2 X L X C
2
Q-factor is a dimensionless quantity. The For a choke coil, L is very large. Hence R
larger the value of Q-factor, the smaller the is very small so cos φ is nearly zero and power
value of 2 or the bandwidth and sharper loss is very small. The only loss of energy is
is the peak in the current or the series resonant due hysteresis loss in the iron core, which can
circuit is more selective. be reduced using a soft iron core.
Fig. (13.21) shows that the lower angular Internet my friend
frequency side of the resonance curve is
dominated by the capacitor’s reactance, the 1. https://en.m.wikipedia.org
high angular frequency side is dominated by 2. hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu
the inductor’s reactance and resonance occurs 3. https://www.britannica.com/science
in the middle. 4. www.khanacademy.org
303
Exercises
304
c) How does the reactance of the device the reading of the AC galvanometer
Y vary with the frequency of the AC ? connected in the circuit?
Show graphically [Ans: i = 2.2 sin (100π t-π/2), 1.555A]
d) Draw the phasor diagram for the device 17. A 25 µF capacitor, a 0.10 H inductor
Y. and a 25Ω resistor are connected in
8. Derive an expression for the impedance series with an AC source whose emf is
of an LCR circuit connected to an AC given by e = 310 sin 314 t (volt). What
power supply. is the frequency, reactance, impedance,
9. Compare resistance and reactance. current and phase angle of the circuit?
10. Show that in an AC circuit containing [Ans: 50Hz, 95.9Ω, 99.1Ω, 2.21A, 1.31
a pure inductor, the voltage is ahead of rad]
current by π/2 in phase. 18. A capacitor of 100 µF, a coil of
11. An AC source generating a voltage resistance 50Ω and an inductance 0.5
e = e0sin ω t is connected to a capacitor
H are connected in series with a 110
of capacitance C. Find the expression
V-50Hz source. Calculate the rms value
for the current i flowing through it. Plot
of current in the circuit.
a graph of e and i versus wt.
[Ans: 0.816A]
12. If the effective current in a 50 cycle AC
19. Find the capacity of a capacitor which
circuit is 5 A, what is the peak value of
current? What is the current 1/600 sec. when put in series with a 10Ω resistor
after if was zero ? makes the power factor equal to 0.5.
[Ans: 7.07A, 3.535 A] Assume an 80V-100Hz AC supply.
13. A light bulb is rated 100W for 220 V AC [Ans: 9.2 × 10-5 F]
supply of 50 Hz. Calculate (a) resistance 20. Find the time required for a 50 Hz
of the bulb. (b) the rms current through alternating current to change its value
the bulb. from zero to the rms value.
[Ans: 484Ω, 0.45A] [Ans: 2.5 × 10-3 s]
14. A 15.0 µF capacitor is connected to a 21. Calculate the value of capacity in
220 V, 50 Hz source. Find the capacitive picofarad, which will make 101.4
reactance and the current (rms and peak) micro henry inductance to oscillate with
in the circuit. If the frequency is doubled, frequency of one megahertz.
what will happen to the capacitive [Ans: 249.7 picofarad]
reactance and the current. 22. A 10 µF capacitor is charged to a
[Ans: 212Ω, 1.04 A, 1.47A, halved, 25 volt of potential. The battery is
doubled] disconnected and a pure 100 m H coil
15. An AC circuit consists of only an inductor is connected across the capacitor so that
of inductance 2 H. If the current is LC oscillations are set up. Calculate the
represented by a sine wave of amplitude maximum current in the coil.
0.25 A and frequency 60 Hz, calculate [Ans: 0.25 A]
the effective potential difference across 23. A 100 µF capacitor is charged with a 50
the inductor (π = 3.142) V source supply. Then source supply is
[Ans: 133.32V] removed and the capacitor is connected
16. Alternating emf of e = 220 sin 100 πt across an inductance, as a result of which
is applied to a circuit containing an
5A current flows through the inductance.
inductance of (1/π) henry. Write an
Calculate the value of the inductance.
equation for instantaneous current
[Ans: 0.01 H]
through the circuit. What will be
305
14. Dual Nature of Radiation and Matter
like tiny oscillators that emit electromagnetic
Can you recall? radiation only in discrete packets (E = nhν),
where ν is the frequency of oscillator. The
1. What is electromagnetic radiation?
emissions occur only when the oscillator makes
2. What are the characteristics of a wave?
a jump from one quantized level of energy to
3. What do you mean by frequency and
another of lower energy. This model of Planck
wave number associated with a wave?
turned out to be the basis for Einstein’s theory
4. What are the characteristic properties
of particles of matter? to explain the observations of experiments on
5. How do we define momentum of a photoelectric effect which we will study in the
particle? following section.
6. What are the different types of energies 14.2 The Photoelectric Effect:
that a particle of matter can possess? Heinrich Hertz discovered photoelectric
emission in 1887 while he was working on the
14.1 Introduction: production of electromagnetic waves by spark
In earlier chapters you have studied discharge. He noticed that when ultraviolet
various optical phenomena like reflection, light is incident on a metal electrode, a high
refraction, interference, diffraction and voltage spark passes across the electrodes.
polarization of light. Light is electromagnetic Actually electrons were emitted from the metal
radiation and most of the phenomena surface. The surface which emits electrons,
mentioned have been explained considering when illuminated with appropriate radiation,
light as a wave. We are also familiar with is known as a photosensitive surface.
the wave nature of electromagnetic radiation
in other regions like X-rays, γ-rays, infrared
and ultraviolet radiation and microwaves
apart from the visible light. Electromagnetic
radiation consists of mutually perpendicular
oscillating electric and magnetic fields, both
being perpendicular to the direction in which Fig. 14.1: Process of photoelectric effect.
the wave and energy are travelling. The phenomenon of emission of electrons
In Chapter 3 on Kinetic Theory of Gases from a metal surface, when radiation of
and Radiation, you have come across spectrum appropriate frequency is incident on it, as
shown in Fig. 14.1, is known as photoelectric
of black body radiation which cannot be
effect. For metals like zinc, cadmium,
explained using the wave nature of radiation.
magnesium etc., ultraviolet radiation is
Such phenomena appear during the interaction
necessary while for alkali metals, even visible
of radiation with matter and need quantum
radiation is sufficient.
physics to explain them.
Electrical energy can be obtained from light
The idea of 'quantization of energy' was
(electromagnetic radiation) in two ways
first proposed by Planck to explain the black
(i) photo-emissive effect as described above
body spectrum. Planck proposed a model that
and (ii) photo-voltaic effect, used in a solar
says (i) energy is emitted in packets and (ii)
cell. In the latter case, an electrical potential
at higher frequencies, the energy of a packet
difference is generated in a semiconductor
is large. Planck assumed that atoms behave
using solar energy.
306
14.2.1 Experimental Set-up of Photoelectric from the metal through its surface. These
Effect: electrons, called photoelectrons, are collected
A typical laboratory experimental set-up at the collector C (photoelectron are ordinary
for the photoelectric effect (Fig. 14.2) consists electrons, they are given this name to indicate
of an evacuated glass tube with a quartz that they are emitted due to incident light). We
window containing a photosensitive metal now know that free electrons are available in
plate - the emitter E and another metal plate a metal plate. They are emitted if sufficient
- the collector C. The emitter and collector energy (we will know more about this energy
are connected to a voltage source whose later in the Chapter) is supplied to them to
voltage can be changed and to an ammeter to overcome the barrier that keeps them inside
measure the current in the circuit. A potential the metal.
difference of V, as measured by the voltmeter, In the late nineteenth century, these
is maintained between the emitter E (the facts were not known and scientists working
cathode) and collector C (the anode), normally on photoelectric effect performed various
C being at a positive potential with respect to experiments and noted down their observations.
the emitter. This potential difference can be These observations are summarized below.
varied and C can even be at negative potential We will try to analyze these observations and
with respect to E. When the anode potential V their explanation.
is positive, it accelerates the electrons (hence 14.2.2 Observations from Experiments on
called accelerating potential) while when the Photoelectric Effect:
anode potential V is negative, it retards the 1. When ultraviolet radiation was incident on
flow of electrons (therefore known as retarding the emitter plate, current I was recorded
potential). A source S of monochromatic light even if the intensity of radiation was very
(light corresponding to only one specific low. Photocurrent I was observed only
frequency) of sufficiently high frequency if the frequency of the incident radiation
(short wavelength ≤ 10-7 m) is used. was more than some threshold frequency
ν0. ν0 was same for a given metal and was
different for different metals used as the
emitter. For a given frequency ν ( > ν0) of
the incident radiation, no matter how feeble
was the light meaning however small the
intensity of radiation be, electrons were
always emitted.
2. There was no time lag between the
incidence of light and emission of electrons.
The photocurrent started instantaneously
(within 10-9 s) on shining the radiation even
if the intensity of radiation was low. As
soon as the incident radiation was stopped,
the flow of current stopped.
3. Keeping the frequency ν of the incident
Fig. 14.2: Schematic of experimental set-up for radiation and accelerating potential V
photoelectric effect. fixed, if the intensity was increased, the
Light is made to fall on the surface of photo current increased linearly with
the metal plate E and electrons are ejected intensity as shown in Fig. 14.3.
307
the frequency of the incident radiation is
changed, KEmax changed. It did not depend
on the intensity of the incident radiation.
Thus, even for very small incident intensity,
if the frequency of incident radiation was
larger than the threshold frequency v0,
KEmax from a given surface was always the
Fig. 14.3: Photocurrent as a function of incident
intensity for fixed incident frequency and
same for a given incident frequency.
accelerating potential . 7. If increasingly negative potentials were
4. The photocurrent I could also be varied applied to the collector, the photocurrent
by changing the potential of the collector decreased and for some typical value -V0,
plate. I was dependent on the accelerating photocurrent became zero. V0 was termed
potential V (potential difference between as cut-off or stopping potential. It indicated
the emitter and collector) for given incident that when the potential was retarding, the
radiation (intensity and frequency were photoelectrons still had enough energy to
overcome the retarding (opposing) electric
fixed). Initially the current increased with
field and reach the collector. Value of V0
voltage but then it remained constant. This
was same for any incident intensity as long
was termed as the saturation current I0
as the incident frequency was same (Fig.
(Fig. 14.4). 14.4) but was different for different emitter
materials.
8. If the frequency of incident radiation
was changed keeping the intensity and
accelerating potential V constant, then the
saturation current remained the same but
the stopping potential V0 changed. This
observation is depicted in Fig. 14.5. The
stopping potential V0 varied linearly with ν
as shown in Fig. 14.6. For different metals,
Fig. 14.4: Photocurrent as a function of the slopes of such straight lines were the
accelerating potential for fixed incident
same but the intercepts on the frequency
frequency and different incident intensities.
and stopping potential axes were different.
5. Keeping the accelerating voltage and
incident frequency fixed, if the intensity
of incident radiation was increased, the
value of saturation current also increased
proportionately, e.g., if the intensity was v3 > v2 > v1
310
means high energy radiation. Alternatively,
short wavelength radiation means high energy Try this
radiation.
Determine the wavelengths and frequencies
Example 14.2: (a) Calculate the energies for photons of energies (i) 10-12 J, (ii) 10-15 J,
of photons corresponding to ultraviolet light (iii) 10-18 J, (iv) 10-21 J and (v) 10-24 J.
and red light, given that their wavelengths are Accordingly prepare a chart (along a
3000 Å and 7000 Å respectively. (Remember horizontal line) of various regions of
that the photon are not coloured. Colour is electromagnetic spectrum and identify
human perception for that frequency range.) these regions in categories that you know.
(b) A typical FM radio station has its Compare your results with a standard chart
broadcast frequency 98.3 MHz. What is the from any reference book or from Internet.
energy of an FM photon of this frequency? You would notice that γ photons are the most
Solution: Given energetic photons and their energies are
λuv = 3000 Å = 3000 × 10-10 m, ~ 10-13 - 10-12 J. This is a very small amount
λred = 7000 Å = 7000 × 10-10 m and of energy on the human scale and therefore
νFM = 98.3 MHz = 98.3 × 106 s-1 we do not notice individual photons along
We know that energy E of electromagnetic their passage.
radiation of frequency ν is hν and if λ is the
The explanation using Einstein's postulate
corresponding wavelength, then λν = c, c
of quantization of energy for the observations
being the speed of electromagnetic radiation mentioned in section 14.2.2 is given below.
in vacuum. 1. Einstein argued that when a photon of
hc
Hence, E h ultraviolet radiation arrives at the metal
(a) surface and collides with an electron, it
6.6310 34 Js 3 10
8 ms 1 gives all of its energy hν to the electron.
E
3000 10 10 m The energy is gained by the electron and
6.63 10 19 J = 4.147 eV the photon no longer exists. If φ0 is the
for a photon corresponding to ultraviolet work function of the material of the emitter
light and plate, then electrons will be emitted if and
6.6310 34 Js 3 10
8 ms 1 only if the energy gained by the electrons
E
7000 10 10 m is more than or equal to the work function
19 J = 1.77 eV
2.84 10 i.e.,hν ≥ φ0 . Thus, a minimum or threshold
for a photon corresponding to red light. frequency ν0 (= φ0 /h) is required to eject
(b) The energy of photon of FM frequency electrons from the metal surface. If ν < ν0,
98.3 MHz is 6.63 ×10-34 J s × 98.3 × 106 s-1 the photon will not have enough energy
to liberate an electron. As a result, no
= 651.73 ×10-28 J = 40.73 ×10-8 eV.
electron will be ejected however intense
This is very small energy as compared
the incident radiation is. Similarly if
to the photon energy in the visible range.
ν > ν0, the energy will always be sufficient
to eject an electron, however small the
• Wavelength (in Å) × energy (in eV) ≈ incident intensity is.
12500 (numerically) 2. Energy is given by the photon to the
• Wavelength (in nm) × energy (in eV) ≈ electron as soon as the radiation is
1250 (numerically) incident on the surface. The exchange of
energy between the photon and electron
311
is instantaneous. Hence there is no time 6. If the frequency of incident radiation is
lag between the incidence of light and more than the threshold frequency, then
emission of electrons. Also when the the energy φ0 is used by the electron
incident radiation is stopped, there are to escape from the metal surface and
no photons to transfer the energy to remaining energy of the photon becomes
electrons, hence the photoemission stops the kinetic energy of the electron.
immediately. Depending on the energy of the electron
3. According to Einstein’s proposition, if the inside the metal and other processes like
intensity of incident radiation for a given collisions after emission from the surface,
wavelength is increased, there will be an the maximum kinetic energy is equal to
increase in the number of energy quanta (hν - φ0 ). Hence,
(photons) incident on unit area in unit KEmax = hν - φ0 --- (14.2)
time; the energy of each quantum being Equation (14.2) is known as Einstein’s
the same (= hν = hc/λ). Therefore larger
photoelectric equation. KEmax depends
intensity radiation will knock off more
on the material of the emitter plate and
number of electrons from the surface and
varies linearly with the incident frequency
hence the current will be larger (if ν > ν0).
ν; it is independent of the intensity of the
Conversely lower intensity implies less
incident radiation.
number of incident photons, hence, less
7. The electrons that are emitted from the
number of ejected electrons and therefore
metal surface have different kinetic
lower current.
4. Once the electron is emitted from the energies. The reasons for this are many-
surface, if the collector is at a higher fold: all the electrons in a solid do not
potential than the emitter, the electric possess the same energy, the electrons
field will accelerate the electrons towards may be ejected from varying depths
the collector. Higher is the accelerating inside the metal surface, electrons may
potential, more will be number of suffer collisions before they come out
electrons reaching the collector. Hence of the metal surface and may lose their
the photocurrent I increases with the energy etc. If V is the potential difference
accelerating potential initially. Moreover, between the emitter and collector and
since the intensity of incident radiation the collector is at a lower potential,
determines the number of photons incident an electron will lose its kinetic energy
on the metal surface on unit area in unit in overcoming the retarding force. If
time, it determines the maximum number the kinetic energy is not sufficient, the
of electrons that can be knocked off by emitted electrons may not reach the
the incident radiation. Hence for a given collector and the photocurrent will be
intensity, increasing the accelerating zero. If KEmax is the energy of the most
potential can increase the current only energetic electron at the emitter surface
till all the knocked off electrons have (where its potential energy is zero) and
reached the collector. No increase can be -V0 is the stopping potential, then this
seen in the current beyond this limit. This electron will fail to reach the collector
explains the saturation current I0. if KEmax< eV0, where e is the electron
5. Increasing the incident intensity will charge and eV0 is the energy needed for
increase the number of incident photons the electron to overcome the retarding
and eventually the saturation current. potential V0. If the electron just fails to
312
reach the collector, i.e., it has lost all was accepted. The work function values φ0
its kinetic energy just at the collector, for some metals were also confirmed from
KEmax= eV0 and the photocurrent becomes Eq. (14.3). Einstein and Millikan received
zero. Equation (14.2) then explains that Nobel prizes for their respective discoveries in
stopping potential V0 depends on the 1921 and 1923 respectively.
incident frequency and the material of
Use your brain power
the emitter and does not depend on the
incident intensity. You must have seen light emitting
8. If the ejected electrons have kinetic diodes (LEDs) of different colours. In LED,
energy more than eV0, electrons can reach electrical energy is converted into light
the collector, hence current flows. When energy corresponding to different colours.
the kinetic energy of the electron is less Can you tell what must be the difference in
than or equal to eV0, no current will flow. the working of LEDs of different colours.
Photocurrent will become zero when Design an experiment using LEDs to
KEmax = eV0. Using KEmax = eV0, we can determine the value of Planck’s constant.
write Eq. (14.2) as You might know that Nobel prize in
eV0 h 0 physics for the year 2014 was awarded to
h Professors Isamu Akasaki, Hiroshi Amano
or, V0 0 --- (14.3)
e e and Shuji Nakamura for the invention of
Above equation tells us that V0 varies blue LEDs. They made the first blue LED in
linearly with incident frequency ν, and the early 1990s. Try to search on the Internet
the slope of the straight line depends on why it was difficult to make a blue LED.
constants h and e while the intercept of
the line depends on the material through According to Einstein, energy of radiation
φ0 . Thus the slope of lines in Fig. 14.6 is of frequency ν comes in bundles with
magnitude hν. Thus energy of a light beam
same and is independent of the material having n photons will be nhν, where n can take
of the emitter but intercepts are different only integral values. Is it then possible to vary
for different materials. the incident energy continuously? Why we do
9. All the above arguments thus bring out the not see individual photons? To understand this
fact that the magnitude of photocurrent issue, let us consider the following example.
depends on the incident intensity through Example 14.3: The wavelength and
the number of emitted photoelectrons and intensity of the incident light is 4000 Å and
the potential V of the collector but not on 0.1 W respectively. What is the minimum
the incident frequency ν as long as ν > ν0. change in the light energy? What is the
number of incident photons?
Thus all the observations related to the Solution : Given incident intensity = 0.1 W
experiments on photoelectric effect were and λ = 4000 Å = 4000 × 10-10 m.
explained by Einstein’s hypothesis of existence The energy E of a photon of given
of a photon or treating light as bundles of wavelength is
energy. Although Einstein gave his hypothesis hc 6.6310 34 Js 3 108 m / s
E h
in 1905, it was not widely accepted by the 4000 10 10 m
scientific community. In 1909, when Millikan 4.97 10 19 J
measured the charge of an electron and the This is the minimum change in energy
value of h, calculated from Eq. (14.3), matched and is very small. The change in energy can
with the value given by Planck, the hypothesis therefore be considered as continuous.
313
Number of photons N incident per second is Can you tell?
0.1W
N 19
2 10
17
4.97 10
J A particular metal used as a cathode in
The number of photons coming out is an experiment on photoelectric effect
so large that human eye cannot comprehend does not show photoelectric effect when
or count it. Even if one wishes to count, say it is illuminated with green light. Which
10 photons per second, ∼109 years will be of the colours in the visible spectrum are
required. likely to generate photocurrent?
Table 14.2 : Summary of analysis of observations from experiments on photoelectric effect.
Observation Wave theory Photon picture
Electrons are emitted Very intense light is needed Only one photon is needed to eject
as soon as the light is for instantaneous emission one electron from the metal surface
incident on the metal of electrons. and energy exchange between
surface. electron and photon is instantaneous
on collision.
Very low intensity of Low intensity should not Low intensity of incident light means
incident light is also give photocurrent. less number of photons and not low
sufficient to generate energy photons. Hence low current
photocurrent. will be produced.
High intensity gives High intensity means Higher intensity means more number
larger photocurrent higher energy radiation and of photons incident in unit time,
means higher rate of therefore more electrons are therefore more number of electrons
release of electrons. emitted. are emitted in unit time and hence
photocurrent is larger.
Increasing the intensity Higher intensity should Higher intensity means higher
has no effect on the mean electrons emitted with number of incident photons per unit
electron energy. higher energies. time. Energy of photon is same as it
does not depend on the intensity.
A minimum threshold Low frequency light should A photon of low frequency light will
frequency is needed for release electrons but would not have sufficient energy to release
photocurrent to start. take more time. an electron from the surface.
Increasing the frequency Increasing intensity should Increasing the frequency increases
of incident light increases increase the maximum the energy of the photon. Therefore
the maximum kinetic kinetic energy. Maximum electrons receive more energy which
energy of electrons. kinetic energy should not results in increasing the maximum
depend on the incident kinetic energy.
frequency.
14.3 Wave-Particle Duality of Electromagnetic momentum. Hence the question came up
Radiation: whether a particle can be associated with
In its interaction with matter, light behaves light or electromagnetic radiation in general.
as if it is made up of packets of energy called Particle nature was confirmed by Compton in
quanta. Later it was confirmed from other 1924 in experiments on scattering of X-rays
theoretical and experimental investigations due to electrons of matter. Summary of these
that these light quanta can have associated results is given in the box below and you can
314
know more about these experiments from the
Compton shift is given by the relation
reference books given at the end of this book h
or from the links given below ' (1 cos )
me c
• h t t p : / / p h y s i c s . u s a s k . c a / ~ b z u l k o s k / where θ is the scattering angle. The shift
modphyslab/phys251manual/ depends only on the scattering angle and
compton_2009.pdf not on the incident wavelength. This shift
• http://www.phys.utk.edu/labs/modphys/ cannot be explained using wave theory. If
Compton Scattering Experiment.pdf we let the Planck’s constant go to zero, we
• http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/ get the result expected from wave theory.
hbase/quantum/comptint.html This is the test to check whether the new
picture is correct or not.
Do you know?
Compton showed that photon has an
The particle nature of radiation is seen associated momentum along with the energy
in black body radiation and photoelectric it carries. All photons of electromagnetic
effect. In the former, near room temperature, radiation of a particular frequency have the
the radiation is mostly in the infrared region same energy and momentum. Photons are
while in the latter it is in the visible and electrically neutral and are not deflected by
ultraviolet region of the spectrum. The electric or magnetic fields. Photons can have
third experiment, which established that a particle-like collisions with other particles
photon possesses momentum like a particle, such as electrons. In photon – particle
was Compton scattering where X-rays and collision, energy and momentum of the system
γ-rays interact with matter. In 1923, A. H. are conserved but the number of photons is not
Compton made a monochromatic beam conserved. Photons can be absorbed or new
of X-rays, of wavelength λ, incident on a photons can be created. Photons can transfer
graphite sheet and measured the intensity their energy and momentum during collisions
of the scattered rays in different directions with particles and disappear. When we turn on
as a function of wavelength. He found that light, they are created. Photon always moves
although the incident beam consisted of a with the speed of light, it is never at rest.
single wavelength λ, the scattered intensity Mass of a photon is not defined as we do for a
was maximum at two wavelengths. One of particle in Newtonian mechanics. Its rest mass
these was same as the incident wavelength is zero (in all frames of reference).
but the other λ′ was larger by an amount Effects of wave nature of light were seen
∆λ. ∆λ is known as the Compton shift that in experiments on interference or diffraction
depends on the scattering angle. when the slit widths or the separation between
Compton explained his observations two slits are smaller than or comparable to
by considering incidence of X-ray beam the wavelength of light. If the slit width is
on graphite as collision of X-ray photons large or the spacing between slits is more, the
with the electrons of graphite, like collision interference or diffraction patterns will not
of billiard balls. Energy and momentum be same and the wave nature will not be so
is transferred during the collision and obvious.
scattered photons have lower energy than It was realized by scientists that some
the incident photons. Therefore they have phenomena observed in experiments in the
lower frequency or higher wavelength. The laboratory or in nature (like interference and
315
diffraction) can be explained by considering photographic cameras make use of photocell
light in particular, and electromagnetic to measure the intensity of light. Photocell can
radiation in general, as a wave. On the also be used to switch on or off the street lights.
other hand, some other observations (like
photoelectric effect and black body radiation)
can be explained only if we consider
electromagnetic radiation as consisting of
photons with definite quantum of energy
(and momentum as evident from Compton
scattering experiments). Also there are some
phenomena which can be explained by both
the theories. It is therefore essential to consider
that both the characters or behaviours hold Fig. 14.7 : Schematic of a photocell.
good; one dominates in some situations and Suppose source of ultraviolet radiation
the other works in rest of the situations. It is is kept near the passage or entrance of a
necessary to keep both the physical models to mall or house and the light is made incident
explain the careful experimental observations. on the cathode of a photocell, photocurrent is
There is thus a need to hypothesize the dual generated. When a person passes through the
passage or comes near the entrance, incident
character of light. Later it turned out that such
light beam is interrupted and photocurrent
a picture is required not only for light but for
stops. This event can be used to operate a
the whole electromagnetic spectrum. This counter in counting devices, or to set a burglar
phenomenon is termed as wave-particle alarm. Such an arrangement can be used to
duality of electromagnetic radiation. identify traffic law defaulters by setting an
14.4 Photo Cell: alarm using the photocell.
Photo cell is a device that makes use
of the photoelectric effect and converts light Use your brain power
energy into electrical energy. Schematic of a Is solar cell a photocell?
photocell is shown in Fig. 14.7. It consists of a
semi-cylindrical photosensitive metal plate E 14.5 De Broglie Hypothesis:
(acting as a cathode) and a wire loop collector In 1924, Prince Louis de Broglie
C (acting as an anode) supported in an (pronounced as ‘de broy’) proposed, on the
evacuated glass or quartz bulb. The electrodes basis of the symmetry existing in nature, that
are connected to an external circuit having a if radiation has dual nature - sometimes wave
high tension battery B and a microammeter nature dominates and sometimes particle
μA. Instead of a photosensitive metal plate, nature, matter may also possess dual nature.
the photosensitive material can be pasted in Normally we talk about matter as composed
the form of a thin film on the inner walls of the of particles, but are there situations where
glass bulb. matter seems to show wave-like properties?
When light of suitable wavelength falls on
This will become evident from the experiments
the cathode, photoelectrons are emitted. These
on diffraction of electrons from nickel crystals
electrons are attracted towards the anode due
described later in this chapter.
to the applied electric field. The generated
photocurrent is noted from the microammeter. De Broglie used the properties, frequency
Photocell is used to operate control systems ν and wavelength λ, of a wave and proposed
and in light measuring devices. Light meters in a relation to connect these with the particle
316
properties, energy E and momentum p. The charged ions where m corresponds to the mass
momentum p carried by a photon of energy E of the charged particle. Of course, when V is
is given by the relation very large (say in kV), so that the speed of the
E particle becomes close to the speed of light,
p = --- (14.4)
c such an equation will not be applicable. You
which is valid for a massless particle
travelling with the speed of light c according will learn about other effects in such situations
to Einstein's special theory of relativity. Using in higher classes.
the Einstein’s relation for E, For an electron moving through a potential
E h h difference of V (given in volts)
p --- (14.5) h
c c
where λ, the wavelength, is given by λν = c. 2 me eV
De Broglie proposed that a moving 6.63 10 34 Js
material particle of total energy E and
momentum p has associated with it a wave involts
2 9.11 10 31 kg 1.6 10 19 C V
analogous to a photon. He then suggested that 1.228 10 9
m
the wave and particle properties of matter V involts
can also be described by a relation similar
to Eq. (14.5) for a photon. Thus frequency 1.228
or, innm --- (14.7)
and wavelength of a wave associated with a V involts
material particle, of mass m moving with a
velocity v, are given as Example 14.4: An electron is accelerated
ν = E/h and through a potential of 120 V. Find its de
λ = h/p = h/mv --- (14.6) Broglie wavelength.
He referred to these waves associated Solution: Given V = 120 V.
with material particles as matter waves. 1.228
The wavelength of the matter waves, given We know that λ = using Eq. (14.7).
V
by Eq. (14.6), is now known as de Broglie
wavelength. Greater is the momentum, shorter 1.228
∴λ = = 0.112 nm.
is the wavelength. Equation (14.6) for the 120
wavelength of matter waves is known as de
Broglie relation. Use your brain power
For a particle of mass m moving with a
velocity v, the kinetic energy Can you estimate the de Broglie wavelength
of the Earth?
1 2EK
EK = mv2 or v = .
2 m Can you tell?
Thus, h h m h
mv m 2 EK 2 mEK The expression p = E/c defines the
For a charged particle of charge q, momentum of a photon. Can this
accelerated from rest, through a potential expression be used for momentum of an
difference V, the work done is qV. This provides electron or proton?
the kinetic energy. Thus EK = qV. Shortly after the existence of photons
h h (particles associated with electromagnetic
.
2 mEK 2 mqV waves) was postulated, it was also
This relation holds for any charged experimentally found that electrons sub-atomic
particle like electron, proton or for even and atomic particles like protons and neutrons
317
also exhibit wave properties. The wavelength experiment, electrons were used in place of
associated with an electron of energy few eV light waves. Scattered electrons were detected
is of the order of few Å. Therefore to observe by an electron detector and the current was
the wave nature of electron, slit width or measured with the help of a galvanometer. By
diffracting objects should be of same order of moving the detector on a circular scale that
magnitude (few Å). is by changing the scattering angle θ (angle
The wave property of electron was between the incident and the scattered electron
confirmed experimentally in 1927 by Davisson beams), the intensity of the scattered electron
and Germer in America and in 1928 by George beam was measured for different values of
P. Thomson in England by diffraction of scattering angle. Scattered intensity was not
electrons by atoms in metals. Knowing that the found to be uniform in all directions (as predicted
size of the atoms and their spacing in crystals by classical theory). The intensity pattern
is of the order of few Å, they anticipated that resembled a diffraction pattern with peaks
corresponding to constructive interference and
if electrons are scattered by atoms in a crystal,
troughs to regions of destructive interference.
the associated matter waves will interfere and
Diffraction is a property of waves. Hence,
will show diffraction effects. It turned out to
above observations implied that the electrons
be true in their experiments. Electrons showed
formed a diffraction pattern on scattering and
constructive and destructive interference. No
that particles could show wave-like properties.
electrons were found in certain directions
due to destructive interference while in other
directions, maximum numbers of electrons
were seen due to constructive interference.
Louis de Broglie received the Nobel prize
in Physics in 1929 and Davisson, Germer and
Thomson shared the Nobel prize in Physics in
1937. It was amazing that Sir J. J. Thomson
discovered the existence of electron as a sub-
atomic particle while his son G. P. Thomson
showed that electron behaves like a wave. Fig. 14.8: Schematic of Davisson and Germer
14.6 Davisson and Germer Experiment: experiment.
A schematic of the experimental Davisson and Germer varied the
arrangement of the Davisson and Germer accelerating potential from 44 V to 68 V
experiment is shown in Fig. 14.8. The whole and observed a peak in the intensity of the
set-up is enclosed in an evacuated chamber. scattered electrons at scattering angle of 50º
It uses an electron gun - a device to produce for a potential of 54 V. This peak was the result
electrons by heating a tungsten filament F of constructive interference of the electrons
using a battery B. Electrons from the gun scattered from different layers of the regularly
are accelerated through vacuum to a desired spaced atoms of the nickel crystal.
velocity by applying suitable accelerating From Eq. (14.7), for V = 54 V, we get
potential across a cylindrical anode and are λ = 1.228/√54 = 0.167 nm --- (14.8)
collimated into a focused beam. This beam From the electron diffraction
of electrons falls on a nickel crystal and is measurements, the wavelength of matter
waves associated with the electrons was
scattered in different directions by the atoms of
found to be 0.165 nm. The two values of λ,
the crystal. Thus, in the Davisson and Germer
318
obtained from the experimental results and particles. Wave-particle duality implies that all
from the theoretical de Broglie relation, were moving particles have an associated frequency
in close agreement. The Davisson and Germer and an associated wave number and all waves
experiment thus substantiated de Broglie’s have an associated energy and an associated
hypothesis of wave-particle duality and momentum. We come across the wave-particle
verified his relation. duality of matter due to quantum behaviour
when we are dealing with microscopic objects
Use your brain power (sizes ≤ 10-6 m). Small order of magnitude of
h sets the scale at which quantum phenomena
Diffraction results described above
manifest themselves.
can be produced in the laboratory using
If all the material objects in motion have
an electron diffraction tube as shown in
an associated wavelength (and therefore an
figure. It has a filament which on heating
associated wave), why then we do not talk
produces electrons. This filament acts as a
about wavelength of a child running with speed
cathode. Electrons are accelerated to quite
v on a pathway 2 m wide or a car moving with
high speeds by creating large potential
speed v on a road 20 m wide? To understand
difference between the cathode and a
this, let us try to calculate these quantities.
positive electrode. On its way, the beam
of electrons comes across a thin sheet of
Example 14.5: A student, weighing 45 kg,
is running with a speed of 8 km per hr on a
foot path 2 m wide. A small car, weighing
1200 kg, is moving with a speed of 60 km
per hr on a 20 m wide road. Calculate their
de Broglie wavelengths.
Solution : Given
graphite. The electrons are diffracted by v1 = 8 km / hr = 8 × 103 /3600 m / s and
the atomic layers in the graphite and form m1 = 45 kg for the student,
diffraction rings on the phosphor screen. By v2 = 60 km / hr = 60 × 103 /3600 m / s and
changing the voltage between the cathode m2 = 1200 kg for the car,
and anode, the energy, and therefore the momentum p1 = 45 × 8 × 103 /3600
speed, of the electrons can be changed. This = 100 kg m /s for the student and
will change the wavelength of the electrons momentum p2 = 1200 × 60 × 103 /3600
and a change will be seen in the diffraction = 20000 kg m /s for the car.
pattern. By increasing the voltage, the The de Broglie wavelength
radius of the diffraction rings will λ1 = h/p1 = 6.63 × 10-34 J s / 100 kg m /s
decrease. Try to explain why? = 6.63 × 10-36 m. for the student, and
de Broglie wavelength
14.7 Wave-Particle Duality of Matter: λ2 = h/p2 = 6.63 × 10-34 J s/ 20000 kg m /s)
Material particles show wave-like nature = 3.32 × 10-38 m for the car.
under certain circumstances. This phenomenon
is known as wave-particle duality of matter. The wavelengths calculated in example
Frequency ω and wave number k are used 14.5 are negligible compared to the size of
to describe waves in classical theories while the moving objects as well as to the widths
mass m and momentum p are used to describe of the paths on which the objects are moving.
319
Therefore the wavelengths associated with obstacles, or are not measurable, we can use
macroscopic particles do not play any Newtonian mechanics.
significant role in our everyday life and we In conclusion, for both electromagnetic
need not consider their wave nature. Also the radiation and atomic and sub-atomic particles,
wavelengths for macroscopic particles are so particle nature is dominant during their
small that they cannot be measured. interaction with matter. On the other hand,
On the other hand, if we try to estimate the while traveling through space, particularly
associated de Broglie wavelength of a moving when their confinement is of same order of
electron passing through a small aperture of magnitude as their associated wavelength, the
size 10-10 m or an oxygen molecule in air, we wave nature is dominant.
will find it to be significant as can be seen in
the following example. Do you know?
Example 14.6: Calculate the de Broglie We have seen earlier that electrons are
wavelength of an electron moving with bound inside a metal surface and need
kinetic energy of 100 eV passing through a some minimum energy equal to the work
circular hole of diameter 2 Å. function to be knocked off from the surface.
Solution: Given This energy, if provided by any means, can
EK = 100 eV = 100 × 1.6 × 10-19 J. make the electron come out of the metal
The speed of the electron is given by the surface. Physical ways to provide this
1
relation mv2 = 100 × 1.6 × 10-19 J. energy differentiate the physical processes
2
involved and accordingly different devices
2 100 1.6 10 19 J
∴v= and characterizing microscopes based on
9.11 10 31 kg them have been designed by scientists.
= 0.593 × 107 m/s and • Thermionic emission : By heating to
momentum p = 9.11 × 10-31 kg × temperatures ~2000 ºC provide thermal
0.593 × 107 m/s = 5.40 × 10-24 kg m/s energy.
∴ the de Broglie wavelength λ = h/p • Field emission : By establishing strong
= 6.63 × 10-34 J s / 5.40 × 10-24 kg m/s electric fields ~106 V/m at the surface
= 1.23 × 10-10 m = 1.23 Å. of a metal tip, provide electrical energy.
The wavelength of the electron in above • Photo-electron emission : By shining
example is comparable to the size of the hole radiation of suitable frequency
through which the electron is passing. The (ultraviolet or visible) on a metal
wavelength associated with this electron is
surface provide light energy.
same as the size of a helium atom and more
Electron microscope:
than double the size of a hydrogen atom.
You have learnt about resolving
Use your brain power power and resolution of telescopes and
microscopes that use the ordinary visible
On what scale or under which circumstances light. The resolution of a microscope is
is the wave nature of matter apparent? limited by the wavelength of the light
Photon picture allows transfer of energy used. The shorter the wavelength of the
and momentum in the same manner as in characterizing probe, the smaller is the
Newtonian mechanics. Wave nature does
limit of resolution of a microscope, i.e., the
not modify that. Whenever wavelengths are
small compared to the dimensions of slits or resolution of microscope is better. Better
320
resolution can be attained by illuminating on the cover page of this book shows tiny
the objects to be seen by radiation of smaller crystals of dimensions less than 50 nm.
wavelengths. We have seen that an electron An electron diffraction pattern is also
can behave as a wave and its wavelength is seen on the cover page (spot pattern).
much smaller than the wavelength of visible When an electron beam passes through
light. The wavelength can be made much a crystal having periodic arrangement of
smaller as it depends on the velocity and atoms, diffraction occurs. The crystal acts
kinetic energy of the electron. An electron as a collection of diffraction slits for the
beam accelerated to several keV of energy electron beam.
will correspond to de Broglie wavelength
much smaller than an angstrom, i.e., Internet my friend
λe<< 1×10-10 m. The resolution of this
electron microscope will be several hundred
1. h t t p : / / p h e t - w e b . c o l o r a d o . e d u /
times higher than that obtainable with an
simulations/schrodinger/dg.jnlp
optical microscope.
2. https://physics.info/photoelectric/
Other advantages of electron
3. https://www.britannica.com/science/
microscopes are that (i) electrons do not
photoelectric-effect
penetrate the matter as visible light or
4. https://www.britannica.com/science/
X-rays do, (ii) electron beams can be more
wave-particle-duality
easily produced and controlled by electric
5. https://www.sciencedaily.com/terms/
and magnetic fields than electromagnetic
wave-particle_duality.htm
waves and (iii) electrons can be focused
6. h t t p s : / / w w w . t h o u g h t c o . c o m / d e -
like light is focused with lenses.
broglie-hypothesis-2699351
It was proposed in 1925 that atoms in
7. https://www.toppr.com/guides/physics/
the solids can act as diffraction centers for
dual-nature-of-radiation-and-matter
electron waves and can give information
8. http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
about the geometry or structure of solid,
hbase/quantum/DavGer2.html
just as X-rays do on getting diffracted by
solids. However, it took many years to
realize an electron microscope for practical
applications. The first electron microscope
was developed by Herald Ruska in Berlin,
Germany in the year 1929.
Microscopic objects, when illuminated
using electron beams, yield high resolution
images. Images of microscopic and
nanometric objects and even of viruses
have been obtained by scientists using
electron microscopes, making valuable
contributions to mankind.
Transmission electron microscopy can
resolve very small particles. A micrograph
321
Exercises
322
the charge of an electron is 1.6 × 10-19 C, Incident wavelength 2536 3650
find the value of the Planck’s constant h. (in Å)
[Ans : 6.56×10-34 J s] Stopping potential 1.95 0.5
9. The threshold wavelength of tungsten (in V)
is 2.76 × 10-5 cm. (a) Explain why no [Ans: 6.42 × 10-34 J s, 2.80 eV,
photoelectrons are emitted when the 6.76 × 1014 Hz, 4440 Å, calcium]
wavelength is more than 2.76 × 10-5 cm. 13. Calculate the wavelength associated with
(b) What will be the maximum kinetic an electron, its momentum and speed
energy of electrons ejected in each of the (a) when it is accelerated through a potential
following cases (i) if ultraviolet radiation of 54 V,
of wavelength λ = 1.80 × 10-5 cm and [Ans: 0.167 nm, 39.70 ×10-25 kg m s-1,
(ii) radiation of frequency 4×1015 Hz is 4.36 ×106 m s-1]
made incident on the tungsten surface. (b) when it is moving with kinetic energy of
[Ans: 2.40 eV, 12.07 eV] 150 eV.
10. Photocurrent recorded in the micro [Ans: 0.100 nm, 66.13×10-25 kg m s-1,
ammeter in an experimental set-up of 7.26 ×106 m s-1 ]
photoelectric effect vanishes when the 14. The de Broglie wavelengths associated
retarding potential is more than 0.8 V if with an electron and a proton are same.
the wavelength of incident radiation is What will be the ratio of (i) their momenta
4950 Å. If the source of incident radiation (ii) their kinetic energies?
is changed, the stopping potential turns [Ans: 1, 1836]
out to be 1.2 V. Find the work function of 15. Two particles have the same de Broglie
the cathode material and the wavelength wavelength and one is moving four times
of the second source. as fast as the other. If the slower particle
[Ans: 1.71 eV, 4270 Å] is an α-particle, what are the possibilities
11. Radiation of wavelength 4500 Å is for the other particle?
incident on a metal having work function [Ans: proton or neutron]
2.0 eV. Due to the presence of a magnetic 16. What is the speed of a proton having de
field B, the most energetic photoelectrons Broglie wavelength of 0.08 Å?
emitted in a direction perpendicular to [Ans: 49.57 × 103 m s-1]
the field move along a circular path of 17. In nuclear reactors, neutrons travel with
radius 20 cm. What is the value of the energies of 5 × 10-21 J. Find their speed
magnetic field B? and wavelength.
[Ans. : 1.47 × 10-5 T] [Ans: 2.45 × 103 m s-1, 1.62 Å]
12. Given the following data for incident 18. Find the ratio of the de Broglie
wavelength and the stopping potential wavelengths of an electron and a proton
obtained from an experiment on when both are moving with the (a) same
photoelectric effect, estimate the value of speed, (b) same energy and (c) same
Planck’s constant and the work function momentum? State which of the two will
of the cathode material. What is the have the longer wavelength in each case?
threshold frequency and corresponding [Ans: (a) 1836, (b) electron; 42.85,
wavelength? What is the most likely electron; (c) 1, equal]
metal used for emitter?
323
15. Structure of Atoms and Nuclei
326
15.6. Bohr’s Atomic Model: The positive integer n is called the principal
Niels Bohr modified Rutherford’s model quantum number of the electron. The
by applying ideas of quantum physics which centripetal force necessary for the circular
were being developed at that time. He realized motion of the electron is provided by the
that Rutherford’s model is essentially correct electrostatic force of attraction between the
and all that it needs is stability of the orbits. electron and the nucleus. Assuming the atomic
Also, the electrons in these stable orbits should number (number of electrons) of the atom to be
not emit electromagnetic waves as required by Z, the total positive charge on the nucleus is Ze
classical (Maxwell’s) electromagnetic theory. and we can write,
He made three postulates which defined his me v n2 Ze 2
--- (15.3)
atomic model. These are given below. rn 4 0 rn2
1. The electrons revolve around the nucleus Here, ε 0 is the permeability of vacuum and e
in circular orbits. is the electron charge. Eliminating vn from the
This is the same assumption as in Eq.(15.2) and Eq.(15.3), we get,
Rutherford’s model and the centripetal force me n 2 h 2 Ze 2
necessary for the circular motion is provided =
4π 2 me 2 rn3 4 0 rn2
by the electrostatic force of attraction between n 2 h 2 0
the electron and the nucleus. ∴ rn --- (15.4)
me Ze 2
2. The radius of the orbit of an electron can Similarly, eliminating rn from Eq.(15.2) and
only take certain fixed values such that the Eq.(15.3), we get,
angular momentum of the electron in these Ze 2
orbits is an integral multiple of h/2π, h being vn --- (15.5)
2 0 h n
the Planck’s constant. Equation (15.4) shows that the radius of
Such orbits are called stable orbits or
the orbit is proportional to n 2 , i.e., the
stable states of the electrons and electrons
square of the principal quantum number.
in these orbits do not emit radiation as is
The radius increases with increase in n. The
demanded by classical physics. Thus, different
orbits have different and definite values of hydrogen atom has only one electron, i.e., Z
angular momentum and therefore, different is 1. Substituting the values of the constants
values of energies. h, ε0, m and e in Eq.(15.4), we get, for n = 1,
3. An electron can make a transition from r1 = 0.053 nm. This is called the Bohr radius
and is denoted by a0 = h 0 .
2
one of its orbit to another orbit having lower
energy. In doing so, it emits a photon of me e 2
energy equal to the difference in its energies This is the radius of the smallest orbit of the
in the two orbits. electron in hydrogen atom. From Eq. (15.4),
15.6.1. Radii of the Orbits: we can write,
Using first two postulates we can study rn = a 0 n 2 --- (15.6)
the entire dynamics of the circular motion of
Example 15.1: Calculate the radius of the
the electron, including its energy. Let the mass
3rd orbit of the electron in hydrogen atom.
of the electron be me, its velocity in the nth
stable orbit be vn and the radius of its orbit be Solution: The radius of nth orbit is given by
rn. The angular momentum is then mevnrn and rn = a 0 n 2 . Thus, the radius of the third orbit
according to the second postulate above, we (n = 3) is
can write r3 a 0 32 9a 0 9 0.053 nm
h = 0.477 nm.
mevn rn n --- (15.2)
2
327
Example 15.2: In a Rutherford scattering The negative value of the energy of the
experiment, assume that an incident alpha electron indicates that the electron is bound
particle (radius 1.80 fm) is moving directly inside the atom and it has to be given energy
toward a target gold nucleus (radius 6.23 so as to make the total energy zero, i.e., to
fm). If the alpha particle stops right at the make the electron free from the nucleus. The
surface of the gold nucleus, how much energy increases (becomes less negative) with
energy did it have to start with? increase in n. Substituting the values of the
Solution: Initially when the alpha particle constants m,e,h and ε 0 in the above equation,
is far away from the gold nucleus, its total we get
energy is equal to its kinetic energy. As Z2
En 13.6 2 eV --- (15.8)
it comes closer to the nucleus, more and n
more of its kinetic energy gets converted to The first orbit ( n = 1) which has minimum
potential energy. By the time it reaches the energy, is called the ground state of the atom.
surface of the nucleus, its kinetic energy is Orbits with higher values of n and therefore,
completely converted into potential energy higher values of energy are called the excited
and it stops moving. Thus, the initial kinetic states of the atom. If the electron is in the nth
energy K, of the alpha particle is equal to the orbit, it is said to be in the nth energy state.
potential energy when it is at the surface of For hydrogen atom (Z = 1) the energy of the
the nucleus, i.e., when the distance between electron in its ground state is -13.6 eV and the
the gold nucleus and the alpha particle is energies of the excited states increase as given
equal to the radius of the gold nucleus.
by Eq.(15.8). The energy levels of hydrogen
∴ K 1 2e Ze , where, Z is the atomic atom are shown in Fig.15.4. The energies of
4 0 r1 r2 the levels are given in eV.
number of gold and r1 and r2 are the radii
of the gold nucleus and alpha particle
respectively. For gold Z = 79.
1 2 Ze 2
K
4 0 r1 r2
2
2 79 1.6 10 19
9 10
9
in terms of the wavelength as For the first three lines in the series, m = 4,
1 me Z 2 e 4 1 1 5 and 6. Substituting in the above formula
3 2
2 ---(15.9)
8c 0 h n m we get,
Here c is the velocity of light in vacuum. 1 1 1
1.097 107 2 2
We define a constant called the Rydberg’s 1 3 4
constant, RH as 1.097 107 7 / ( 9 16 )
me e 4
RH = = 1.097 × 107 m–1. ---(15.10) 0.0533 107 m 1
8c ε 0 h 3
1 1.876 x 10-6 m
In terms of R, the wavelength is given by
1 1 1 1 1 1
RH Z 2 2 2 ---(15.11) 1.097 10
7 2 2
n m 2 3 5
This is called the Rydberg’s formula. 1 .097 107 16 / ( 9 25)
Remember that for hydrogen Z is 1. Thus, 0.075 107 m 1
Eq.(15.11) correctly describes the observed
2 1.282 10 6 m
spectrum of hydrogen as given by Eq.(15.1).
1 1 1
1.097 10
7 2 2
Example 15.3: Determine the energies of 3 3 6
the first two excited states of the electron 1 .097 107 27 / ( 9 36 )
in hydrogen atom. What are the excitation
energies of the electrons in these orbits? 0.0914 107 m 1
Solution: The energy of the electron in the 3 1.094 10 6 m
nth orbit is given by E 13.6 1 eV.
n
n2
329
15.6.3. Limitations of Bohr’s Model:
Even though Bohr’s model seemed to
explain hydrogen spectrum, it had a few
shortcomings which are listed below.
(i) It could not explain the line spectra
of atoms other than hydrogen. Even
for hydrogen, more accurate study of
the observed spectra showed multiple
components in some lines which could not
be explained on the basis of this model. Fig. 15.5: Standing electron wave for the 4th
orbit of an electron in an atom.
(ii) The intensities of the emission lines
2 rn n n , n = 1,2,3….., giving
seemed to differ from line to line and
2 rn
Bohr’s model had no explanation for that. n --- (15.12)
n
(iii) On theoretical side also the model was The de Broglie wavelength is related to the
not entirely satisfactory as it arbitrarily linear momentum pn ,of the particle by
assumed orbits following a particular h h .
n
condition to be stable. There was no pn mv n
theoretical basis for that assumption. Substituting this in Eq. (15.12) gives,
A full quantum mechanical study is hn
pn .
required for the complete understanding of the 2 rn
structure of atoms which is beyond the scope Thus, the angular momentum of the electron in
of this book. Some reasoning for the third nth orbit, Ln, can be written as
h
shortcoming (i.e., theoretical basis for the Ln pn rn n , which is the second
second postulate in Bohr’s atomic model) was 2
postulate of Bohr’s atomic model. Therefore,
given by de Broglie which we consider next.
considering electrons as waves gives some
15.6.4 De Broglie’s Explanation:
theoretical basis for the second postulate made
We have seen in Chapter 14 that material by Bohr.
particles also have dual nature like that for 15.7. Atomic Nucleus:
light and there is a wave associated with every 15.7.1 Constituents of a Nucleus:
material particle. De Broglie suggested that The atomic nucleus is made up of
instead of considering the orbiting electrons subatomic, meaning smaller than an atom,
inside atoms as particles, we should view particles called protons and neutrons.
them as standing waves. Similar to the case Together, protons and neutrons are referred
of standing waves on strings or in pipes as to as nucleons. Mass of a proton is about
studied in Chapter 6, the length of the orbit of 1836 times that of an electron. Mass of a
an electron has to be an integral multiple of its neutron is nearly same as that of a proton but
wavelength. Thus, the length of the first orbit is slightly higher. The proton is a positively
will be equal to one de Broglie wavelength, λ1 charged particle. The magnitude of its charge
of the electron in that orbit, that of the second is equal to the magnitude of the charge of an
orbit will be twice the de Broglie wavelength electron. The neutron, as the name suggests,
of the electron in that orbit and so on. This is is electrically neutral. The number of protons
shown for the 4th orbit in Fig.(15.5) in an atom is called its atomic number and
In general, we can write, is designated by Z. The number of electrons
330
in an atom is also equal to Z. Thus, the total proton and neutron, me , mp and mn respectively,
positive and total negative charges in an atom in this unit are:
are equal in magnitude and the atom as a me = 9.109383 × 10-31 kg
whole is electrically neutral. The number of mp = 1.672623 × 10-27 kg
neutrons in a nucleus is written as N. The total mn = 1.674927 × 10-27 kg
number of nucleons in a nucleus is called the Obviously, kg is not a convenient unit
mass number of the atom and is designated by to measure masses of atoms or subatomic
A = Z + N. The mass number determines the particles which are extremely small compared
mass of a nucleus and of the atom. The atoms of to one kg. Therefore, another unit called the
an element X are represented by the symbol for unified atomic mass unit (u) is used for the
the element and its atomic and mass numbers purpose. One u is equal to 1/12th of the mass
A
as Z X . For example, symbols for hydrogen, of a neutral carbon atom having atomic
carbon and oxygen atoms are written as 11 H , number 12, in its lowest electronic state. 1 u =
12 16
6 C and 8 O . The chemical properties of an 1.6605402 × 10-27 kg. In this unit, the masses
atom are decided by the number of electrons of the above three particles are
present in it, i.e., by Z. me = 0.00055 u
The number of protons and electrons in mp = 1.007825 u
the atoms of a given element are fixed. For mn = 1.008665 u.
example, hydrogen atom has one proton and The third unit for measuring masses of
one electron, carbon atom has six protons atoms and subatomic particles is in terms of
and six electrons. The number of neutrons in the amount of energy that their masses are
the atoms of a given element can vary. For equivalent to. According to Einstein’s famous
example, hydrogen nucleus can have zero, one mass-energy relation, a particle having
or two neutrons. These varieties of hydrogen mass m is equivalent to an amount of energy
are referred to as 11 H , 12 H and 13 H and are E = mc2. The unit used to measure masses in
respectively called hydrogen, deuterium and terms of their energy equivalent is the eV/c2.
tritium. Atoms having the same number of One atomic mass unit is equal to 931.5 MeV/
protons but different number of neutrons are c2. The masses of the three particles in this unit
called iosotopes. Thus, deuterium and tritium are
are isotopes of hydrogen. They have the same me = 0.511 MeV/c2
chemical properties as those of hydrogen. mp = 938.28 MeV/c2
Similarly, helium nucleus can have one or two mn = 939.57 MeV/c2
neutrons and are referred as 32 He and 42 He . 15.7.2. Sizes of Nuclei:
The atoms having the same mass number A, The size of an atom is decided by the sizes
are called isobars. Thus, 13 H and 32 He are of the orbits of the electrons in the atom. Larger
isobars. Atoms having the same number of the number of electrons in an atom, higher
neutrons but different values of atomic number are the orbits occupied by them and larger is
Z, are called iosotones. Thus, 13 H and 42 He the size of the atom. Similarly, all nuclei do
are isotones. not have the same size. Obviously, the size of
Units for measuring masses of atoms and a nucleus depends on the number of nucleons
subatomic particles present in it, i.e., on its atomic number A. From
Masses of atoms and subatomic particles experimental observations it has been found that
are measured in three different units. First unit the radius RX of a nucleus X is related to A as
1
337
of fuel, the nuclear energy released is about a
constants are λp and λd respectively. What
million times that released through chemical
condition needs to be satisfied in order for
reactions. However, nuclear energy generation
Nd to remain constant?
is a very complex and expensive process and
Solution: The number of parent nuclei
it can also be extremely harmful. Let us learn
decaying between time 0 and dt, for small
more about it.
values of dt is given by N p λp dt . This is
We have seen in section 15.8 that the
the number of daughter nuclei produced
mass of a nucleus is smaller than the sum
in time dt. The number of daughter nuclei of masses of its constituents. The difference
decaying in the same interval is N d λd dt . in these two masses is the binding energy of
For the number of daughter nuclei to remain the nucleus. It would be the energy released
constant, these two quantities, i.e., the if the nucleus is formed by bringing together
number of daughter nuclei produced in time its constituents from infinity. This energy
dt and the number decaying in time dt have is large (in MeV), and this process can be a
to be equal. Thus, the required condition is good source of energy. In practice, we never
given by form nuclei starting from individual nucleons.
N p p dt N d d dt , However, we can obtain nuclear energy by
or, N p p N d d two other processes (i) nuclear fission in which
15.11. Nuclear Energy: a heavy nucleus is broken into two nuclei of
You are familiar with the naturally smaller masses and (ii) nuclear fusion in which
two light nuclei undergo nuclear reaction and
occurring, conventional sources of energy.
fuse together to form a heavier nucleus. Both
These include the fossil fuels, i.e., coal,
fission and fusion are nuclear reactions. Let us
petroleum, natural gas, and fire wood. The
understand how nuclear energy is released in
energy generation from these fuels is through
the two processes.
chemical reactions. It takes millions of years
15.11.1. Nuclear Fission:
for these fuels to form. Naturally, the supply
We have seen in Fig.15.6 that the binding
of these conventional sources is limited and
energy per nucleon (EB/A) depends on the mass
with indiscriminate use, they are bound to
number of the nuclei. This quantity is a measure
get over in a couple of hundred years from
of the stability of the nucleus. As seen from the
now. Therefore, we have to use alternative
figure, the middle weight nuclei (mass number
sources of energy. The ones already in use are
ranging from 50 to 80) have highest binding
hydroelectric power, solar energy, wind energy
energy per nucleon and are most stable, while
and nuclear energy, nuclear energy being the
nuclei with higher and lower atomic masses
largest source among these.
have smaller values of EB/A. The value of
Nuclear energy is the energy released
EB/A goes on decreasing till A~238 which is
when nuclei undergo a nuclear reaction,
the mass number of the heaviest naturally
i.e., when one nucleus or a pair of nuclei,
occurring element which is uranium. Many of
due to their interaction, undergo a change
the heavy nuclei are unstable and decay into
in their structure resulting in new nuclei and
two smaller mass nuclei.
generating energy in the process. While the
Let us consider a case when a heavy
energy generated in chemical reactions is of
nucleus, say with A ~230, breaks into two
the order of few eV per reaction, the amount of
nuclei having A between 50 and 150. The EB/A
energy released in a nuclear reaction is of the
of the product nuclei will be higher than that
order of a few MeV. Thus, for the same weight
338
of the parent nucleus. This means that the in a controlled manner to produce energy
combined masses of the two product nuclei in the form heat which is then converted to
will be smaller than the mass of the parent electricity. In a uranium reactor, 235
92 U
is used
nucleus. The difference in the mass of the as the fuel. It is bombarded by slow neutrons to
parent nucleus and that of the product nuclei produce 23692 U
which undergoes fission.
taken together will be released in the form of
energy in the process. This process in which a Example 15.12: Calculate the energy
heavy nucleus breaks into two lighter nuclei released in the reaction
with the release of energy is called nuclear
236
92 U
→ 137 97
53 I + 39 Y + 2n
.
fission and is a source of nuclear energy. The masses of 92 U , 137
236 97
53 I and 39 Y
are
One of the nuclei used in nuclear energy 236.04557, 136.91787 and 96.91827
generation by fusion is 236 respectively.
92 U
. This has a half-
7
life of 2.3 x 10 years and an activity of 6.5 x Solution: Energy released is given by
10-5 Ci/g. However, it being fissionable, most Q = [mU – mI – mY – 2mn]c2
of its nuclei have already decayed and it is = [236.04557 – 136.91787 –
not found in nature. More than 99% of natural 96.91827 -2 x 1.00865] c2
uranium is in the form of 238 92 U and less than
= 0.19011 × 931.5 MeV
1% is in the form of 92 U . 238
235 = 177.0875 MeV
92 U
also decays,
3
but its half-life is about 10 times higher than Chain Reaction:
that of 23692 U
and is therefore not very useful Neutrons are produced in the fission
for energy generation. The species needed for reaction shown in Eq. (15.31). Some reactions
nuclear energy generation, i.e., 236 92 U
can be produce 2 neutrons while others produce 3 or
obtained from the naturally occurring 235 92 U
4 neutrons. The average number of neutrons
by bombarding it with slow neutrons. 235 92 U
per reaction can be shown to be 2.7. These
absorbs a neutron and yields 236 92 U
. This neutrons are in turn absorbed by other 235 92 U
235
reaction can be written as 92 U + n→ 236 92 U
. nuclei to produce 236
92 U
which undergo fission
236
92 U
can undergo fission in several ways and produce further 2.7 neutrons per fission.
producing different pairs of daughter nuclei This can have a cascading effect and the
and generating different amounts of energy in number of neutrons produced and therefore the
the process. Some of its decays are number of 23692 U
nuclei produced can increase
236
92 U
→ 137 97
53 I + 39 Y + 2n
quickly. This is called a chain reaction. Such
236
92 U
→ 140 94
56 Ba + 36 Kr + 2n
a reaction will lead to a fast increase in the
236
→ 133 Sb + 99 Nb + 4n --- (15.31) number of fissions and thereby in a rapid
92 U 51 41
Some of the daughter nuclei produced are increase in the amount of energy produced.
not stable and they further decay to produce This will lead to an explosion. In a nuclear
more stable nuclei. The energy produced in the reactor, methods are employed to stop a chain
fission is in the form of kinetic energy of the reaction from occurring and fission and energy
products, i.e., in the form of heat which can generation is allowed to occur in a controlled
be collected and converted to other forms of fashion. The energy generated, which is in the
energy as needed. form of heat, is carried away and converted to
Uranium Nuclear Reactor: electricity by using turbines etc.
A nuclear reactor is an apparatus or a More than 15 countries have nuclear
device in which nuclear fission is carried out reactors and use nuclear power. India is one of
them. There are 22 nuclear reactors in India,
339
the largest one being at Kudankulam, Tamil Nuclear fusion is taking place all the
Nadu. Maximum nuclear power is generated time in the universe. It mostly takes place at
by the USA. the centres of stars where the temperatures are
15.11.2. Nuclear Fusion: high enough for nuclear reactions to take place.
We have seen that light nuclei (A < 40) There, light nuclei fuse into heavier nuclei
have lower EB/A as compared to heavier ones. generating energy in the process. Nuclear
If any two of the lighter nuclei come sufficiently fusion is in fact the source of energy for stars.
close, within about one fm of each other, then Most of the elements heavier than boron till
they can undergo nuclear reaction and form a iron, that we see around us today have been
heavier nucleus. The heavier nucleus will have produced through nuclear fusion inside stars.
higher EB/A than the reactants. The mass of the
product nucleus will therefore be lower than the Do you know?
total mass of the reactants, and energy of the
order of MeV will be released in the process. Light elements, i.e., deuterium, helium,
This process wherein two nuclei fuse together lithium, beryllium and boron, have not been
to form a heavier nucleus accompanied by a created inside stars, but are believed to have
release of nuclear energy is called nuclear been created within the first 200 second
fusion. in the life of the universe, i.e., within 200
For a nuclear reaction to take place, seconds of the big bang which marked the
it is necessary for two nuclei to come to beginning of the universe. The temperature
within about 1 fm of each other so that they at that time was very high and some
can experience the nuclear forces. It is very nuclear reactions could take place. After
difficult for two atoms to come that close to about 200 s, the temperature decreased and
each other due to the electrostatic repulsion nuclear reactions were no longer possible.
between the electrons of the two atoms. This
problem can be solved by stripping the atoms The temperature at the centre of the Sun is
of their electrons and producing bare nuclei. about 107 K. The nuclear reactions taking place
It is possible to do so by giving the electrons at the centre of the Sun are the fusion of four
energies larger than the ionization potentials hydrogen nuclei, i.e., protons to form a helium
of the atoms by heating a gas of atoms. But nucleus. Of course, because of the electrostatic
even after this, the two bare nuclei find it repulsion and the values of densities at the
very difficult to go near each other due to the centre of the Sun, it is extremely unlikely
repulsive force between their positive charges. that four protons will come sufficiently close
For nuclear fusion to occur, we have to heat to one another at a given time so that they
the gas to very high temperature thereby can combine to form helium. Instead, the
providing the nuclei with very high kinetic fusion proceeds in several steps. The effective
energies. These high energies can help them to reaction can be written as
overcome the electrostatic repulsion and come 4 p → α + 2e+ + neutrinos + 26.7 MeV.
close to one another. As the positive charge These reactions have been going on inside
of a nucleus goes on increasing with increase the Sun since past 4.5 billion years and are
in its atomic number, the kinetic energies of expected to continue for similar time period in
the nuclei, i.e., the temperature of the gas the future. At the centres of other stars where
necessary for nuclear fusion to occur goes on temperatures are higher, nuclei heavier than
increasing with increase in Z. hydrogen can fuse generating energy.
340
tested such nuclear devices. America remains
Do you know? the only country to have actually used two
atom bombs which completely destroyed the
The fusion inside stars can only take place cities of Hiroshima and Nagasaki in Japan in
between nuclei having mass number smaller
early August 1945.
than that of iron, i.e., 56. The reason for
this is that iron has the highest EB/A value Do you know?
among all elements as seen from Fig.15.6.
If an iron nucleus fuses into another
nucleus, the atomic number of the resulting We have seen that the activity of radioactive
nucleus will be higher than that of iron and material decreases exponentially with time.
hence it will have smaller EB/A. The mass Other examples of exponential decay are
of the resultant nucleus will hence be larger • Amplitude of a simple pendulom decays
than the sum of masses of the reactants exponentially as A =A0 e-bt, where b is
and energy will have to be supplied to the damping factor.
reactants for the reaction to take place. • Cooling of an object in an open
The elements heavier than iron which are surrounding is exponential. Temperature
present in the universe are produced via θ = θ 0e-kt where k depends upon the
other type of nuclear reaction which take object and the surrounding.
place during stellar explosions. • Discharging of a capacitor through a
pure resistor is exponential. Charge Q
on the capacitor at a given instant is
Example 15.13: Calculate the energy
Q = Q0 e-[t/RC] where RC is called time
released in the fusion reaction taking place
constant.
inside the Sun, 4 p → α + 2e+ + neutrinos,
• Charging of a capacitor is also
neglecting the energy given to the neutrinos. exponential but, it is called exponential
Mass of alpha particle being 4.001506 u. growth.
Solution: The energy released in the process,
ignoring the energy taken by the neutrinos is
given by Internet my friend
Q 4 mp m 2 me c 2
,
Q 4 1.00728 4.001506 2 0.00055 c 2 1. https://www.siyavula.com/read/
science/grade-10/the-atom/04-the-
0.026514 931.5 24.698 MeV
atom-02
The discussion on nuclear energy will not 2. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Bohr_
be complete without mentioning its harmful model
3. http://hyperphysics.phy-astr.gsu.edu/
effects. If an uncontrolled chain reaction sets
hbase/quantum/atomstructcon.html
up in a nuclear fuel, an extremely large amount
4. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Atomic_
of energy can be generated in a very short
nucleus
time. This fact has been used to produce what 5. h t t p s : / / e n . w i k i p e d i a . o r g / w i k i /
are called atom bombs or nuclear devices. Radioactive_decay
Either fission alone or both fission and fusion
are used in these bombs. The first such devices
were made towards the end of the second world
war by America. By now, several countries
including India have successfully made and
341
Exercises
343
16. Semiconductor Devices
AC
16.1: Block diagram simple rectifier circuit with respective output wave form. Describe the wave forms.
344
Hence a DC output voltage obtained
across RL is in the form of alternate pulses.
16.2.2 Full Wave Rectifier:
As discussed in the previous section, the
output of a half wave rectifier is available
only in alternate positive half cycles of the AC
input. All negative half cycles are lost and the
Fig. 16.2: Circuit diagram of a half wave efficiency of a half wave rectifier is very poor.
rectifier. Therefore, a rectifier circuit using two diodes
The secondary coil AB of a transformer is more useful.
is connected in series with a diode D and the In a full wave rectifier, current flows
load resistance RL. The use of transformer has through the load in the same direction during
both the half cycles of input AC voltage.
two advantages. First, it allows us to step up
This is because, the full wave rectifier circuit
or step down the AC input voltage as per the
consists of two diodes conducting alternately.
requirement of the circuit, and second it isolates
Figure 16.4 shows typical circuit of a full wave
the rectifier circuit from the mains supply rectifier. The circuit consists of a centre tapped
to reduce the risk of electric shock. The AC transformer and diodes D1 and D2.
voltage across the secondary coil AB changes
its polarities after every half cycle. When the
positive half cycle begins, the voltage at the
point A is at higher potential with respect to
that at the point B, therefore, the diode (D) is
forward biased. It conducts (works as a closed
Fig. 16.4: Circuit diagram for full wave rectifier.
switch) and current flows through the circuit.
When the negative half cycle begins, the The diodes D1 and D2 are connected such
potential at the point A is lower with respect that D1 conducts in the positive half cycle
to that at the point B and the diode is reverse and D2 conducts in the negative half cycle
biased, therefore, it does not conduct (works as of the input voltage. During the positive half
cycle of the input voltage, the point A is at a
an open switch). No current passes through the
higher potential than that of the point B and
circuit. Hence, the diode conducts only in the
the diode D1 conducts. The current through the
positive half cycles of the AC input. It blocks
load resistance RL follows the path APQRC
the current during the negative half cycles. The as shown in Fig. 16.4. During the negative
waveform for input and output voltages are half cycle of the input voltage, point B is at
shown in Fig. 16.3. In this way, current always higher potential than point A and the diode
flows through the load RL in the same direction D2 conducts. The current through the load
for alternate positive half cycles. resistance RL follows the path BPQRC. Thus,
the current flowing through the load resistance
is in the same direction during both the cycles.
The input and output waveforms of a full
wave rectifier are shown in Fig. 16.5. First
waveform is input AC. The second wave form
shows the output when the diode D1 conducts
Fig. 16.3: Waveform of input and output signals and the third waveform shows the output
for half wave rectifier. when diode D2 conducts. The fourth waveform
345
shows the total output waveform of the full 16.2.3 Ripple Factor:
wave rectifier. The output of a rectifier consists of a
small fraction of an A C component along with
I DC called the ripple. This ripple is undesirable
and is responsible for the fluctuations in the
II rectifier output. Figure 16.6 (a) shows the
ripple in the output of a rectifier.
III The effectiveness of a rectifier depends
upon the magnitude of the ripple component
IV in its output. A smaller ripple means that the
rectifier is more effective.
Fig 16.5: Waveforms of input and output
signals for a full wave rectifier.
Voltage
Remember this
A full wave rectifier utilises both half
cycles of AC input voltage to produce the
time
DC output
Fig. 16.6 (a): Ripple in the output of a DC output.
346
diode first and then try to understand how it
can be used as a voltage regulator.
16.3 Special Purpose Junction Diodes:
In this section we will study some of the
common special purpose junction diodes such
as,
Fig. 16.6 (c): Output wave form ofter filtration. 1) Zener diode, 2) Photo diode, 3) Solar cell, 4)
Light Emitting Diode (LED).
A capacitor filter:
16.3.1 Zener Diode:
As shown in Fig. 16.6 (b), the pulsating
A Zener diode works on the principle
DC voltage of a rectifier output is applied
of junction breakdown. The other diodes
across the capacitor. As the voltage across the
mentioned above make use of photosensitivity,
capacitor rises, capacitor gets charged to point
a very important and useful property of
A and supplies current to the load resistance.
semiconductors.
At the end of quarter cycle, the capacitor gets
16.3 : Junction Break Down:
charged to the peak voltage shown as Vp in
In XIth Std. we have studied that when
Fig. 16.7 (c) of the rectified output voltage.
reverse bias voltage of an ordinary junction
Now, the rectifier voltage begins to decrease,
diode is increased beyond a critical voltage,
so that the capacitor starts discharging
the reverse current increases sharply to a high
through the load resistance and the voltage
value. This critical voltage is called reverse
across it begins to drop. Voltage across the
breakdown voltage. The diode is damaged at
load decreases only slightly, up to the point
this stage. We will now discuss what happens
B, because the next voltage peak recharges
when there is a junction breakdown.
the capacitor immediately. This process is
Electrical break down of any material
repeated again and again and the output
(metal, semiconductor or even insulator) can
voltage waveform takes the form shown in Fig
be due to 1) Avalanche breakdown or 2)
16.6 (c). This output is unregulated DC wave
Zener breakdown. We will discuss only the
form. Voltage, regulator circuits are used to
Zener breakdown in some details.
obtain regulated DC supply The capacitor
Zener Breakdown :
filter circuit is widely used because of its low When the reverse voltage across a p-n
cost, small size and light weight. This type of junction diode is increased, the electric field
filter is preferred for small load currents. It is across the junction increases. This results in a
commonly used in battery eliminators. force of attraction on the negatively charged
When a power supply is connected to a electrons at the junction. Covalent bonds which
load, it is noticed that there is a drop in the hold the semiconductor together are broken
output voltage. A power supply whose output due to this force and electrons are removed
changes when a load is connected across it is from the bonds. These free electrons are then
called unregulated power supply. When the available for electrical conduction and result
output of a power supply remains steady even in a large current. When the applied voltage is
after connecting a load across it, it is called a increased, the electric field across the junction
regulated power supply. There are many ways also increases and more and more electrons
in which a power supply can be regulated. A are removed from their covalent bonds. Thus,
commonly used voltage regulator circuit uses a net current is developed which increases
a Zener diode. We will now discuss a Zener rapidly with increase in the applied voltage.
347
Zener breakdown occurs in diodes which This property of the Zener diode is used in
are heavily doped. The depletion layer is a voltage regulator. The Zener voltage VZ
narrow in such diodes. Zener breakdown does depends upon the amount of doping. For a
not result in damage of a diode. heavily doped diode, the depletion layer is thin
Zener Diode Characteristic: and the breakdown occurs at a lower reverse
A Zener diode is a p-n junction diode voltage. A lightly doped diode has higher
designed to work in the breakdown region. breakdown voltage. The Zener diodes with
It is used as a voltage regulator or a voltage breakdown voltage of less than 6 V, operate
stabiliser. Figure 16.7 (a) shows the circuit mainly at Zener breakdown region. Those
symbol of a Zener diode. Its I-V characteristic with voltage greater the 6 V operate mainly
is shown in Fig. 16.7 (b). in avalanche breakdown region (not discussed
here) but both are called Zener diode.
Fig 16.7 (a): circuit Zener diode as a voltage regulator:
symbol of a Zener diode. When a Zener diode is operated in the
breakdown region, voltage across it remains
almost constant even if the current through it
changes by a large amount. A voltage regulator
maintains a constant voltage across a load
regardless of variations in the applied input
voltage and variations in the load current.
Figure 16.8 shows a typical circuit diagram of
a voltage regulator using a Zener diode.
Reverse
current
-200
through the junction. The magnitude of this
-300
current is constant for a certain range of
reverse bias voltages. This current is due to the -400
minority carriers on its either side.(Electrons
μA
are minority carriers in the p-region and the
holes are minority carriers in the p-region of Fig. 16.11: The I-V characteristic of a
a diode). The reverse current depends only photodiode.
on the concentration of the minority carriers The total current passing through a
and not on the applied voltage. This current photodiode is the sum of the photocurrent
is called the dark currant in a photodiode and the dark current. Figure 16.12 shows
because it flows even when the photodiode is the graphical relation between the reverse
not illuminated. Figure 16.10 schematically current of a photodiode and the intensity of
shows working of a photodiode. illumination incident on the photodiode. The
sensitivity of the device can be increased by
minimizing the dark current.
354
LED is fabricated in such a way that light produce light of different wavelengths. For
emitted is not reabsorbed into the material. It example, when LED is manufactured using
is ensured that the electron-hole recombination aluminium gallium arsenide (AlGaAs), it emits
takes place on the surface for maximum light infrared radiations. LED made using gallium
output. arsenic phosphide (GaAsP) produces either
red or yellow light, whereas LED made by
Do you know? using aluminium gallium phosphide (AlGaP)
emits red or green light and zinc selenide
LED junction does not actually emit that (ZnSe) produce blue light.
much light so the epoxy resin body is
constructed in such a way that the photons
emitted by the junction are reflected away
from the surrounding substrate base to
which the diode is attached and are focused
upwards through the domed top of the LED,
which itself acts like a lens concentrating
the light. This is why the emitted light
appears to be brightest at the top of the LED.
Working of a LED:
Figure 16.16 schematically shows the
emission of light when electron-hole pair Fig.16.17: Light Emitting Diode (LED) I-V
combines. When the diode is forward biased, Characteristic Curves showing different
electrons from the semiconductor's conduction colours available.
band recombine with holes from the valence
I-V Characteristics Light Emitting Diodes:
band releasing sufficient energy to produce
Figure 16.17 shows the I-V characteristic
photons which emit a monochromatic (single
of LED. It is similar to the forward
colour) light. Because of the thin layer, a
characteristic of an ordinary diode.
reasonable number of these photons can leave
the junction and emit coloured light. The Remember this
amount of light output is directly proportional
to the forward current. Thus, higher the forward The current rating of LED is of a few tens
current, higher is the light output. of milli-amps. Hence it is necessary to
connect a high resistance in series with it.
The forward voltage drop of an LED is
much larger than an ordinary diode and is
around 1.5 to 3.5 volts.
Advantages of LED:
LED is a solid state light source.
1. Energy efficient: More light output for
lesser electrical power. LEDs are now
capable of producing 135 lumens/watt
Fig. 16.16: Emission of light from LED
2. Long Lifetime: 50,000 hours or more if
LEDs are fabricated by using compound
properly manufactured.
semiconductors made with elements such as
3. Rugged: LEDs are also called Solid State
gallium, phosphorus and arsenic. By varying
Lights (SSL) as they are made of solid
the proportions of these elements in the
material with no filament or tube or bulb
semiconducting materials, it is possible to
to break.
355
4. Almost no warm up period. LEDs start Application of LED:
emitting light in nanoseconds. An LED is used in a variety of ways such
5. Excellent colour rendering: Colours as, burglar alarm system, counters, optical
produced by LED do not fade out making communication, indicator lamps in electric
them perfect for displays and retail equipment, display screen of a cell phone
applications. handset, LED television, vehicle head lamps,
6. Environment friendly LEDs do not contain domestic and decorative illumination, street
mercury or other hazardous substances. lighting.
7. Controllable: Brightness and colour of
light emitted by LEDs can be controlled Try this
B B
n-p-n p-n-p
Fig. 16.18: (c) Two-diode Analogy of a BJT . Fig. 16.19 (a): Biasing of n-p-n transistor.
Figure 16.19 (a) shows typical biasing
Emitter: It is a thick heavily doped layer. This circuit of a n-p-n transistor. At the instant the
supplies a large number of majority carriers forward bias is applied to the E-B junction,
for the current flow through the transistor electrons in the emitter region (n-type) have
Base: It is the thin, lightly doped central layer. not entered the base region (p-type) as shown
Collector: It is on the other side of the base. It in Fig. 16.19 (b).
is also thick and moderately doped layer. Its
area is larger than that of the emitter and the - +
base. This layer collects a major portion of the VEB VCB
majority carriers supplied by the emitter. The + -
collector also helps dissipation of any small
amount of heat generated. Fig. 16.19 (b): Majority carriers in emitter.
357
When the biasing voltage VBE is greater
than the barrier potential (0.6-0.7V for silicon Remember this
transistors, which are commonly used), The lightly doped, thin base region
many electrons enter the base region and sandwiched between the heavily doped
form the emitter current IE as shown in the
emitter region and the intermediate doped
Fig. 16. 19 (c).
collector region plays a crucial role in the
- + transistor action.
VCB
Transistor configuration:
VEB
- The possible configurations of transistor
+
in a circuit are, (a) Common Emitter, CE
Fig. 16.19 (c): Injection of majority carriers
into base.
(b) Common Base, CB and (c) Common
These electrons can now flow in two Collector, CC.
directions. They can either flow through the Common Emitter configuration
base circuit and constitute the base current The emitter of the transistor is common to
(IB), or they can also flow through the collector both the input and the output, Fig. 16.20 (a).
circuit and contribute towards the collector
current (IC). The base current is small (about
5% of IE) because the base is thin and also, it
is lightly doped.
The base of a transistor plays a crucial
role in its action. Electrons injected from the
Fig. 16.20 (a): Common emitter configuration.
emitter into the base diffuse into the collector-
base depletion region due to the thin base Common Base configuration
region. When the electrons enter the collector- The base of the transistor is common to
base depletion region, they are pushed into both the input and the output, Fig. 16.20 (b).
the collector region by the electric field at the
collector-base depletion region. The collector
current (IC) flow through the external circuit as
shown in Fig. 19.16 (d). The collector current
IC is about 95% of IE.
Fig. 16.20 (b): Common base configuration.
Majority of the electrons injected by the
Common Collector configuration
The collector of the transistor is common
to both the input and the output, Fig. 16.20 (c).
358
In the Common Emitter or grounded Since the electrical relationship between
emitter configuration, the input signal is these three currents IB, IC and IE is determined
applied between the base and the emitter, while by the physical construction of the transistor
the output is obtained between the collector itself, any small change in the base current
and the emitter as shown in the Fig. 16.21.
(IB), will result in a much larger change in the
IC collector current (IC). Thus, a small change
in current flowing in the base will control the
IB VCE
current in the emitter-collector circuit. Typical
Vin
IE RL Vout value of bDC is between 20 and 200 for most
general purpose transistors. So if a transistor
VBE has a bDC = 100, then one electron will flow
from the base terminal for every 100 electrons
Fig.16.21: The Common Emitter configuration.
The common emitter amplifier flowing between the emitter-collector terminal.
configuration, to be discussed in section 16.4.2 The Common Emitter (CE)
16.4.3, produces the highest current and characteristic:
power gain of all the three bipolar transistor A typical circuit used to study the common
configurations. This is mainly because the emitter (CE) characteristic is shown in the
input impedance is low as it is connected to a Fig. 16.22.
forward biased p-n junction, while the output
impedance is high as it is taken from a reverse
biased p-n junction.
In this type of configuration, the current
flowing out of the transistor must be equal to
the currents flowing into the transistor as the
emitter current is given by,
IE = IC + IB --- (16.1)
As the load resistance ( RL ) is connected
Fig. 16.22: Circuit to study Common Emitter
in series with the collector, the current gain of (CE) characteristic.
the common emitter transistor configuration The Input characteristics:
is quite large. The current gain is called the The variation of base current IB with
current amplification factor and is defined as base-emitter voltage, VBE , is called input
the ratio characteristic. While studying the dependence
bDC = IC/IB --- (16.2) of IB on VBE , the collector-emitter voltage VCE
Similarly, the ratio of the collector current is kept fixed. The characteristic is shown in the
and the emitter current is defined as Fig. 16.23.
aDC = IC/IE --- (16.3) As we can see from the figure, initially,
the current is very small till the barrier potential
The ratios aDC and bDC are related. is overcome. When the voltage VBE is more
From Eq. (16.1) and Eq. (16.2) we have, than the barrier potential, the characteristic is
IC = α IE = β IB --- (16.4) similar to that of a forward biased diode.
The input dynamic resistance ri of a
DC --- (16.5) transistor is defined as the ratio of the change
1 in the base-emitter voltage and the resulting
change in the base current at a constant
and DC --- (16.6) collector-base voltage.
1
359
V discuss an amplifier using an n-p-n transistor
ri BE --- (16.7) in common emitter configuration. Figure 16.25
I B
shows a typical circuit used for transistor
for VCE constant. amplifier.
IB A small sinusoidal input signal is
superimposed on the DC bias as shown in the
VCE=10V
Fig. 16.25. The base current IB and the collector
100 current IC will have these sinusoidal variations
80 superimposed on them. This causes the output
60 voltage VO also to change sinusoidally. A
40 capacitor is connected in the output circuit to
20
block the DC component. A load resistance RL
is connected in the collector circuit. Output is
VCE/V
0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 obtained across this resistance.
Fig. 16.23: The Input characteristics IC
The output characteristic of a transistor is
shown in the Fig. 16.24 RB B C RL
The variation of the collector current IB vo
IC with variation in the collector-emitter
E
VCE
~
voltage is called the output characteristic of
Vin ~ VBE IE
a transistor. The base current IB is constant at
this time. From the curve we can see that the,
collector current IC is independent of VCE as
Fig. 16.25: Typical transistor amplifier circuit.
long as the collector-emitter junction is reverse
Working of the amplifier:
biased. Also, the collector current IC is large
Let us discuss the working of the amplifier
for large values of the base current IB when VCE
when the input signal vi is not applied.
is constant.
Consider the output loop. We have, from the
The output dynamic resistance ro of a Kirchhoff’s law,
transistor is defined as the ratio of the change
VCC = VCE + ICRL --- (16.9)
in the collector-emitter voltage VCE and the
change in the collector current IC for constant Similarly, for the input loop we have,
base current IB. VBB = VBE + IBRB --- (16.10)
VCE When some AC signal is applied, vi is not zero
ro --- (16.8)
I C and we can write,
VBE + vi = vBE + IBRB + I B RB ri ---(16.11)
The change in VBE can be related to the input
Collector current (IC) in mA
10 Base current (IB) resistance and the change in the base current IB.
8 Hence, using Eq. (16.7) we can write,
vi = I B RB ri = ΔI B ri
6
4 because RB is small.
2 Changes in the base current cause changes
0 2 4 6 8 10 11 12 13
in the collector current. We will now define the
Collector to emitter voltage (VCE) in volts AC current gain bAC.
Fig. 16.24: The Input characteristics i
16.4.3 Transistor as an Amplifier: AC C
iB
Amplifier is a device which is used for The AC current gain bAC is almost the
increasing the amplitude of the alternating same as the DC current gain bDC for normal
signal (voltage, current or power). We will operating voltages.
360
The changes in the base current IB cause states (i.e. values), either low (0 V) or high
changes in the collector current IC. This (+5 V) value. An electronic circuit that handles
changes the voltage drop across the load only a digital signal is called a digital circuit,
resistance because VCC is constant. We can and the branch of electronics which deals with
write, digital circuits is called digital electronics.
VCC VCE RL I C 0 , therefore, Logic gate:
A digital circuit with one or more input
VCE RL I C signals but only one output signal is called a
The change in the out put voltage ∆VCE logic gate. It is a switching circuit that follows
is the output voltage Vi hence we can write, curtain logical relationship between the input
and output voltages. Therefore, they are
Vi VCE AC RL I B
generally known as logic gates; gates because
We now define the voltage gain Av of the they control the flow of signal or information .
amplifier as, The output of a logic gate can have only one
v V of the two possible states, i.e., either a high
Av o CE
vi ri I B voltage or low voltage.
The voltage gain is hence given by, Analog signal
Digital signal
R Volt Volt
Av AC L
ri
The negative sign indicates that the output
Time
voltage and the input voltage are out of phase. Time
362
A Figure 16.32 shows the symbol and truth
B Y = A+B table of two input x-OR gate.
Input Output
Exercises
363
ii) How is a Zener diode different than an 13. What are the uses of logic gates? Why is
ordinary diode? a NOT gate known as an inverter?
iii) On which factors does the wavelength of 14. Write the Boolean expression for (i) OR
light emitted by a LED depend? gate, (ii) AND gate, and (iii) NAND
iv) Why should a photodiode be operated in Gate.
reverse biased mode? 15. Why is the emitter, the base and the
v) State the principle and uses of a solar collector of a BJT doped differently?
Cell. 16. Which method of biasing is used for
3. Draw the circuit diagram of a half wave operating transistor as an amplifier?
rectifier. Explain its working. What is the 17. Define α and β. Derive the relation
frequency of ripple in its output? between then.
4. Why do we need filters in a power supply? 18. The common-base DC current gain of a
5. Draw a neat diagram of a full wave transistor is 0.967. If the emitter current is
rectifier and explain it’s working. 10mA. What is the value of base current.
6. Explain how a Zener diode maintains [Ans: 0.33mA]
constant voltage across a load. 19. In a comman-base connection, a certain
7. Explain the forward and the reverse transistor has an emitter current of
characteristic of a Zener diode. 10mA and collector current of 9.8 mA.
8. Explain the working of a LED. Calculate the value of the base current.
9. Explain the construction and working of [Ans: 0.2mA]
solar cell. 20. In a common-base connection, the emitter
10. Explain the principle of operation of a current is 6.28mA and collector current is
photodiode. 6.20 mA. Determine the common base
11. What do you mean by a logic gate, a DC current gain.
truth table and a Boolean expression? [Ans: 0.987]
12. What is logic gate? Write down the truth
table and Boolean expression for ‘AND’
gate.
364